blob: 41fcf7299dbeefb3aa6fb6cd906ad0b0d3c918a3 [file] [log] [blame]
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner0bc735f2007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
John McCall2d887082010-08-25 22:03:47 +000014#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
Douglas Gregore737f502010-08-12 20:07:10 +000015#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
16#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
17#include "clang/Sema/AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Sebastian Redlf79a7192011-04-29 08:19:30 +000019#include "clang/AST/ASTMutationListener.h"
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +000020#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Daniel Dunbarc4a1dea2008-08-11 05:35:13 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000022#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +000023#include "clang/AST/EvaluatedExprVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +000024#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +000025#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Narofff494b572008-05-29 21:12:08 +000026#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +000027#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +000028#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000029#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000030#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000031#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000032#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
33#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
John McCall19510852010-08-20 18:27:03 +000034#include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h"
35#include "clang/Sema/Designator.h"
36#include "clang/Sema/Scope.h"
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +000037#include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h"
John McCall19510852010-08-20 18:27:03 +000038#include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h"
Anna Zaks67221552011-07-28 19:51:27 +000039#include "clang/Sema/SemaFixItUtils.h"
John McCall7cd088e2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000040#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000041using namespace clang;
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +000042using namespace sema;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000043
Sebastian Redl14b0c192011-09-24 17:48:00 +000044/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, without
45/// emitting diagnostics.
46bool Sema::CanUseDecl(NamedDecl *D) {
47 // See if this is an auto-typed variable whose initializer we are parsing.
48 if (ParsingInitForAutoVars.count(D))
49 return false;
50
51 // See if this is a deleted function.
52 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
53 if (FD->isDeleted())
54 return false;
55 }
56 return true;
57}
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +000058
Fariborz Jahanian0f32caf2011-09-29 22:45:21 +000059static AvailabilityResult DiagnoseAvailabilityOfDecl(Sema &S,
60 NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
61 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *UnknownObjCClass) {
62 // See if this declaration is unavailable or deprecated.
63 std::string Message;
64 AvailabilityResult Result = D->getAvailability(&Message);
65 switch (Result) {
66 case AR_Available:
67 case AR_NotYetIntroduced:
68 break;
69
70 case AR_Deprecated:
71 S.EmitDeprecationWarning(D, Message, Loc, UnknownObjCClass);
72 break;
73
74 case AR_Unavailable:
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc076e372011-10-06 23:23:27 +000075 if (S.getCurContextAvailability() != AR_Unavailable) {
Fariborz Jahanian0f32caf2011-09-29 22:45:21 +000076 if (Message.empty()) {
77 if (!UnknownObjCClass)
78 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
79 else
80 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_unavailable_fwdclass_message)
81 << D->getDeclName();
82 }
83 else
84 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable_message)
85 << D->getDeclName() << Message;
86 S.Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here)
87 << isa<FunctionDecl>(D) << false;
88 }
89 break;
90 }
91 return Result;
92}
93
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000094/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
95/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
96///
97/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
98/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
99/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
100/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
101/// function is being used.
102///
103/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
104/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattner52338262009-10-25 22:31:57 +0000105///
Fariborz Jahanian8e5fc9b2010-12-21 00:44:01 +0000106bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Fariborz Jahanian0f32caf2011-09-29 22:45:21 +0000107 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *UnknownObjCClass) {
Douglas Gregor9b623632010-10-12 23:32:35 +0000108 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
109 // If there were any diagnostics suppressed by template argument deduction,
110 // emit them now.
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000111 llvm::DenseMap<Decl *, SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 1> >::iterator
Douglas Gregor9b623632010-10-12 23:32:35 +0000112 Pos = SuppressedDiagnostics.find(D->getCanonicalDecl());
113 if (Pos != SuppressedDiagnostics.end()) {
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000114 SmallVectorImpl<PartialDiagnosticAt> &Suppressed = Pos->second;
Douglas Gregor9b623632010-10-12 23:32:35 +0000115 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Suppressed.size(); I != N; ++I)
116 Diag(Suppressed[I].first, Suppressed[I].second);
117
118 // Clear out the list of suppressed diagnostics, so that we don't emit
Douglas Gregor0a0d2b12011-03-23 00:50:03 +0000119 // them again for this specialization. However, we don't obsolete this
Douglas Gregor9b623632010-10-12 23:32:35 +0000120 // entry from the table, because we want to avoid ever emitting these
121 // diagnostics again.
122 Suppressed.clear();
123 }
124 }
125
Richard Smith34b41d92011-02-20 03:19:35 +0000126 // See if this is an auto-typed variable whose initializer we are parsing.
Richard Smith483b9f32011-02-21 20:05:19 +0000127 if (ParsingInitForAutoVars.count(D)) {
128 Diag(Loc, diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
129 << D->getDeclName();
130 return true;
Richard Smith34b41d92011-02-20 03:19:35 +0000131 }
132
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +0000133 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregor25d944a2009-02-24 04:26:15 +0000134 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +0000135 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
136 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000137 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 1 << true;
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +0000138 return true;
139 }
Douglas Gregor25d944a2009-02-24 04:26:15 +0000140 }
Fariborz Jahanian0f32caf2011-09-29 22:45:21 +0000141 AvailabilityResult Result =
142 DiagnoseAvailabilityOfDecl(*this, D, Loc, UnknownObjCClass);
Douglas Gregor0a0d2b12011-03-23 00:50:03 +0000143
Anders Carlsson2127ecc2010-10-22 23:37:08 +0000144 // Warn if this is used but marked unused.
Fariborz Jahanian0f32caf2011-09-29 22:45:21 +0000145 if (D->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>())
Anders Carlsson2127ecc2010-10-22 23:37:08 +0000146 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_used_but_marked_unused) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian97db7262011-09-29 18:40:01 +0000147 // For available enumerator, it will become unavailable/deprecated
148 // if its enum declaration is as such.
149 if (Result == AR_Available)
150 if (const EnumConstantDecl *ECD = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(D)) {
151 const DeclContext *DC = ECD->getDeclContext();
152 if (const EnumDecl *TheEnumDecl = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(DC))
Fariborz Jahanian0f32caf2011-09-29 22:45:21 +0000153 DiagnoseAvailabilityOfDecl(*this,
154 const_cast< EnumDecl *>(TheEnumDecl),
155 Loc, UnknownObjCClass);
Fariborz Jahanian97db7262011-09-29 18:40:01 +0000156 }
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +0000157 return false;
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +0000158}
159
Douglas Gregor0a0d2b12011-03-23 00:50:03 +0000160/// \brief Retrieve the message suffix that should be added to a
161/// diagnostic complaining about the given function being deleted or
162/// unavailable.
163std::string Sema::getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(const FunctionDecl *FD) {
164 // FIXME: C++0x implicitly-deleted special member functions could be
165 // detected here so that we could improve diagnostics to say, e.g.,
166 // "base class 'A' had a deleted copy constructor".
167 if (FD->isDeleted())
168 return std::string();
169
170 std::string Message;
171 if (FD->getAvailability(&Message))
172 return ": " + Message;
173
174 return std::string();
175}
176
John McCall3323fad2011-09-09 07:56:05 +0000177/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks whether a call or
178/// message-send is to a declaration with the sentinel attribute, and
179/// if so, it checks that the requirements of the sentinel are
180/// satisfied.
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000181void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
John McCall3323fad2011-09-09 07:56:05 +0000182 Expr **args, unsigned numArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +0000183 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000184 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000185 return;
Douglas Gregor92e986e2010-04-22 16:44:27 +0000186
John McCall3323fad2011-09-09 07:56:05 +0000187 // The number of formal parameters of the declaration.
188 unsigned numFormalParams;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000189
John McCall3323fad2011-09-09 07:56:05 +0000190 // The kind of declaration. This is also an index into a %select in
191 // the diagnostic.
192 enum CalleeType { CT_Function, CT_Method, CT_Block } calleeType;
193
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000194 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
John McCall3323fad2011-09-09 07:56:05 +0000195 numFormalParams = MD->param_size();
196 calleeType = CT_Method;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000197 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
John McCall3323fad2011-09-09 07:56:05 +0000198 numFormalParams = FD->param_size();
199 calleeType = CT_Function;
200 } else if (isa<VarDecl>(D)) {
201 QualType type = cast<ValueDecl>(D)->getType();
202 const FunctionType *fn = 0;
203 if (const PointerType *ptr = type->getAs<PointerType>()) {
204 fn = ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
205 if (!fn) return;
206 calleeType = CT_Function;
207 } else if (const BlockPointerType *ptr = type->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
208 fn = ptr->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
209 calleeType = CT_Block;
210 } else {
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000211 return;
John McCall3323fad2011-09-09 07:56:05 +0000212 }
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000213
John McCall3323fad2011-09-09 07:56:05 +0000214 if (const FunctionProtoType *proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(fn)) {
215 numFormalParams = proto->getNumArgs();
216 } else {
217 numFormalParams = 0;
218 }
219 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000220 return;
221 }
John McCall3323fad2011-09-09 07:56:05 +0000222
223 // "nullPos" is the number of formal parameters at the end which
224 // effectively count as part of the variadic arguments. This is
225 // useful if you would prefer to not have *any* formal parameters,
226 // but the language forces you to have at least one.
227 unsigned nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
228 assert((nullPos == 0 || nullPos == 1) && "invalid null position on sentinel");
229 numFormalParams = (nullPos > numFormalParams ? 0 : numFormalParams - nullPos);
230
231 // The number of arguments which should follow the sentinel.
232 unsigned numArgsAfterSentinel = attr->getSentinel();
233
234 // If there aren't enough arguments for all the formal parameters,
235 // the sentinel, and the args after the sentinel, complain.
236 if (numArgs < numFormalParams + numArgsAfterSentinel + 1) {
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000237 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
John McCall3323fad2011-09-09 07:56:05 +0000238 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << calleeType;
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000239 return;
240 }
John McCall3323fad2011-09-09 07:56:05 +0000241
242 // Otherwise, find the sentinel expression.
243 Expr *sentinelExpr = args[numArgs - numArgsAfterSentinel - 1];
John McCall8eb662e2010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000244 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
John McCall8eb662e2010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000245 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
Anders Carlsson343e6ff2010-11-05 15:21:33 +0000246
247 // nullptr_t is always treated as null.
248 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isNullPtrType()) return;
249
Fariborz Jahanian9ccd7252010-07-14 16:37:51 +0000250 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
John McCall8eb662e2010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000251 sentinelExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
252 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
253 return;
254
255 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
256 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr)) return;
257
John McCall3323fad2011-09-09 07:56:05 +0000258 // Pick a reasonable string to insert. Optimistically use 'nil' or
259 // 'NULL' if those are actually defined in the context. Only use
260 // 'nil' for ObjC methods, where it's much more likely that the
261 // variadic arguments form a list of object pointers.
262 SourceLocation MissingNilLoc
Douglas Gregorf78c4e52011-07-30 08:57:03 +0000263 = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(sentinelExpr->getLocEnd());
264 std::string NullValue;
John McCall3323fad2011-09-09 07:56:05 +0000265 if (calleeType == CT_Method &&
266 PP.getIdentifierInfo("nil")->hasMacroDefinition())
Douglas Gregorf78c4e52011-07-30 08:57:03 +0000267 NullValue = "nil";
268 else if (PP.getIdentifierInfo("NULL")->hasMacroDefinition())
269 NullValue = "NULL";
Douglas Gregorf78c4e52011-07-30 08:57:03 +0000270 else
John McCall3323fad2011-09-09 07:56:05 +0000271 NullValue = "(void*) 0";
Eli Friedman39834ba2011-09-27 23:46:37 +0000272
273 if (MissingNilLoc.isInvalid())
274 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << calleeType;
275 else
276 Diag(MissingNilLoc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel)
277 << calleeType
278 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(MissingNilLoc, ", " + NullValue);
John McCall3323fad2011-09-09 07:56:05 +0000279 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << calleeType;
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000280}
281
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +0000282SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(Expr *E) const {
283 return E ? E->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
Douglas Gregor4b2d3f72009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000284}
285
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000286//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
287// Standard Promotions and Conversions
288//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
289
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000290/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +0000291ExprResult Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *E) {
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +0000292 // Handle any placeholder expressions which made it here.
293 if (E->getType()->isPlaceholderType()) {
294 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
295 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
296 E = result.take();
297 }
298
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000299 QualType Ty = E->getType();
300 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
301
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000302 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +0000303 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
304 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay).take();
Chris Lattner67d33d82008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000305 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
306 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
307 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
308 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
309 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
310 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
311 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc39a3d72008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000312 //
313 // C++ 4.2p1:
314 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
315 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
316 //
John McCall7eb0a9e2010-11-24 05:12:34 +0000317 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || E->isLValue())
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +0000318 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
319 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay).take();
Chris Lattner67d33d82008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000320 }
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +0000321 return Owned(E);
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000322}
323
Argyrios Kyrtzidis8a285ae2011-04-26 17:41:22 +0000324static void CheckForNullPointerDereference(Sema &S, Expr *E) {
325 // Check to see if we are dereferencing a null pointer. If so,
326 // and if not volatile-qualified, this is undefined behavior that the
327 // optimizer will delete, so warn about it. People sometimes try to use this
328 // to get a deterministic trap and are surprised by clang's behavior. This
329 // only handles the pattern "*null", which is a very syntactic check.
330 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E->IgnoreParenCasts()))
331 if (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Deref &&
332 UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParenCasts()->
333 isNullPointerConstant(S.Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) &&
334 !UO->getType().isVolatileQualified()) {
335 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO,
336 S.PDiag(diag::warn_indirection_through_null)
337 << UO->getSubExpr()->getSourceRange());
338 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO,
339 S.PDiag(diag::note_indirection_through_null));
340 }
341}
342
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +0000343ExprResult Sema::DefaultLvalueConversion(Expr *E) {
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +0000344 // Handle any placeholder expressions which made it here.
345 if (E->getType()->isPlaceholderType()) {
346 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
347 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
348 E = result.take();
349 }
350
John McCall0ae287a2010-12-01 04:43:34 +0000351 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
352 // A glvalue of a non-function, non-array type T can be
353 // converted to a prvalue.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +0000354 if (!E->isGLValue()) return Owned(E);
Kaelyn Uhraind6c88652011-08-05 23:18:04 +0000355
John McCall409fa9a2010-12-06 20:48:59 +0000356 QualType T = E->getType();
357 assert(!T.isNull() && "r-value conversion on typeless expression?");
John McCallf6a16482010-12-04 03:47:34 +0000358
Eli Friedmanb001de72011-10-06 23:00:33 +0000359 // We can't do lvalue-to-rvalue on atomics yet.
360 if (T->getAs<AtomicType>())
361 return Owned(E);
362
John McCall409fa9a2010-12-06 20:48:59 +0000363 // Create a load out of an ObjCProperty l-value, if necessary.
364 if (E->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +0000365 ExprResult Res = ConvertPropertyForRValue(E);
366 if (Res.isInvalid())
367 return Owned(E);
368 E = Res.take();
John McCall409fa9a2010-12-06 20:48:59 +0000369 if (!E->isGLValue())
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +0000370 return Owned(E);
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000371 }
John McCall409fa9a2010-12-06 20:48:59 +0000372
373 // We don't want to throw lvalue-to-rvalue casts on top of
374 // expressions of certain types in C++.
375 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
376 (E->getType() == Context.OverloadTy ||
377 T->isDependentType() ||
378 T->isRecordType()))
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +0000379 return Owned(E);
John McCall409fa9a2010-12-06 20:48:59 +0000380
381 // The C standard is actually really unclear on this point, and
382 // DR106 tells us what the result should be but not why. It's
383 // generally best to say that void types just doesn't undergo
384 // lvalue-to-rvalue at all. Note that expressions of unqualified
385 // 'void' type are never l-values, but qualified void can be.
386 if (T->isVoidType())
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +0000387 return Owned(E);
John McCall409fa9a2010-12-06 20:48:59 +0000388
Argyrios Kyrtzidis8a285ae2011-04-26 17:41:22 +0000389 CheckForNullPointerDereference(*this, E);
390
John McCall409fa9a2010-12-06 20:48:59 +0000391 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
392 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the prvalue is the
393 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
394 // rvalue is T.
395 //
396 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
397 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
398 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
399 // type of the lvalue.
400 if (T.hasQualifiers())
401 T = T.getUnqualifiedType();
Ted Kremeneka0125d82011-02-16 01:57:07 +0000402
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +0000403 return Owned(ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, T, CK_LValueToRValue,
404 E, 0, VK_RValue));
John McCall409fa9a2010-12-06 20:48:59 +0000405}
406
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +0000407ExprResult Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *E) {
408 ExprResult Res = DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
409 if (Res.isInvalid())
410 return ExprError();
411 Res = DefaultLvalueConversion(Res.take());
412 if (Res.isInvalid())
413 return ExprError();
414 return move(Res);
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000415}
416
417
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000418/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000419/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattnerfc8f0e12011-04-15 05:22:18 +0000420/// sometimes suppressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000421/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
422/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +0000423ExprResult Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *E) {
John McCall0ae287a2010-12-01 04:43:34 +0000424 // First, convert to an r-value.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +0000425 ExprResult Res = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
426 if (Res.isInvalid())
427 return Owned(E);
428 E = Res.take();
John McCall0ae287a2010-12-01 04:43:34 +0000429
430 QualType Ty = E->getType();
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000431 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
John McCall0ae287a2010-12-01 04:43:34 +0000432
433 // Try to perform integral promotions if the object has a theoretically
434 // promotable type.
435 if (Ty->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) {
436 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
437 //
438 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
439 // unsigned int may be used:
440 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
441 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
442 // and unsigned int.
443 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
444 //
445 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
446 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
447 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
448 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
449
450 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(E);
451 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +0000452 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, PTy, CK_IntegralCast).take();
453 return Owned(E);
John McCall0ae287a2010-12-01 04:43:34 +0000454 }
455 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
456 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +0000457 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, PT, CK_IntegralCast).take();
458 return Owned(E);
John McCall0ae287a2010-12-01 04:43:34 +0000459 }
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000460 }
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +0000461 return Owned(E);
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000462}
463
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000464/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000465/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000466/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +0000467ExprResult Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *E) {
468 QualType Ty = E->getType();
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000469 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000470
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +0000471 ExprResult Res = UsualUnaryConversions(E);
472 if (Res.isInvalid())
473 return Owned(E);
474 E = Res.take();
John McCall40c29132010-12-06 18:36:11 +0000475
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000476 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000477 if (Ty->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +0000478 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.DoubleTy, CK_FloatingCast).take();
479
John McCall96a914a2011-08-27 22:06:17 +0000480 // C++ performs lvalue-to-rvalue conversion as a default argument
John McCall709bca82011-08-29 23:55:37 +0000481 // promotion, even on class types, but note:
482 // C++11 [conv.lval]p2:
483 // When an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion occurs in an unevaluated
484 // operand or a subexpression thereof the value contained in the
485 // referenced object is not accessed. Otherwise, if the glvalue
486 // has a class type, the conversion copy-initializes a temporary
487 // of type T from the glvalue and the result of the conversion
488 // is a prvalue for the temporary.
489 // FIXME: add some way to gate this entire thing for correctness in
490 // potentially potentially evaluated contexts.
John McCall96a914a2011-08-27 22:06:17 +0000491 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && E->isGLValue() &&
492 ExprEvalContexts.back().Context != Unevaluated) {
John McCall5f8d6042011-08-27 01:09:30 +0000493 ExprResult Temp = PerformCopyInitialization(
494 InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(E->getType()),
495 E->getExprLoc(),
496 Owned(E));
497 if (Temp.isInvalid())
498 return ExprError();
499 E = Temp.get();
500 }
501
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +0000502 return Owned(E);
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000503}
504
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000505/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
506/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +0000507/// interfaces passed by value.
508ExprResult Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *E, VariadicCallType CT,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000509 FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
Douglas Gregor8d5e18c2011-06-17 00:15:10 +0000510 ExprResult ExprRes = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
511 if (ExprRes.isInvalid())
512 return ExprError();
513
514 ExprRes = DefaultArgumentPromotion(E);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +0000515 if (ExprRes.isInvalid())
516 return ExprError();
517 E = ExprRes.take();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000518
Douglas Gregor930a9ab2011-05-21 19:26:31 +0000519 // Don't allow one to pass an Objective-C interface to a vararg.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +0000520 if (E->getType()->isObjCObjectType() &&
Douglas Gregor930a9ab2011-05-21 19:26:31 +0000521 DiagRuntimeBehavior(E->getLocStart(), 0,
522 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
523 << E->getType() << CT))
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +0000524 return ExprError();
John McCall5f8d6042011-08-27 01:09:30 +0000525
Douglas Gregorb8e778d2011-10-14 20:34:19 +0000526 // Complain about passing non-POD types through varargs. However, don't
527 // perform this check for incomplete types, which we can get here when we're
528 // in an unevaluated context.
529 if (!E->getType()->isIncompleteType() && !E->getType().isPODType(Context)) {
Douglas Gregor0fd228d2011-05-21 16:27:21 +0000530 // C++0x [expr.call]p7:
531 // Passing a potentially-evaluated argument of class type (Clause 9)
532 // having a non-trivial copy constructor, a non-trivial move constructor,
533 // or a non-trivial destructor, with no corresponding parameter,
534 // is conditionally-supported with implementation-defined semantics.
535 bool TrivialEnough = false;
536 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x && !E->getType()->isDependentType()) {
537 if (CXXRecordDecl *Record = E->getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
538 if (Record->hasTrivialCopyConstructor() &&
539 Record->hasTrivialMoveConstructor() &&
540 Record->hasTrivialDestructor())
541 TrivialEnough = true;
542 }
543 }
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000544
545 if (!TrivialEnough &&
546 getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount &&
547 E->getType()->isObjCLifetimeType())
548 TrivialEnough = true;
Douglas Gregor0fd228d2011-05-21 16:27:21 +0000549
550 if (TrivialEnough) {
551 // Nothing to diagnose. This is okay.
552 } else if (DiagRuntimeBehavior(E->getLocStart(), 0,
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000553 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
Douglas Gregor0fd228d2011-05-21 16:27:21 +0000554 << getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x << E->getType()
Douglas Gregor930a9ab2011-05-21 19:26:31 +0000555 << CT)) {
556 // Turn this into a trap.
557 CXXScopeSpec SS;
558 UnqualifiedId Name;
559 Name.setIdentifier(PP.getIdentifierInfo("__builtin_trap"),
560 E->getLocStart());
561 ExprResult TrapFn = ActOnIdExpression(TUScope, SS, Name, true, false);
562 if (TrapFn.isInvalid())
563 return ExprError();
564
565 ExprResult Call = ActOnCallExpr(TUScope, TrapFn.get(), E->getLocStart(),
566 MultiExprArg(), E->getLocEnd());
567 if (Call.isInvalid())
568 return ExprError();
569
570 ExprResult Comma = ActOnBinOp(TUScope, E->getLocStart(), tok::comma,
571 Call.get(), E);
572 if (Comma.isInvalid())
John McCall66c20302011-08-26 18:41:18 +0000573 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor930a9ab2011-05-21 19:26:31 +0000574 E = Comma.get();
575 }
Douglas Gregor0fd228d2011-05-21 16:27:21 +0000576 }
577
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +0000578 return Owned(E);
Anders Carlssondce5e2c2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000579}
580
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000581/// \brief Converts an integer to complex float type. Helper function of
582/// UsualArithmeticConversions()
583///
584/// \return false if the integer expression is an integer type and is
585/// successfully converted to the complex type.
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +0000586static bool handleIntegerToComplexFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &IntExpr,
587 ExprResult &ComplexExpr,
588 QualType IntTy,
589 QualType ComplexTy,
590 bool SkipCast) {
591 if (IntTy->isComplexType() || IntTy->isRealFloatingType()) return true;
592 if (SkipCast) return false;
593 if (IntTy->isIntegerType()) {
594 QualType fpTy = cast<ComplexType>(ComplexTy)->getElementType();
595 IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.take(), fpTy, CK_IntegralToFloating);
596 IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.take(), ComplexTy,
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000597 CK_FloatingRealToComplex);
598 } else {
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +0000599 assert(IntTy->isComplexIntegerType());
600 IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.take(), ComplexTy,
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000601 CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex);
602 }
603 return false;
604}
605
606/// \brief Takes two complex float types and converts them to the same type.
607/// Helper function of UsualArithmeticConversions()
608static QualType
Richard Trieucafd30b2011-09-06 18:25:09 +0000609handleComplexFloatToComplexFloatConverstion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
610 ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType,
611 QualType RHSType,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +0000612 bool IsCompAssign) {
Richard Trieucafd30b2011-09-06 18:25:09 +0000613 int order = S.Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(LHSType, RHSType);
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000614
615 if (order < 0) {
616 // _Complex float -> _Complex double
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +0000617 if (!IsCompAssign)
Richard Trieucafd30b2011-09-06 18:25:09 +0000618 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.take(), RHSType, CK_FloatingComplexCast);
619 return RHSType;
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000620 }
621 if (order > 0)
622 // _Complex float -> _Complex double
Richard Trieucafd30b2011-09-06 18:25:09 +0000623 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.take(), LHSType, CK_FloatingComplexCast);
624 return LHSType;
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000625}
626
627/// \brief Converts otherExpr to complex float and promotes complexExpr if
628/// necessary. Helper function of UsualArithmeticConversions()
629static QualType handleOtherComplexFloatConversion(Sema &S,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +0000630 ExprResult &ComplexExpr,
631 ExprResult &OtherExpr,
632 QualType ComplexTy,
633 QualType OtherTy,
634 bool ConvertComplexExpr,
635 bool ConvertOtherExpr) {
636 int order = S.Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(ComplexTy, OtherTy);
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000637
638 // If just the complexExpr is complex, the otherExpr needs to be converted,
639 // and the complexExpr might need to be promoted.
640 if (order > 0) { // complexExpr is wider
641 // float -> _Complex double
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +0000642 if (ConvertOtherExpr) {
643 QualType fp = cast<ComplexType>(ComplexTy)->getElementType();
644 OtherExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(OtherExpr.take(), fp, CK_FloatingCast);
645 OtherExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(OtherExpr.take(), ComplexTy,
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000646 CK_FloatingRealToComplex);
647 }
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +0000648 return ComplexTy;
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000649 }
650
651 // otherTy is at least as wide. Find its corresponding complex type.
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +0000652 QualType result = (order == 0 ? ComplexTy :
653 S.Context.getComplexType(OtherTy));
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000654
655 // double -> _Complex double
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +0000656 if (ConvertOtherExpr)
657 OtherExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(OtherExpr.take(), result,
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000658 CK_FloatingRealToComplex);
659
660 // _Complex float -> _Complex double
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +0000661 if (ConvertComplexExpr && order < 0)
662 ComplexExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(ComplexExpr.take(), result,
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000663 CK_FloatingComplexCast);
664
665 return result;
666}
667
668/// \brief Handle arithmetic conversion with complex types. Helper function of
669/// UsualArithmeticConversions()
Richard Trieucafd30b2011-09-06 18:25:09 +0000670static QualType handleComplexFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
671 ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType,
672 QualType RHSType,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +0000673 bool IsCompAssign) {
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000674 // if we have an integer operand, the result is the complex type.
Richard Trieucafd30b2011-09-06 18:25:09 +0000675 if (!handleIntegerToComplexFloatConversion(S, RHS, LHS, RHSType, LHSType,
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000676 /*skipCast*/false))
Richard Trieucafd30b2011-09-06 18:25:09 +0000677 return LHSType;
678 if (!handleIntegerToComplexFloatConversion(S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +0000679 /*skipCast*/IsCompAssign))
Richard Trieucafd30b2011-09-06 18:25:09 +0000680 return RHSType;
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000681
682 // This handles complex/complex, complex/float, or float/complex.
683 // When both operands are complex, the shorter operand is converted to the
684 // type of the longer, and that is the type of the result. This corresponds
685 // to what is done when combining two real floating-point operands.
686 // The fun begins when size promotion occur across type domains.
687 // From H&S 6.3.4: When one operand is complex and the other is a real
688 // floating-point type, the less precise type is converted, within it's
689 // real or complex domain, to the precision of the other type. For example,
690 // when combining a "long double" with a "double _Complex", the
691 // "double _Complex" is promoted to "long double _Complex".
692
Richard Trieucafd30b2011-09-06 18:25:09 +0000693 bool LHSComplexFloat = LHSType->isComplexType();
694 bool RHSComplexFloat = RHSType->isComplexType();
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000695
696 // If both are complex, just cast to the more precise type.
697 if (LHSComplexFloat && RHSComplexFloat)
Richard Trieucafd30b2011-09-06 18:25:09 +0000698 return handleComplexFloatToComplexFloatConverstion(S, LHS, RHS,
699 LHSType, RHSType,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +0000700 IsCompAssign);
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000701
702 // If only one operand is complex, promote it if necessary and convert the
703 // other operand to complex.
704 if (LHSComplexFloat)
705 return handleOtherComplexFloatConversion(
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +0000706 S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, /*convertComplexExpr*/!IsCompAssign,
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000707 /*convertOtherExpr*/ true);
708
709 assert(RHSComplexFloat);
710 return handleOtherComplexFloatConversion(
Richard Trieucafd30b2011-09-06 18:25:09 +0000711 S, RHS, LHS, RHSType, LHSType, /*convertComplexExpr*/true,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +0000712 /*convertOtherExpr*/ !IsCompAssign);
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000713}
714
715/// \brief Hande arithmetic conversion from integer to float. Helper function
716/// of UsualArithmeticConversions()
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +0000717static QualType handleIntToFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &FloatExpr,
718 ExprResult &IntExpr,
719 QualType FloatTy, QualType IntTy,
720 bool ConvertFloat, bool ConvertInt) {
721 if (IntTy->isIntegerType()) {
722 if (ConvertInt)
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000723 // Convert intExpr to the lhs floating point type.
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +0000724 IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.take(), FloatTy,
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000725 CK_IntegralToFloating);
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +0000726 return FloatTy;
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000727 }
728
729 // Convert both sides to the appropriate complex float.
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +0000730 assert(IntTy->isComplexIntegerType());
731 QualType result = S.Context.getComplexType(FloatTy);
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000732
733 // _Complex int -> _Complex float
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +0000734 if (ConvertInt)
735 IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.take(), result,
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000736 CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex);
737
738 // float -> _Complex float
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +0000739 if (ConvertFloat)
740 FloatExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(FloatExpr.take(), result,
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000741 CK_FloatingRealToComplex);
742
743 return result;
744}
745
746/// \brief Handle arithmethic conversion with floating point types. Helper
747/// function of UsualArithmeticConversions()
Richard Trieu8ef5c8e2011-09-06 18:38:41 +0000748static QualType handleFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
749 ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +0000750 QualType RHSType, bool IsCompAssign) {
Richard Trieu8ef5c8e2011-09-06 18:38:41 +0000751 bool LHSFloat = LHSType->isRealFloatingType();
752 bool RHSFloat = RHSType->isRealFloatingType();
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000753
754 // If we have two real floating types, convert the smaller operand
755 // to the bigger result.
756 if (LHSFloat && RHSFloat) {
Richard Trieu8ef5c8e2011-09-06 18:38:41 +0000757 int order = S.Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(LHSType, RHSType);
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000758 if (order > 0) {
Richard Trieu8ef5c8e2011-09-06 18:38:41 +0000759 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.take(), LHSType, CK_FloatingCast);
760 return LHSType;
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000761 }
762
763 assert(order < 0 && "illegal float comparison");
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +0000764 if (!IsCompAssign)
Richard Trieu8ef5c8e2011-09-06 18:38:41 +0000765 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.take(), RHSType, CK_FloatingCast);
766 return RHSType;
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000767 }
768
769 if (LHSFloat)
Richard Trieu8ef5c8e2011-09-06 18:38:41 +0000770 return handleIntToFloatConversion(S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +0000771 /*convertFloat=*/!IsCompAssign,
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000772 /*convertInt=*/ true);
773 assert(RHSFloat);
Richard Trieu8ef5c8e2011-09-06 18:38:41 +0000774 return handleIntToFloatConversion(S, RHS, LHS, RHSType, LHSType,
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000775 /*convertInt=*/ true,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +0000776 /*convertFloat=*/!IsCompAssign);
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000777}
778
779/// \brief Handle conversions with GCC complex int extension. Helper function
Benjamin Kramer5cc86802011-09-06 19:57:14 +0000780/// of UsualArithmeticConversions()
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000781// FIXME: if the operands are (int, _Complex long), we currently
782// don't promote the complex. Also, signedness?
Benjamin Kramer5cc86802011-09-06 19:57:14 +0000783static QualType handleComplexIntConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
784 ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType,
785 QualType RHSType,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +0000786 bool IsCompAssign) {
Richard Trieu8ef5c8e2011-09-06 18:38:41 +0000787 const ComplexType *LHSComplexInt = LHSType->getAsComplexIntegerType();
788 const ComplexType *RHSComplexInt = RHSType->getAsComplexIntegerType();
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000789
Richard Trieu8ef5c8e2011-09-06 18:38:41 +0000790 if (LHSComplexInt && RHSComplexInt) {
791 int order = S.Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(LHSComplexInt->getElementType(),
792 RHSComplexInt->getElementType());
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000793 assert(order && "inequal types with equal element ordering");
794 if (order > 0) {
795 // _Complex int -> _Complex long
Richard Trieu8ef5c8e2011-09-06 18:38:41 +0000796 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.take(), LHSType, CK_IntegralComplexCast);
797 return LHSType;
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000798 }
799
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +0000800 if (!IsCompAssign)
Richard Trieu8ef5c8e2011-09-06 18:38:41 +0000801 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.take(), RHSType, CK_IntegralComplexCast);
802 return RHSType;
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000803 }
804
Richard Trieu8ef5c8e2011-09-06 18:38:41 +0000805 if (LHSComplexInt) {
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000806 // int -> _Complex int
Richard Trieu8ef5c8e2011-09-06 18:38:41 +0000807 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.take(), LHSType, CK_IntegralRealToComplex);
808 return LHSType;
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000809 }
810
Richard Trieu8ef5c8e2011-09-06 18:38:41 +0000811 assert(RHSComplexInt);
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000812 // int -> _Complex int
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +0000813 if (!IsCompAssign)
Richard Trieu8ef5c8e2011-09-06 18:38:41 +0000814 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.take(), RHSType, CK_IntegralRealToComplex);
815 return RHSType;
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000816}
817
818/// \brief Handle integer arithmetic conversions. Helper function of
819/// UsualArithmeticConversions()
Richard Trieu2e8a95d2011-09-06 19:52:52 +0000820static QualType handleIntegerConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
821 ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +0000822 QualType RHSType, bool IsCompAssign) {
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000823 // The rules for this case are in C99 6.3.1.8
Richard Trieu2e8a95d2011-09-06 19:52:52 +0000824 int order = S.Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(LHSType, RHSType);
825 bool LHSSigned = LHSType->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation();
826 bool RHSSigned = RHSType->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation();
827 if (LHSSigned == RHSSigned) {
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000828 // Same signedness; use the higher-ranked type
829 if (order >= 0) {
Richard Trieu2e8a95d2011-09-06 19:52:52 +0000830 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.take(), LHSType, CK_IntegralCast);
831 return LHSType;
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +0000832 } else if (!IsCompAssign)
Richard Trieu2e8a95d2011-09-06 19:52:52 +0000833 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.take(), RHSType, CK_IntegralCast);
834 return RHSType;
835 } else if (order != (LHSSigned ? 1 : -1)) {
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000836 // The unsigned type has greater than or equal rank to the
837 // signed type, so use the unsigned type
Richard Trieu2e8a95d2011-09-06 19:52:52 +0000838 if (RHSSigned) {
839 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.take(), LHSType, CK_IntegralCast);
840 return LHSType;
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +0000841 } else if (!IsCompAssign)
Richard Trieu2e8a95d2011-09-06 19:52:52 +0000842 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.take(), RHSType, CK_IntegralCast);
843 return RHSType;
844 } else if (S.Context.getIntWidth(LHSType) != S.Context.getIntWidth(RHSType)) {
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000845 // The two types are different widths; if we are here, that
846 // means the signed type is larger than the unsigned type, so
847 // use the signed type.
Richard Trieu2e8a95d2011-09-06 19:52:52 +0000848 if (LHSSigned) {
849 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.take(), LHSType, CK_IntegralCast);
850 return LHSType;
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +0000851 } else if (!IsCompAssign)
Richard Trieu2e8a95d2011-09-06 19:52:52 +0000852 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.take(), RHSType, CK_IntegralCast);
853 return RHSType;
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000854 } else {
855 // The signed type is higher-ranked than the unsigned type,
856 // but isn't actually any bigger (like unsigned int and long
857 // on most 32-bit systems). Use the unsigned type corresponding
858 // to the signed type.
859 QualType result =
Richard Trieu2e8a95d2011-09-06 19:52:52 +0000860 S.Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(LHSSigned ? LHSType : RHSType);
861 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.take(), result, CK_IntegralCast);
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +0000862 if (!IsCompAssign)
Richard Trieu2e8a95d2011-09-06 19:52:52 +0000863 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.take(), result, CK_IntegralCast);
Richard Trieu8289f492011-09-02 20:58:51 +0000864 return result;
865 }
866}
867
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000868/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
869/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000870/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000871/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
872/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
873/// GCC.
Richard Trieu2e8a95d2011-09-06 19:52:52 +0000874QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +0000875 bool IsCompAssign) {
876 if (!IsCompAssign) {
Richard Trieu2e8a95d2011-09-06 19:52:52 +0000877 LHS = UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.take());
878 if (LHS.isInvalid())
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +0000879 return QualType();
880 }
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000881
Richard Trieu2e8a95d2011-09-06 19:52:52 +0000882 RHS = UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.take());
883 if (RHS.isInvalid())
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +0000884 return QualType();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000885
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000886 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000887 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Richard Trieu2e8a95d2011-09-06 19:52:52 +0000888 QualType LHSType =
889 Context.getCanonicalType(LHS.get()->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
890 QualType RHSType =
891 Context.getCanonicalType(RHS.get()->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000892
893 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
Richard Trieu2e8a95d2011-09-06 19:52:52 +0000894 if (LHSType == RHSType)
895 return LHSType;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000896
897 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
898 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
Richard Trieu2e8a95d2011-09-06 19:52:52 +0000899 if (!LHSType->isArithmeticType() || !RHSType->isArithmeticType())
900 return LHSType;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000901
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000902 // Apply unary and bitfield promotions to the LHS's type.
Richard Trieu2e8a95d2011-09-06 19:52:52 +0000903 QualType LHSUnpromotedType = LHSType;
904 if (LHSType->isPromotableIntegerType())
905 LHSType = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSType);
906 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(LHS.get());
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000907 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
Richard Trieu2e8a95d2011-09-06 19:52:52 +0000908 LHSType = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +0000909 if (LHSType != LHSUnpromotedType && !IsCompAssign)
Richard Trieu2e8a95d2011-09-06 19:52:52 +0000910 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.take(), LHSType, CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000911
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000912 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
Richard Trieu2e8a95d2011-09-06 19:52:52 +0000913 if (LHSType == RHSType)
914 return LHSType;
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000915
916 // At this point, we have two different arithmetic types.
917
918 // Handle complex types first (C99 6.3.1.8p1).
Richard Trieu2e8a95d2011-09-06 19:52:52 +0000919 if (LHSType->isComplexType() || RHSType->isComplexType())
920 return handleComplexFloatConversion(*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +0000921 IsCompAssign);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000922
923 // Now handle "real" floating types (i.e. float, double, long double).
Richard Trieu2e8a95d2011-09-06 19:52:52 +0000924 if (LHSType->isRealFloatingType() || RHSType->isRealFloatingType())
925 return handleFloatConversion(*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +0000926 IsCompAssign);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000927
928 // Handle GCC complex int extension.
Richard Trieu2e8a95d2011-09-06 19:52:52 +0000929 if (LHSType->isComplexIntegerType() || RHSType->isComplexIntegerType())
Benjamin Kramer5cc86802011-09-06 19:57:14 +0000930 return handleComplexIntConversion(*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +0000931 IsCompAssign);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000932
933 // Finally, we have two differing integer types.
Richard Trieu2e8a95d2011-09-06 19:52:52 +0000934 return handleIntegerConversion(*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +0000935 IsCompAssign);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000936}
937
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000938//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
939// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
940//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
941
942
Peter Collingbournef111d932011-04-15 00:35:48 +0000943ExprResult
944Sema::ActOnGenericSelectionExpr(SourceLocation KeyLoc,
945 SourceLocation DefaultLoc,
946 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
947 Expr *ControllingExpr,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +0000948 MultiTypeArg ArgTypes,
949 MultiExprArg ArgExprs) {
950 unsigned NumAssocs = ArgTypes.size();
951 assert(NumAssocs == ArgExprs.size());
Peter Collingbournef111d932011-04-15 00:35:48 +0000952
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +0000953 ParsedType *ParsedTypes = ArgTypes.release();
954 Expr **Exprs = ArgExprs.release();
Peter Collingbournef111d932011-04-15 00:35:48 +0000955
956 TypeSourceInfo **Types = new TypeSourceInfo*[NumAssocs];
957 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumAssocs; ++i) {
958 if (ParsedTypes[i])
959 (void) GetTypeFromParser(ParsedTypes[i], &Types[i]);
960 else
961 Types[i] = 0;
962 }
963
964 ExprResult ER = CreateGenericSelectionExpr(KeyLoc, DefaultLoc, RParenLoc,
965 ControllingExpr, Types, Exprs,
966 NumAssocs);
Benjamin Kramer5bf47f72011-04-15 11:21:57 +0000967 delete [] Types;
Peter Collingbournef111d932011-04-15 00:35:48 +0000968 return ER;
969}
970
971ExprResult
972Sema::CreateGenericSelectionExpr(SourceLocation KeyLoc,
973 SourceLocation DefaultLoc,
974 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
975 Expr *ControllingExpr,
976 TypeSourceInfo **Types,
977 Expr **Exprs,
978 unsigned NumAssocs) {
979 bool TypeErrorFound = false,
980 IsResultDependent = ControllingExpr->isTypeDependent(),
981 ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack
982 = ControllingExpr->containsUnexpandedParameterPack();
983
984 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumAssocs; ++i) {
985 if (Exprs[i]->containsUnexpandedParameterPack())
986 ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack = true;
987
988 if (Types[i]) {
989 if (Types[i]->getType()->containsUnexpandedParameterPack())
990 ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack = true;
991
992 if (Types[i]->getType()->isDependentType()) {
993 IsResultDependent = true;
994 } else {
995 // C1X 6.5.1.1p2 "The type name in a generic association shall specify a
996 // complete object type other than a variably modified type."
997 unsigned D = 0;
998 if (Types[i]->getType()->isIncompleteType())
999 D = diag::err_assoc_type_incomplete;
1000 else if (!Types[i]->getType()->isObjectType())
1001 D = diag::err_assoc_type_nonobject;
1002 else if (Types[i]->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType())
1003 D = diag::err_assoc_type_variably_modified;
1004
1005 if (D != 0) {
1006 Diag(Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), D)
1007 << Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange()
1008 << Types[i]->getType();
1009 TypeErrorFound = true;
1010 }
1011
1012 // C1X 6.5.1.1p2 "No two generic associations in the same generic
1013 // selection shall specify compatible types."
1014 for (unsigned j = i+1; j < NumAssocs; ++j)
1015 if (Types[j] && !Types[j]->getType()->isDependentType() &&
1016 Context.typesAreCompatible(Types[i]->getType(),
1017 Types[j]->getType())) {
1018 Diag(Types[j]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(),
1019 diag::err_assoc_compatible_types)
1020 << Types[j]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange()
1021 << Types[j]->getType()
1022 << Types[i]->getType();
1023 Diag(Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(),
1024 diag::note_compat_assoc)
1025 << Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange()
1026 << Types[i]->getType();
1027 TypeErrorFound = true;
1028 }
1029 }
1030 }
1031 }
1032 if (TypeErrorFound)
1033 return ExprError();
1034
1035 // If we determined that the generic selection is result-dependent, don't
1036 // try to compute the result expression.
1037 if (IsResultDependent)
1038 return Owned(new (Context) GenericSelectionExpr(
1039 Context, KeyLoc, ControllingExpr,
1040 Types, Exprs, NumAssocs, DefaultLoc,
1041 RParenLoc, ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack));
1042
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00001043 SmallVector<unsigned, 1> CompatIndices;
Peter Collingbournef111d932011-04-15 00:35:48 +00001044 unsigned DefaultIndex = -1U;
1045 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumAssocs; ++i) {
1046 if (!Types[i])
1047 DefaultIndex = i;
1048 else if (Context.typesAreCompatible(ControllingExpr->getType(),
1049 Types[i]->getType()))
1050 CompatIndices.push_back(i);
1051 }
1052
1053 // C1X 6.5.1.1p2 "The controlling expression of a generic selection shall have
1054 // type compatible with at most one of the types named in its generic
1055 // association list."
1056 if (CompatIndices.size() > 1) {
1057 // We strip parens here because the controlling expression is typically
1058 // parenthesized in macro definitions.
1059 ControllingExpr = ControllingExpr->IgnoreParens();
1060 Diag(ControllingExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_generic_sel_multi_match)
1061 << ControllingExpr->getSourceRange() << ControllingExpr->getType()
1062 << (unsigned) CompatIndices.size();
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00001063 for (SmallVector<unsigned, 1>::iterator I = CompatIndices.begin(),
Peter Collingbournef111d932011-04-15 00:35:48 +00001064 E = CompatIndices.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1065 Diag(Types[*I]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(),
1066 diag::note_compat_assoc)
1067 << Types[*I]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange()
1068 << Types[*I]->getType();
1069 }
1070 return ExprError();
1071 }
1072
1073 // C1X 6.5.1.1p2 "If a generic selection has no default generic association,
1074 // its controlling expression shall have type compatible with exactly one of
1075 // the types named in its generic association list."
1076 if (DefaultIndex == -1U && CompatIndices.size() == 0) {
1077 // We strip parens here because the controlling expression is typically
1078 // parenthesized in macro definitions.
1079 ControllingExpr = ControllingExpr->IgnoreParens();
1080 Diag(ControllingExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_generic_sel_no_match)
1081 << ControllingExpr->getSourceRange() << ControllingExpr->getType();
1082 return ExprError();
1083 }
1084
1085 // C1X 6.5.1.1p3 "If a generic selection has a generic association with a
1086 // type name that is compatible with the type of the controlling expression,
1087 // then the result expression of the generic selection is the expression
1088 // in that generic association. Otherwise, the result expression of the
1089 // generic selection is the expression in the default generic association."
1090 unsigned ResultIndex =
1091 CompatIndices.size() ? CompatIndices[0] : DefaultIndex;
1092
1093 return Owned(new (Context) GenericSelectionExpr(
1094 Context, KeyLoc, ControllingExpr,
1095 Types, Exprs, NumAssocs, DefaultLoc,
1096 RParenLoc, ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack,
1097 ResultIndex));
1098}
1099
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00001100/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001101/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
1102/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
1103/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
1104/// string.
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001105///
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001106ExprResult
Sean Hunt6cf75022010-08-30 17:47:05 +00001107Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001108 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
1109
Chris Lattnerbbee00b2009-01-16 18:51:42 +00001110 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001111 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001112 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001113
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00001114 SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001115 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
1116 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +00001117
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +00001118 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Douglas Gregor5cee1192011-07-27 05:40:30 +00001119 if (Literal.isWide())
Anders Carlsson96b4adc2011-04-06 18:42:48 +00001120 StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Douglas Gregor5cee1192011-07-27 05:40:30 +00001121 else if (Literal.isUTF16())
1122 StrTy = Context.Char16Ty;
1123 else if (Literal.isUTF32())
1124 StrTy = Context.Char32Ty;
Anders Carlsson96b4adc2011-04-06 18:42:48 +00001125 else if (Literal.Pascal)
1126 StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +00001127
Douglas Gregor5cee1192011-07-27 05:40:30 +00001128 StringLiteral::StringKind Kind = StringLiteral::Ascii;
1129 if (Literal.isWide())
1130 Kind = StringLiteral::Wide;
1131 else if (Literal.isUTF8())
1132 Kind = StringLiteral::UTF8;
1133 else if (Literal.isUTF16())
1134 Kind = StringLiteral::UTF16;
1135 else if (Literal.isUTF32())
1136 Kind = StringLiteral::UTF32;
1137
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +00001138 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
Chris Lattner7dc480f2010-06-15 18:05:34 +00001139 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings)
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +00001140 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001141
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +00001142 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
1143 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
1144 // strings.
1145 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerdbb1ecc2009-02-26 23:01:51 +00001146 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +00001147 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001148
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001149 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Sean Hunt6cf75022010-08-30 17:47:05 +00001150 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
Douglas Gregor5cee1192011-07-27 05:40:30 +00001151 Kind, Literal.Pascal, StrTy,
Sean Hunt6cf75022010-08-30 17:47:05 +00001152 &StringTokLocs[0],
1153 StringTokLocs.size()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001154}
1155
John McCall469a1eb2011-02-02 13:00:07 +00001156enum CaptureResult {
1157 /// No capture is required.
1158 CR_NoCapture,
1159
1160 /// A capture is required.
1161 CR_Capture,
1162
John McCall6b5a61b2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00001163 /// A by-ref capture is required.
1164 CR_CaptureByRef,
1165
John McCall469a1eb2011-02-02 13:00:07 +00001166 /// An error occurred when trying to capture the given variable.
1167 CR_Error
1168};
1169
1170/// Diagnose an uncapturable value reference.
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001171///
John McCall469a1eb2011-02-02 13:00:07 +00001172/// \param var - the variable referenced
1173/// \param DC - the context which we couldn't capture through
1174static CaptureResult
John McCall6b5a61b2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00001175diagnoseUncapturableValueReference(Sema &S, SourceLocation loc,
John McCall469a1eb2011-02-02 13:00:07 +00001176 VarDecl *var, DeclContext *DC) {
1177 switch (S.ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
1178 case Sema::Unevaluated:
1179 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
1180 return CR_NoCapture;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001181
John McCall469a1eb2011-02-02 13:00:07 +00001182 case Sema::PotentiallyEvaluated:
1183 case Sema::PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
1184 break;
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001185
John McCall469a1eb2011-02-02 13:00:07 +00001186 case Sema::PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
1187 // FIXME: delay these!
1188 break;
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +00001189 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001190
John McCall469a1eb2011-02-02 13:00:07 +00001191 // Don't diagnose about capture if we're not actually in code right
1192 // now; in general, there are more appropriate places that will
1193 // diagnose this.
1194 if (!S.CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod()) return CR_NoCapture;
1195
John McCall4f38f412011-03-22 23:15:50 +00001196 // Certain madnesses can happen with parameter declarations, which
1197 // we want to ignore.
1198 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(var)) {
1199 // - If the parameter still belongs to the translation unit, then
1200 // we're actually just using one parameter in the declaration of
1201 // the next. This is useful in e.g. VLAs.
1202 if (isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(var->getDeclContext()))
1203 return CR_NoCapture;
1204
1205 // - This particular madness can happen in ill-formed default
1206 // arguments; claim it's okay and let downstream code handle it.
1207 if (S.CurContext == var->getDeclContext()->getParent())
1208 return CR_NoCapture;
1209 }
John McCall469a1eb2011-02-02 13:00:07 +00001210
1211 DeclarationName functionName;
1212 if (FunctionDecl *fn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(var->getDeclContext()))
1213 functionName = fn->getDeclName();
1214 // FIXME: variable from enclosing block that we couldn't capture from!
1215
1216 S.Diag(loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
1217 << var->getIdentifier() << functionName;
1218 S.Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
1219 << var->getIdentifier();
1220
1221 return CR_Error;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001222}
1223
John McCall6b5a61b2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00001224/// There is a well-formed capture at a particular scope level;
1225/// propagate it through all the nested blocks.
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00001226static CaptureResult propagateCapture(Sema &S, unsigned ValidScopeIndex,
1227 const BlockDecl::Capture &Capture) {
1228 VarDecl *var = Capture.getVariable();
John McCall6b5a61b2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00001229
1230 // Update all the inner blocks with the capture information.
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00001231 for (unsigned i = ValidScopeIndex + 1, e = S.FunctionScopes.size();
John McCall6b5a61b2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00001232 i != e; ++i) {
1233 BlockScopeInfo *innerBlock = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[i]);
1234 innerBlock->Captures.push_back(
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00001235 BlockDecl::Capture(Capture.getVariable(), Capture.isByRef(),
1236 /*nested*/ true, Capture.getCopyExpr()));
John McCall6b5a61b2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00001237 innerBlock->CaptureMap[var] = innerBlock->Captures.size(); // +1
1238 }
1239
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00001240 return Capture.isByRef() ? CR_CaptureByRef : CR_Capture;
John McCall6b5a61b2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00001241}
1242
1243/// shouldCaptureValueReference - Determine if a reference to the
John McCall469a1eb2011-02-02 13:00:07 +00001244/// given value in the current context requires a variable capture.
1245///
1246/// This also keeps the captures set in the BlockScopeInfo records
1247/// up-to-date.
John McCall6b5a61b2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00001248static CaptureResult shouldCaptureValueReference(Sema &S, SourceLocation loc,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00001249 ValueDecl *Value) {
John McCall469a1eb2011-02-02 13:00:07 +00001250 // Only variables ever require capture.
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00001251 VarDecl *var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Value);
John McCall76a40212011-02-09 01:13:10 +00001252 if (!var) return CR_NoCapture;
John McCall469a1eb2011-02-02 13:00:07 +00001253
1254 // Fast path: variables from the current context never require capture.
1255 DeclContext *DC = S.CurContext;
1256 if (var->getDeclContext() == DC) return CR_NoCapture;
1257
1258 // Only variables with local storage require capture.
1259 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
1260 if (!var->hasLocalStorage()) return CR_NoCapture;
1261
1262 // Otherwise, we need to capture.
1263
1264 unsigned functionScopesIndex = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1;
John McCall469a1eb2011-02-02 13:00:07 +00001265 do {
1266 // Only blocks (and eventually C++0x closures) can capture; other
1267 // scopes don't work.
1268 if (!isa<BlockDecl>(DC))
John McCall6b5a61b2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00001269 return diagnoseUncapturableValueReference(S, loc, var, DC);
John McCall469a1eb2011-02-02 13:00:07 +00001270
1271 BlockScopeInfo *blockScope =
1272 cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[functionScopesIndex]);
1273 assert(blockScope->TheDecl == static_cast<BlockDecl*>(DC));
1274
John McCall6b5a61b2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00001275 // Check whether we've already captured it in this block. If so,
1276 // we're done.
1277 if (unsigned indexPlus1 = blockScope->CaptureMap[var])
1278 return propagateCapture(S, functionScopesIndex,
1279 blockScope->Captures[indexPlus1 - 1]);
John McCall469a1eb2011-02-02 13:00:07 +00001280
1281 functionScopesIndex--;
1282 DC = cast<BlockDecl>(DC)->getDeclContext();
1283 } while (var->getDeclContext() != DC);
1284
John McCall6b5a61b2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00001285 // Okay, we descended all the way to the block that defines the variable.
1286 // Actually try to capture it.
1287 QualType type = var->getType();
1288
1289 // Prohibit variably-modified types.
1290 if (type->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
1291 S.Diag(loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
1292 S.Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1293 return CR_Error;
1294 }
1295
1296 // Prohibit arrays, even in __block variables, but not references to
1297 // them.
1298 if (type->isArrayType()) {
1299 S.Diag(loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
1300 S.Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1301 return CR_Error;
1302 }
1303
1304 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(loc, var);
1305
1306 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
1307 bool byRef = var->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>();
1308
1309 // Build a copy expression.
1310 Expr *copyExpr = 0;
John McCall642a75f2011-04-28 02:15:35 +00001311 const RecordType *rtype;
1312 if (!byRef && S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !type->isDependentType() &&
1313 (rtype = type->getAs<RecordType>())) {
1314
1315 // The capture logic needs the destructor, so make sure we mark it.
1316 // Usually this is unnecessary because most local variables have
1317 // their destructors marked at declaration time, but parameters are
1318 // an exception because it's technically only the call site that
1319 // actually requires the destructor.
1320 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(var))
1321 S.FinalizeVarWithDestructor(var, rtype);
1322
John McCall6b5a61b2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00001323 // According to the blocks spec, the capture of a variable from
1324 // the stack requires a const copy constructor. This is not true
1325 // of the copy/move done to move a __block variable to the heap.
1326 type.addConst();
1327
1328 Expr *declRef = new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(var, type, VK_LValue, loc);
1329 ExprResult result =
1330 S.PerformCopyInitialization(
1331 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(var->getLocation(),
1332 type, false),
1333 loc, S.Owned(declRef));
1334
1335 // Build a full-expression copy expression if initialization
1336 // succeeded and used a non-trivial constructor. Recover from
1337 // errors by pretending that the copy isn't necessary.
1338 if (!result.isInvalid() &&
1339 !cast<CXXConstructExpr>(result.get())->getConstructor()->isTrivial()) {
1340 result = S.MaybeCreateExprWithCleanups(result);
1341 copyExpr = result.take();
1342 }
1343 }
1344
1345 // We're currently at the declarer; go back to the closure.
1346 functionScopesIndex++;
1347 BlockScopeInfo *blockScope =
1348 cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[functionScopesIndex]);
1349
1350 // Build a valid capture in this scope.
1351 blockScope->Captures.push_back(
1352 BlockDecl::Capture(var, byRef, /*nested*/ false, copyExpr));
1353 blockScope->CaptureMap[var] = blockScope->Captures.size(); // +1
1354
1355 // Propagate that to inner captures if necessary.
1356 return propagateCapture(S, functionScopesIndex,
1357 blockScope->Captures.back());
1358}
1359
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00001360static ExprResult BuildBlockDeclRefExpr(Sema &S, ValueDecl *VD,
John McCall6b5a61b2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00001361 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00001362 bool ByRef) {
1363 assert(isa<VarDecl>(VD) && "capturing non-variable");
John McCall6b5a61b2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00001364
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00001365 VarDecl *var = cast<VarDecl>(VD);
John McCall6b5a61b2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00001366 assert(var->hasLocalStorage() && "capturing non-local");
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00001367 assert(ByRef == var->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() && "byref set wrong");
John McCall6b5a61b2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00001368
1369 QualType exprType = var->getType().getNonReferenceType();
1370
1371 BlockDeclRefExpr *BDRE;
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00001372 if (!ByRef) {
John McCall6b5a61b2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00001373 // The variable will be bound by copy; make it const within the
1374 // closure, but record that this was done in the expression.
1375 bool constAdded = !exprType.isConstQualified();
1376 exprType.addConst();
1377
1378 BDRE = new (S.Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(var, exprType, VK_LValue,
1379 NameInfo.getLoc(), false,
1380 constAdded);
1381 } else {
1382 BDRE = new (S.Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(var, exprType, VK_LValue,
1383 NameInfo.getLoc(), true);
1384 }
1385
1386 return S.Owned(BDRE);
John McCall469a1eb2011-02-02 13:00:07 +00001387}
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001388
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001389ExprResult
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00001390Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, ExprValueKind VK,
John McCall76a40212011-02-09 01:13:10 +00001391 SourceLocation Loc,
1392 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001393 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(D->getDeclName(), Loc);
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00001394 return BuildDeclRefExpr(D, Ty, VK, NameInfo, SS);
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001395}
1396
John McCall76a40212011-02-09 01:13:10 +00001397/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build an expression that references a
1398/// declaration that does not require a closure capture.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001399ExprResult
John McCall76a40212011-02-09 01:13:10 +00001400Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, ExprValueKind VK,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001401 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
1402 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Peter Collingbourne78dd67e2011-10-02 23:49:40 +00001403 if (getLangOptions().CUDA)
1404 if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext))
1405 if (const FunctionDecl *Callee = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1406 CUDAFunctionTarget CallerTarget = IdentifyCUDATarget(Caller),
1407 CalleeTarget = IdentifyCUDATarget(Callee);
1408 if (CheckCUDATarget(CallerTarget, CalleeTarget)) {
1409 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_ref_bad_target)
1410 << CalleeTarget << D->getIdentifier() << CallerTarget;
1411 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
1412 << D->getIdentifier();
1413 return ExprError();
1414 }
1415 }
1416
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001417 MarkDeclarationReferenced(NameInfo.getLoc(), D);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001418
John McCall7eb0a9e2010-11-24 05:12:34 +00001419 Expr *E = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor40d96a62011-02-28 21:54:11 +00001420 SS? SS->getWithLocInContext(Context)
1421 : NestedNameSpecifierLoc(),
John McCall7eb0a9e2010-11-24 05:12:34 +00001422 D, NameInfo, Ty, VK);
1423
1424 // Just in case we're building an illegal pointer-to-member.
Richard Smitha6b8b2c2011-10-10 18:28:20 +00001425 FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(D);
1426 if (FD && FD->isBitField())
John McCall7eb0a9e2010-11-24 05:12:34 +00001427 E->setObjectKind(OK_BitField);
1428
1429 return Owned(E);
Douglas Gregor1a49af92009-01-06 05:10:23 +00001430}
1431
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001432/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationNameInfo, its location, and
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001433/// possibly a list of template arguments.
1434///
1435/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
1436/// DecomposeTemplateName.
1437///
1438/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
1439/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
1440/// some way.
Richard Trieu67e29332011-08-02 04:35:43 +00001441void
1442Sema::DecomposeUnqualifiedId(const UnqualifiedId &Id,
1443 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
1444 DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
1445 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001446 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
1447 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
1448 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
1449
Douglas Gregor2b1ad8b2011-06-23 00:49:38 +00001450 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(*this,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001451 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
1452 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor2b1ad8b2011-06-23 00:49:38 +00001453 translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001454 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
1455
John McCall2b5289b2010-08-23 07:28:44 +00001456 TemplateName TName = Id.TemplateId->Template.get();
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001457 SourceLocation TNameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
Douglas Gregor2b1ad8b2011-06-23 00:49:38 +00001458 NameInfo = Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001459 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
1460 } else {
Douglas Gregor2b1ad8b2011-06-23 00:49:38 +00001461 NameInfo = GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001462 TemplateArgs = 0;
1463 }
1464}
1465
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001466/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
1467///
1468/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +00001469bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
Kaelyn Uhrainace5e762011-08-05 00:09:52 +00001470 CorrectTypoContext CTC,
1471 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
1472 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001473 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
1474
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001475 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001476 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001477 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
1478 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001479 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001480 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001481 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
1482 }
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001483
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001484 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
1485 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
1486 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
1487 // dependent name.
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +00001488 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty() ? CurContext : 0;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001489 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001490 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
1491 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1492
1493 if (!R.empty()) {
1494 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
1495 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1496
1497 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
1498 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
1499 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
1500 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
1501
1502 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
1503 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
1504 // Actually quite difficult!
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +00001505 if (isInstance) {
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +00001506 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(
1507 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->getCallee());
Nick Lewyckyd9ca4ab2010-08-20 20:54:15 +00001508 CXXMethodDecl *DepMethod = cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +00001509 CurMethod->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction());
Eli Friedmana7e68452010-08-22 01:00:03 +00001510 if (DepMethod) {
Francois Pichet62ec1f22011-09-17 17:15:52 +00001511 if (getLangOptions().MicrosoftExt)
Francois Pichet0f74d1e2011-09-07 00:14:57 +00001512 diagnostic = diag::warn_found_via_dependent_bases_lookup;
Nick Lewyckyd9ca4ab2010-08-20 20:54:15 +00001513 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
1514 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
1515 QualType DepThisType = DepMethod->getThisType(Context);
1516 CXXThisExpr *DepThis = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(
1517 R.getNameLoc(), DepThisType, false);
1518 TemplateArgumentListInfo TList;
1519 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
1520 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TList);
Douglas Gregor7c3179c2011-02-28 18:50:33 +00001521
Douglas Gregor7c3179c2011-02-28 18:50:33 +00001522 CXXScopeSpec SS;
Douglas Gregor4c9be892011-02-28 20:01:57 +00001523 SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc());
Nick Lewyckyd9ca4ab2010-08-20 20:54:15 +00001524 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr *DepExpr =
1525 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(
1526 Context, DepThis, DepThisType, true, SourceLocation(),
Douglas Gregor7c3179c2011-02-28 18:50:33 +00001527 SS.getWithLocInContext(Context), NULL,
Francois Pichetf7400122011-09-04 23:00:48 +00001528 R.getLookupNameInfo(),
1529 ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() ? &TList : 0);
Nick Lewyckyd9ca4ab2010-08-20 20:54:15 +00001530 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->setCallee(DepExpr);
Eli Friedmana7e68452010-08-22 01:00:03 +00001531 } else {
Nick Lewyckyd9ca4ab2010-08-20 20:54:15 +00001532 // FIXME: we should be able to handle this case too. It is correct
1533 // to add this-> here. This is a workaround for PR7947.
1534 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Eli Friedmana7e68452010-08-22 01:00:03 +00001535 }
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +00001536 } else {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001537 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +00001538 }
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001539
1540 // Do we really want to note all of these?
1541 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
1542 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
1543
1544 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
1545 return false;
1546 }
Douglas Gregore26f0432010-08-09 22:38:14 +00001547
1548 R.clear();
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001549 }
1550 }
1551
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001552 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregord8bba9c2011-06-28 16:20:02 +00001553 TypoCorrection Corrected;
1554 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R.getLookupNameInfo(), R.getLookupKind(),
1555 S, &SS, NULL, false, CTC))) {
1556 std::string CorrectedStr(Corrected.getAsString(getLangOptions()));
1557 std::string CorrectedQuotedStr(Corrected.getQuoted(getLangOptions()));
1558 R.setLookupName(Corrected.getCorrection());
1559
Hans Wennborg701d1e72011-07-12 08:45:31 +00001560 if (NamedDecl *ND = Corrected.getCorrectionDecl()) {
Kaelyn Uhrainf0c1d8f2011-08-03 20:36:05 +00001561 if (Corrected.isOverloaded()) {
1562 OverloadCandidateSet OCS(R.getNameLoc());
1563 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
1564 for (TypoCorrection::decl_iterator CD = Corrected.begin(),
1565 CDEnd = Corrected.end();
1566 CD != CDEnd; ++CD) {
Kaelyn Uhrainadc7a732011-08-08 17:35:31 +00001567 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD =
Kaelyn Uhrainace5e762011-08-05 00:09:52 +00001568 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*CD))
1569 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(
1570 FTD, DeclAccessPair::make(FTD, AS_none), ExplicitTemplateArgs,
1571 Args, NumArgs, OCS);
Kaelyn Uhrainadc7a732011-08-08 17:35:31 +00001572 else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*CD))
1573 if (!ExplicitTemplateArgs || ExplicitTemplateArgs->size() == 0)
1574 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, DeclAccessPair::make(FD, AS_none),
1575 Args, NumArgs, OCS);
Kaelyn Uhrainf0c1d8f2011-08-03 20:36:05 +00001576 }
1577 switch (OCS.BestViableFunction(*this, R.getNameLoc(), Best)) {
1578 case OR_Success:
1579 ND = Best->Function;
1580 break;
1581 default:
Kaelyn Uhrain844d5722011-08-04 23:30:54 +00001582 break;
Kaelyn Uhrainf0c1d8f2011-08-03 20:36:05 +00001583 }
1584 }
Douglas Gregord8bba9c2011-06-28 16:20:02 +00001585 R.addDecl(ND);
1586 if (isa<ValueDecl>(ND) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(ND)) {
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001587 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregord8bba9c2011-06-28 16:20:02 +00001588 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << CorrectedQuotedStr
1589 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(), CorrectedStr);
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001590 else
1591 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregord8bba9c2011-06-28 16:20:02 +00001592 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << CorrectedQuotedStr
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001593 << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregord8bba9c2011-06-28 16:20:02 +00001594 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(), CorrectedStr);
1595 if (ND)
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001596 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Douglas Gregord8bba9c2011-06-28 16:20:02 +00001597 << CorrectedQuotedStr;
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001598
1599 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
1600 return false;
1601 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001602
Douglas Gregord8bba9c2011-06-28 16:20:02 +00001603 if (isa<TypeDecl>(ND) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(ND)) {
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001604 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
1605 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
1606 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
1607 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
1608 // to recover well anyway.
1609 if (SS.isEmpty())
Richard Trieu67e29332011-08-02 04:35:43 +00001610 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest)
1611 << Name << CorrectedQuotedStr;
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001612 else
1613 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregord8bba9c2011-06-28 16:20:02 +00001614 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << CorrectedQuotedStr
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001615 << SS.getRange();
1616
1617 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
1618 return true;
1619 }
1620 } else {
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001621 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001622 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001623 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregord8bba9c2011-06-28 16:20:02 +00001624 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << CorrectedQuotedStr;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001625 else
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001626 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregord8bba9c2011-06-28 16:20:02 +00001627 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << CorrectedQuotedStr
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001628 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001629 return true;
1630 }
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001631 }
Douglas Gregord8bba9c2011-06-28 16:20:02 +00001632 R.clear();
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001633
1634 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
1635 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
1636 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
1637 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1638 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
1639 << SS.getRange();
1640 return true;
1641 }
1642
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001643 // Give up, we can't recover.
1644 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1645 return true;
1646}
1647
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001648ExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
John McCallfb97e752010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001649 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1650 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1651 bool HasTrailingLParen,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00001652 bool IsAddressOfOperand) {
1653 assert(!(IsAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001654 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1655
1656 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor4c921ae2009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001657 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor5953d8b2009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001658
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001659 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001660
1661 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001662 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001663 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
Douglas Gregor2b1ad8b2011-06-23 00:49:38 +00001664 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Id, TemplateArgsBuffer, NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor5953d8b2009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001665
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001666 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
Douglas Gregor10c42622008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001667 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001668 SourceLocation NameLoc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001669
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001670 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1671 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregor48026d22010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001672 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1673 // (note: handled after lookup)
1674 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1675 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1676 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001677 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1678 // names a dependent type.
1679 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1680 // we need to handle these differently.
Eli Friedman647c8b32010-08-06 23:41:47 +00001681 bool DependentID = false;
1682 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1683 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) {
1684 DependentID = true;
1685 } else if (SS.isSet()) {
Chris Lattner337e5502011-02-18 01:27:55 +00001686 if (DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) {
Eli Friedman647c8b32010-08-06 23:41:47 +00001687 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
1688 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman647c8b32010-08-06 23:41:47 +00001689 } else {
1690 DependentID = true;
1691 }
1692 }
1693
Chris Lattner337e5502011-02-18 01:27:55 +00001694 if (DependentID)
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00001695 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, NameInfo, IsAddressOfOperand,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001696 TemplateArgs);
Chris Lattner337e5502011-02-18 01:27:55 +00001697
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001698 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = false;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001699 // Perform the required lookup.
Fariborz Jahanian98a54032011-07-12 17:16:56 +00001700 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo,
1701 (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_ImplicitSelfParam)
1702 ? LookupObjCImplicitSelfParam : LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001703 if (TemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregord2235f62010-05-20 20:58:56 +00001704 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
1705 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
1706 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
1707 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
1708 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
Douglas Gregor1fd6d442010-05-21 23:18:07 +00001709 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
1710 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false,
1711 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization);
Douglas Gregor2f9f89c2011-02-04 13:35:07 +00001712
1713 if (MemberOfUnknownSpecialization ||
1714 (R.getResultKind() == LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation))
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00001715 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, NameInfo, IsAddressOfOperand,
Douglas Gregor2f9f89c2011-02-04 13:35:07 +00001716 TemplateArgs);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001717 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001718 IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001719 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001720
Douglas Gregor2f9f89c2011-02-04 13:35:07 +00001721 // If the result might be in a dependent base class, this is a dependent
1722 // id-expression.
1723 if (R.getResultKind() == LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation)
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00001724 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, NameInfo, IsAddressOfOperand,
Douglas Gregor2f9f89c2011-02-04 13:35:07 +00001725 TemplateArgs);
1726
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001727 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1728 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001729 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001730 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001731 if (E.isInvalid())
1732 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001733
Chris Lattner337e5502011-02-18 01:27:55 +00001734 if (Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>())
1735 return Owned(Ex);
1736
Fariborz Jahanianf759b4d2010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001737 // for further use, this must be set to false if in class method.
1738 IvarLookupFollowUp = getCurMethodDecl()->isInstanceMethod();
Steve Naroffe3e9add2008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001739 }
Chris Lattner8a934232008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001740 }
Douglas Gregorc71e28c2009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001741
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001742 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1743 return ExprError();
1744
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001745 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1746 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001747 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001748
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001749 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001750 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001751 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1752 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1753 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1754 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1755 }
1756
1757 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1758 // call, diagnose the problem.
1759 if (R.empty()) {
Francois Pichetfce1a3a2011-09-24 10:38:05 +00001760
1761 // In Microsoft mode, if we are inside a template class member function
1762 // and we can't resolve an identifier then assume the identifier is type
1763 // dependent. The goal is to postpone name lookup to instantiation time
1764 // to be able to search into type dependent base classes.
1765 if (getLangOptions().MicrosoftMode && CurContext->isDependentContext() &&
1766 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext))
1767 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, NameInfo, IsAddressOfOperand,
1768 TemplateArgs);
1769
Douglas Gregor91f7ac72010-05-18 16:14:23 +00001770 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CTC_Unknown))
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001771 return ExprError();
1772
1773 assert(!R.empty() &&
1774 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001775
1776 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1777 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001778 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001779 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1780 R.clear();
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001781 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
Fariborz Jahanianbc2b91a2011-09-23 23:11:38 +00001782 // In a hopelessly buggy code, Objective-C instance variable
1783 // lookup fails and no expression will be built to reference it.
1784 if (!E.isInvalid() && !E.get())
1785 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001786 return move(E);
1787 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001788 }
1789 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001790
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001791 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1792 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1793
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001794 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
John McCallfb97e752010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001795 // C++ [class.mfct.non-static]p3:
1796 // When an id-expression that is not part of a class member access
1797 // syntax and not used to form a pointer to member is used in the
1798 // body of a non-static member function of class X, if name lookup
1799 // resolves the name in the id-expression to a non-static non-type
1800 // member of some class C, the id-expression is transformed into a
1801 // class member access expression using (*this) as the
1802 // postfix-expression to the left of the . operator.
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001803 //
1804 // But we don't actually need to do this for '&' operands if R
1805 // resolved to a function or overloaded function set, because the
1806 // expression is ill-formed if it actually works out to be a
1807 // non-static member function:
1808 //
1809 // C++ [expr.ref]p4:
1810 // Otherwise, if E1.E2 refers to a non-static member function. . .
1811 // [t]he expression can be used only as the left-hand operand of a
1812 // member function call.
1813 //
1814 // There are other safeguards against such uses, but it's important
1815 // to get this right here so that we don't end up making a
1816 // spuriously dependent expression if we're inside a dependent
1817 // instance method.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001818 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001819 bool MightBeImplicitMember;
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00001820 if (!IsAddressOfOperand)
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001821 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
1822 else if (!SS.isEmpty())
1823 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
1824 else if (R.isOverloadedResult())
1825 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
Douglas Gregore2248be2010-08-30 16:00:47 +00001826 else if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
1827 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001828 else
Francois Pichet87c2e122010-11-21 06:08:52 +00001829 MightBeImplicitMember = isa<FieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl()) ||
1830 isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl());
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001831
1832 if (MightBeImplicitMember)
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001833 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001834 }
1835
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001836 if (TemplateArgs)
1837 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001838
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001839 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1840}
1841
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001842/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1843/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1844/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1845/// this path.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001846ExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001847Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001848 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001849 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregore6ec5c42010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001850 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001851 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, NameInfo, 0);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001852
John McCall77bb1aa2010-05-01 00:40:08 +00001853 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
Douglas Gregore6ec5c42010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001854 return ExprError();
1855
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001856 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001857 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1858
1859 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1860 return ExprError();
1861
1862 if (R.empty()) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001863 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1864 << NameInfo.getName() << DC << SS.getRange();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001865 return ExprError();
1866 }
1867
1868 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1869}
1870
1871/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1872/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1873/// additional lookup.
1874///
1875/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1876/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1877///
1878/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001879ExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001880Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnereb483eb2010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001881 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001882 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001883 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001884
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001885 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1886 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1887 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1888 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1889 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1890
1891 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1892 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1893 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001894 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001895
1896 bool LookForIvars;
1897 if (Lookup.empty())
1898 LookForIvars = true;
1899 else if (IsClassMethod)
1900 LookForIvars = false;
1901 else
1902 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1903 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian412e7982010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001904 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001905 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001906 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001907 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1908 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1909 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1910 if (IsClassMethod)
1911 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1912 << IV->getDeclName());
1913
1914 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1915 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1916 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1917 return ExprError();
1918
1919 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1920 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1921 return ExprError();
1922
1923 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1924 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1925 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1926 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1927
1928 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1929 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1930 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1931 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001932 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
Fariborz Jahanian98a54032011-07-12 17:16:56 +00001933 SelfName.setKind(UnqualifiedId::IK_ImplicitSelfParam);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001934 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001935 ExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
Douglas Gregore45bb6a2010-09-22 16:33:13 +00001936 SelfName, false, false);
1937 if (SelfExpr.isInvalid())
1938 return ExprError();
1939
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00001940 SelfExpr = DefaultLvalueConversion(SelfExpr.take());
1941 if (SelfExpr.isInvalid())
1942 return ExprError();
John McCall409fa9a2010-12-06 20:48:59 +00001943
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001944 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1945 return Owned(new (Context)
1946 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00001947 SelfExpr.take(), true, true));
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001948 }
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001949 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001950 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001951 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001952 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1953 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1954 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1955 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1956 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1957 }
1958 }
1959
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001960 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1961 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1962 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1963 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1964 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1965 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1966 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1967 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1968 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1969 }
1970 }
1971 }
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001972 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1973 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001974}
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001975
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001976/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1977///
1978/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1979///
1980/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1981/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1982/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1983/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1984///
1985/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1986/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1987/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1988/// the class declaring the member.
1989///
1990/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1991/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1992/// obey access control.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00001993ExprResult
1994Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *From,
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001995 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001996 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001997 NamedDecl *Member) {
1998 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1999 if (!RD)
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00002000 return Owned(From);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002001
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00002002 QualType DestRecordType;
2003 QualType DestType;
2004 QualType FromRecordType;
2005 QualType FromType = From->getType();
2006 bool PointerConversions = false;
2007 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
2008 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002009
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00002010 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2011 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
2012 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
2013 PointerConversions = true;
2014 } else {
2015 DestType = DestRecordType;
2016 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanian98a541e2009-07-29 18:40:24 +00002017 }
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00002018 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
2019 if (Method->isStatic())
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00002020 return Owned(From);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002021
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00002022 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
2023 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002024
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00002025 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2026 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
2027 PointerConversions = true;
2028 } else {
2029 FromRecordType = FromType;
2030 DestType = DestRecordType;
2031 }
2032 } else {
2033 // No conversion necessary.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00002034 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00002035 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002036
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00002037 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00002038 return Owned(From);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002039
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00002040 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
2041 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00002042 return Owned(From);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002043
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002044 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
2045 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
2046
Eli Friedmanc1c0dfb2011-09-27 21:58:52 +00002047 ExprValueKind VK = From->getValueKind();
Sebastian Redl906082e2010-07-20 04:20:21 +00002048
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00002049 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002050 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00002051 // class name.
2052 //
2053 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
2054 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
2055 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
2056 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
2057 //
2058 // class Base { public: int x; };
2059 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
2060 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
2061 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
2062 //
2063 // void VeryDerived::f() {
2064 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
2065 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
2066 // }
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00002067 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002068 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
2069 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
2070 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
2071
2072 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
2073
2074 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
2075 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
2076 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
2077 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00002078 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002079 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00002080 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00002081 return ExprError();
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002082
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00002083 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002084 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00002085 From = ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
2086 VK, &BasePath).take();
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002087
2088 FromType = QType;
2089 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
2090
2091 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
2092 // we're done.
2093 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00002094 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00002095 }
2096 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002097
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002098 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00002099
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002100 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
2101 // down to the using declaration's type.
2102 //
2103 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
2104 // class ever has member declarations.
2105 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
2106 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
2107 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
2108 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
2109
2110 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
2111 // conversion is non-trivial.
2112 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
2113 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00002114 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002115 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00002116 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00002117 return ExprError();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002118
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002119 QualType UType = URecordType;
2120 if (PointerConversions)
2121 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00002122 From = ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
2123 VK, &BasePath).take();
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002124 FromType = UType;
2125 FromRecordType = URecordType;
2126 }
2127
2128 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
2129 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
2130 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00002131 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002132
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00002133 CXXCastPath BasePath;
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00002134 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
2135 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002136 IgnoreAccess))
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00002137 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002138
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00002139 return ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
2140 VK, &BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanian98a541e2009-07-29 18:40:24 +00002141}
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00002142
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00002143bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00002144 const LookupResult &R,
2145 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002146 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
2147 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
2148 return false;
2149
2150 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00002151 if (SS.isSet())
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002152 return false;
2153
2154 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00002155 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002156 return false;
2157
2158 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
2159 // normal lookup:
2160 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
2161 NamedDecl *D = *I;
2162
2163 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
2164 // -- a declaration of a class member
2165 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
2166 // original decl.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00002167 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002168 return false;
2169
2170 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
2171 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
2172 // using-declaration
2173 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
2174 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
2175 // turn off ADL anyway).
2176 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
2177 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
2178 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
2179 return false;
2180
2181 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
2182 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
2183 // template
2184 // And also for builtin functions.
2185 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
2186 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
2187
2188 // But also builtin functions.
2189 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
2190 return false;
2191 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
2192 return false;
2193 }
2194
2195 return true;
2196}
2197
2198
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002199/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
2200/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
2201/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
2202/// will in fact be used.
2203static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
Richard Smith162e1c12011-04-15 14:24:37 +00002204 if (isa<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) {
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002205 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
2206 return true;
2207 }
2208
2209 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
2210 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
2211 return true;
2212 }
2213
2214 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
2215 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
2216 return true;
2217 }
2218
2219 return false;
2220}
2221
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002222ExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00002223Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00002224 LookupResult &R,
2225 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCallfead20c2009-12-08 22:45:53 +00002226 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
2227 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor86b8e092010-01-29 17:15:43 +00002228 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002229 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(),
2230 R.getFoundDecl());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002231
2232 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
2233 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
2234 // functions and function templates.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00002235 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
2236 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002237 return ExprError();
2238
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002239 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
2240 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
2241 // we've picked a target.
2242 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2243
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002244 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
Douglas Gregorbebbe0d2010-12-15 01:34:56 +00002245 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, R.getNamingClass(),
Douglas Gregor4c9be892011-02-28 20:01:57 +00002246 SS.getWithLocInContext(Context),
2247 R.getLookupNameInfo(),
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00002248 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(),
2249 R.begin(), R.end());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002250
2251 return Owned(ULE);
2252}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002253
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002254/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002255ExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00002256Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002257 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
2258 NamedDecl *D) {
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002259 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall7453ed42009-11-22 00:44:51 +00002260 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
2261 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002262
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002263 SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002264 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
2265 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002266
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00002267 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
2268 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
2269 // a template argument list.
2270 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
2271 << Template << SS.getRange();
2272 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
2273 return ExprError();
2274 }
2275
2276 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
2277 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
2278 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002279 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00002280 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCall87cf6702009-12-18 18:35:10 +00002281 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00002282 return ExprError();
2283 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002284
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00002285 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
2286 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
2287 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
2288 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002289 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00002290 return ExprError();
2291
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00002292 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
2293 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002294 return ExprError();
2295
John McCall5808ce42011-02-03 08:15:49 +00002296 // Handle members of anonymous structs and unions. If we got here,
2297 // and the reference is to a class member indirect field, then this
2298 // must be the subject of a pointer-to-member expression.
2299 if (IndirectFieldDecl *indirectField = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(VD))
2300 if (!indirectField->isCXXClassMember())
2301 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SS, NameInfo.getLoc(),
2302 indirectField);
Francois Pichet87c2e122010-11-21 06:08:52 +00002303
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00002304 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
2305 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
2306 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
2307 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00002308 //
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00002309 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
2310 // as they do not get snapshotted.
2311 //
John McCall6b5a61b2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00002312 switch (shouldCaptureValueReference(*this, NameInfo.getLoc(), VD)) {
John McCall469a1eb2011-02-02 13:00:07 +00002313 case CR_Error:
2314 return ExprError();
Mike Stump0d6fd572010-01-05 02:56:35 +00002315
John McCall469a1eb2011-02-02 13:00:07 +00002316 case CR_Capture:
John McCall6b5a61b2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00002317 assert(!SS.isSet() && "referenced local variable with scope specifier?");
2318 return BuildBlockDeclRefExpr(*this, VD, NameInfo, /*byref*/ false);
2319
2320 case CR_CaptureByRef:
2321 assert(!SS.isSet() && "referenced local variable with scope specifier?");
2322 return BuildBlockDeclRefExpr(*this, VD, NameInfo, /*byref*/ true);
John McCall76a40212011-02-09 01:13:10 +00002323
2324 case CR_NoCapture: {
2325 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced
2326 // variable is within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
2327
2328 QualType type = VD->getType();
Daniel Dunbarb20de812011-02-10 18:29:28 +00002329 ExprValueKind valueKind = VK_RValue;
John McCall76a40212011-02-09 01:13:10 +00002330
2331 switch (D->getKind()) {
2332 // Ignore all the non-ValueDecl kinds.
2333#define ABSTRACT_DECL(kind)
2334#define VALUE(type, base)
2335#define DECL(type, base) \
2336 case Decl::type:
2337#include "clang/AST/DeclNodes.inc"
2338 llvm_unreachable("invalid value decl kind");
2339 return ExprError();
2340
2341 // These shouldn't make it here.
2342 case Decl::ObjCAtDefsField:
2343 case Decl::ObjCIvar:
2344 llvm_unreachable("forming non-member reference to ivar?");
2345 return ExprError();
2346
2347 // Enum constants are always r-values and never references.
2348 // Unresolved using declarations are dependent.
2349 case Decl::EnumConstant:
2350 case Decl::UnresolvedUsingValue:
2351 valueKind = VK_RValue;
2352 break;
2353
2354 // Fields and indirect fields that got here must be for
2355 // pointer-to-member expressions; we just call them l-values for
2356 // internal consistency, because this subexpression doesn't really
2357 // exist in the high-level semantics.
2358 case Decl::Field:
2359 case Decl::IndirectField:
2360 assert(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
2361 "building reference to field in C?");
2362
2363 // These can't have reference type in well-formed programs, but
2364 // for internal consistency we do this anyway.
2365 type = type.getNonReferenceType();
2366 valueKind = VK_LValue;
2367 break;
2368
2369 // Non-type template parameters are either l-values or r-values
2370 // depending on the type.
2371 case Decl::NonTypeTemplateParm: {
2372 if (const ReferenceType *reftype = type->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
2373 type = reftype->getPointeeType();
2374 valueKind = VK_LValue; // even if the parameter is an r-value reference
2375 break;
2376 }
2377
2378 // For non-references, we need to strip qualifiers just in case
2379 // the template parameter was declared as 'const int' or whatever.
2380 valueKind = VK_RValue;
2381 type = type.getUnqualifiedType();
2382 break;
2383 }
2384
2385 case Decl::Var:
2386 // In C, "extern void blah;" is valid and is an r-value.
2387 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
2388 !type.hasQualifiers() &&
2389 type->isVoidType()) {
2390 valueKind = VK_RValue;
2391 break;
2392 }
2393 // fallthrough
2394
2395 case Decl::ImplicitParam:
2396 case Decl::ParmVar:
2397 // These are always l-values.
2398 valueKind = VK_LValue;
2399 type = type.getNonReferenceType();
2400 break;
2401
2402 case Decl::Function: {
John McCall755d8492011-04-12 00:42:48 +00002403 const FunctionType *fty = type->castAs<FunctionType>();
2404
2405 // If we're referring to a function with an __unknown_anytype
2406 // result type, make the entire expression __unknown_anytype.
2407 if (fty->getResultType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) {
2408 type = Context.UnknownAnyTy;
2409 valueKind = VK_RValue;
2410 break;
2411 }
2412
John McCall76a40212011-02-09 01:13:10 +00002413 // Functions are l-values in C++.
2414 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
2415 valueKind = VK_LValue;
2416 break;
2417 }
2418
2419 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
2420 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
2421 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
2422 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
2423 // type.
John McCall755d8492011-04-12 00:42:48 +00002424 if (!cast<FunctionDecl>(VD)->hasPrototype() &&
2425 isa<FunctionProtoType>(fty))
2426 type = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(fty->getResultType(),
2427 fty->getExtInfo());
John McCall76a40212011-02-09 01:13:10 +00002428
2429 // Functions are r-values in C.
2430 valueKind = VK_RValue;
2431 break;
2432 }
2433
2434 case Decl::CXXMethod:
John McCall755d8492011-04-12 00:42:48 +00002435 // If we're referring to a method with an __unknown_anytype
2436 // result type, make the entire expression __unknown_anytype.
2437 // This should only be possible with a type written directly.
Richard Trieu67e29332011-08-02 04:35:43 +00002438 if (const FunctionProtoType *proto
2439 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(VD->getType()))
John McCall755d8492011-04-12 00:42:48 +00002440 if (proto->getResultType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) {
2441 type = Context.UnknownAnyTy;
2442 valueKind = VK_RValue;
2443 break;
2444 }
2445
John McCall76a40212011-02-09 01:13:10 +00002446 // C++ methods are l-values if static, r-values if non-static.
2447 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(VD)->isStatic()) {
2448 valueKind = VK_LValue;
2449 break;
2450 }
2451 // fallthrough
2452
2453 case Decl::CXXConversion:
2454 case Decl::CXXDestructor:
2455 case Decl::CXXConstructor:
2456 valueKind = VK_RValue;
2457 break;
2458 }
2459
2460 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, type, valueKind, NameInfo, &SS);
2461 }
2462
John McCall469a1eb2011-02-02 13:00:07 +00002463 }
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00002464
John McCall6b5a61b2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00002465 llvm_unreachable("unknown capture result");
2466 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002467}
2468
John McCall755d8492011-04-12 00:42:48 +00002469ExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc, tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattnerd9f69102008-08-10 01:53:14 +00002470 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002471
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002472 switch (Kind) {
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00002473 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattnerd9f69102008-08-10 01:53:14 +00002474 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
2475 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
2476 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002477 }
Chris Lattner1423ea42008-01-12 18:39:25 +00002478
Chris Lattnerfa28b302008-01-12 08:14:25 +00002479 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
2480 // string.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002481
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00002482 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanianeb024ac2010-07-23 21:53:24 +00002483 if (!currentDecl && getCurBlock())
2484 currentDecl = getCurBlock()->TheDecl;
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00002485 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerb0da9232008-12-12 05:05:20 +00002486 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00002487 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerb0da9232008-12-12 05:05:20 +00002488 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002489
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00002490 QualType ResTy;
2491 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
2492 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
2493 } else {
Anders Carlsson848fa642010-02-11 18:20:28 +00002494 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002495
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00002496 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002497 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00002498 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
2499 }
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002500 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002501}
2502
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002503ExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002504 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregor453091c2010-03-16 22:30:13 +00002505 bool Invalid = false;
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00002506 StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
Douglas Gregor453091c2010-03-16 22:30:13 +00002507 if (Invalid)
2508 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002509
Benjamin Kramerddeea562010-02-27 13:44:12 +00002510 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
Douglas Gregor5cee1192011-07-27 05:40:30 +00002511 PP, Tok.getKind());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002512 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002513 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnerfc62bfd2008-03-01 08:32:21 +00002514
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00002515 QualType Ty;
2516 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
2517 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
2518 else if (Literal.isWide())
2519 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Douglas Gregor5cee1192011-07-27 05:40:30 +00002520 else if (Literal.isUTF16())
2521 Ty = Context.Char16Ty; // u'x' -> char16_t in C++0x.
2522 else if (Literal.isUTF32())
2523 Ty = Context.Char32Ty; // U'x' -> char32_t in C++0x.
Eli Friedman136b0cd2010-02-03 18:21:45 +00002524 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
2525 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00002526 else
2527 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattnerfc62bfd2008-03-01 08:32:21 +00002528
Douglas Gregor5cee1192011-07-27 05:40:30 +00002529 CharacterLiteral::CharacterKind Kind = CharacterLiteral::Ascii;
2530 if (Literal.isWide())
2531 Kind = CharacterLiteral::Wide;
2532 else if (Literal.isUTF16())
2533 Kind = CharacterLiteral::UTF16;
2534 else if (Literal.isUTF32())
2535 Kind = CharacterLiteral::UTF32;
2536
2537 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(), Kind, Ty,
2538 Tok.getLocation()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002539}
2540
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002541ExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002542 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002543 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
2544 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner7216dc92009-01-26 22:36:52 +00002545 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Douglas Gregorbcfd1f52011-09-02 00:18:52 +00002546 unsigned IntSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002547 return Owned(IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff0a473932009-01-20 19:53:53 +00002548 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002549 }
Ted Kremenek28396602009-01-13 23:19:12 +00002550
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002551 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattner2a299042008-09-30 20:53:45 +00002552 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
2553 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002554 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002555
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002556 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregor453091c2010-03-16 22:30:13 +00002557 bool Invalid = false;
2558 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
2559 if (Invalid)
2560 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002561
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002562 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002563 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
2564 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002565 return ExprError();
2566
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002567 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002568
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002569 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00002570 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002571 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00002572 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002573 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00002574 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002575 else
Chris Lattner9e9b6dc2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00002576 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002577
2578 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
2579
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002580 using llvm::APFloat;
2581 APFloat Val(Format);
2582
2583 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall9f2df882009-12-24 11:09:08 +00002584
2585 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
2586 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
2587 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
2588 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002589 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002590 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002591 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall2a0d7572010-02-26 23:35:57 +00002592 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002593 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
2594 } else {
John McCall2a0d7572010-02-26 23:35:57 +00002595 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002596 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
2597 }
2598
2599 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
2600 << Ty
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00002601 << StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002602 }
2603
2604 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002605 Res = FloatingLiteral::Create(Context, Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002606
Peter Collingbournef4f7cb82011-03-11 19:24:59 +00002607 if (Ty == Context.DoubleTy) {
2608 if (getLangOptions().SinglePrecisionConstants) {
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00002609 Res = ImpCastExprToType(Res, Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast).take();
Peter Collingbournef4f7cb82011-03-11 19:24:59 +00002610 } else if (getLangOptions().OpenCL && !getOpenCLOptions().cl_khr_fp64) {
2611 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_double_const_requires_fp64);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00002612 Res = ImpCastExprToType(Res, Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast).take();
Peter Collingbournef4f7cb82011-03-11 19:24:59 +00002613 }
2614 }
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002615 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002616 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002617 } else {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002618 QualType Ty;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002619
Neil Boothb9449512007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002620 // long long is a C99 feature.
2621 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth79859c32007-08-29 22:13:52 +00002622 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothb9449512007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002623 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
2624
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002625 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Douglas Gregorbcfd1f52011-09-02 00:18:52 +00002626 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.getTargetInfo().getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002627
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002628 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
2629 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
2630 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002631 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
2632 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002633 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002634 } else {
2635 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
2636 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002637
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002638 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
2639 // be an unsigned int.
2640 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
2641
2642 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002643 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner97c51562007-08-23 21:58:08 +00002644 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
2645 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Douglas Gregorbcfd1f52011-09-02 00:18:52 +00002646 unsigned IntSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002647
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002648 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
2649 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
2650 // Does it fit in a signed int?
2651 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002652 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002653 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002654 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002655 Width = IntSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002656 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002657 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002658
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002659 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002660 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Douglas Gregorbcfd1f52011-09-02 00:18:52 +00002661 unsigned LongSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002662
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002663 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
2664 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
2665 // Does it fit in a signed long?
2666 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002667 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002668 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002669 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002670 Width = LongSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002671 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002672 }
2673
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002674 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002675 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Douglas Gregorbcfd1f52011-09-02 00:18:52 +00002676 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002677
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002678 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
2679 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
2680 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
Francois Pichet24323202011-01-11 23:38:13 +00002681 // To be compatible with MSVC, hex integer literals ending with the
2682 // LL or i64 suffix are always signed in Microsoft mode.
Francois Picheta15a5ee2011-01-11 12:23:00 +00002683 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && (ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0 ||
Francois Pichet62ec1f22011-09-17 17:15:52 +00002684 (getLangOptions().MicrosoftExt && Literal.isLongLong)))
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002685 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002686 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002687 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002688 Width = LongLongSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002689 }
2690 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002691
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002692 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
2693 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002694 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002695 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002696 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Douglas Gregorbcfd1f52011-09-02 00:18:52 +00002697 Width = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002698 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002699
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002700 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
Jay Foad9f71a8f2010-12-07 08:25:34 +00002701 ResultVal = ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002702 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002703 Res = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002704 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002705
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002706 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
2707 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002708 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002709 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002710
2711 return Owned(Res);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002712}
2713
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00002714ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L, SourceLocation R, Expr *E) {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002715 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002716 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002717}
2718
Chandler Carruthdf1f3772011-05-26 08:53:12 +00002719static bool CheckVecStepTraitOperandType(Sema &S, QualType T,
2720 SourceLocation Loc,
2721 SourceRange ArgRange) {
2722 // [OpenCL 1.1 6.11.12] "The vec_step built-in function takes a built-in
2723 // scalar or vector data type argument..."
2724 // Every built-in scalar type (OpenCL 1.1 6.1.1) is either an arithmetic
2725 // type (C99 6.2.5p18) or void.
2726 if (!(T->isArithmeticType() || T->isVoidType() || T->isVectorType())) {
2727 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_vecstep_non_scalar_vector_type)
2728 << T << ArgRange;
2729 return true;
2730 }
2731
2732 assert((T->isVoidType() || !T->isIncompleteType()) &&
2733 "Scalar types should always be complete");
2734 return false;
2735}
2736
Chandler Carruth42ec65d2011-05-26 08:53:16 +00002737static bool CheckExtensionTraitOperandType(Sema &S, QualType T,
2738 SourceLocation Loc,
2739 SourceRange ArgRange,
2740 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait TraitKind) {
2741 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
2742 if (T->isFunctionType()) {
2743 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
2744 if (TraitKind == UETT_SizeOf)
2745 S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ArgRange;
2746 return false;
2747 }
2748
2749 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
2750 if (T->isVoidType()) {
2751 S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type) << TraitKind << ArgRange;
2752 return false;
2753 }
2754
2755 return true;
2756}
2757
2758static bool CheckObjCTraitOperandConstraints(Sema &S, QualType T,
2759 SourceLocation Loc,
2760 SourceRange ArgRange,
2761 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait TraitKind) {
2762 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
2763 if (S.LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && T->isObjCObjectType()) {
2764 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
2765 << T << (TraitKind == UETT_SizeOf)
2766 << ArgRange;
2767 return true;
2768 }
2769
2770 return false;
2771}
2772
Chandler Carruth9d342d02011-05-26 08:53:10 +00002773/// \brief Check the constrains on expression operands to unary type expression
2774/// and type traits.
2775///
Chandler Carruthe4d645c2011-05-27 01:33:31 +00002776/// Completes any types necessary and validates the constraints on the operand
2777/// expression. The logic mostly mirrors the type-based overload, but may modify
2778/// the expression as it completes the type for that expression through template
2779/// instantiation, etc.
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00002780bool Sema::CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(Expr *E,
Chandler Carruth9d342d02011-05-26 08:53:10 +00002781 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind) {
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00002782 QualType ExprTy = E->getType();
Chandler Carruthe4d645c2011-05-27 01:33:31 +00002783
2784 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
2785 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
2786 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
2787 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2788 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = ExprTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2789 ExprTy = Ref->getPointeeType();
2790
2791 if (ExprKind == UETT_VecStep)
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00002792 return CheckVecStepTraitOperandType(*this, ExprTy, E->getExprLoc(),
2793 E->getSourceRange());
Chandler Carruthe4d645c2011-05-27 01:33:31 +00002794
2795 // Whitelist some types as extensions
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00002796 if (!CheckExtensionTraitOperandType(*this, ExprTy, E->getExprLoc(),
2797 E->getSourceRange(), ExprKind))
Chandler Carruthe4d645c2011-05-27 01:33:31 +00002798 return false;
2799
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00002800 if (RequireCompleteExprType(E,
Chandler Carruthe4d645c2011-05-27 01:33:31 +00002801 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00002802 << ExprKind << E->getSourceRange(),
Chandler Carruthe4d645c2011-05-27 01:33:31 +00002803 std::make_pair(SourceLocation(), PDiag(0))))
2804 return true;
2805
2806 // Completeing the expression's type may have changed it.
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00002807 ExprTy = E->getType();
Chandler Carruthe4d645c2011-05-27 01:33:31 +00002808 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = ExprTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2809 ExprTy = Ref->getPointeeType();
2810
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00002811 if (CheckObjCTraitOperandConstraints(*this, ExprTy, E->getExprLoc(),
2812 E->getSourceRange(), ExprKind))
Chandler Carruthe4d645c2011-05-27 01:33:31 +00002813 return true;
2814
Nico Webercf739922011-06-15 02:47:03 +00002815 if (ExprKind == UETT_SizeOf) {
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00002816 if (DeclRefExpr *DeclRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParens())) {
Nico Webercf739922011-06-15 02:47:03 +00002817 if (ParmVarDecl *PVD = dyn_cast<ParmVarDecl>(DeclRef->getFoundDecl())) {
2818 QualType OType = PVD->getOriginalType();
2819 QualType Type = PVD->getType();
2820 if (Type->isPointerType() && OType->isArrayType()) {
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00002821 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_sizeof_array_param)
Nico Webercf739922011-06-15 02:47:03 +00002822 << Type << OType;
2823 Diag(PVD->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
2824 }
2825 }
2826 }
2827 }
2828
Chandler Carruthe4d645c2011-05-27 01:33:31 +00002829 return false;
Chandler Carruth9d342d02011-05-26 08:53:10 +00002830}
2831
2832/// \brief Check the constraints on operands to unary expression and type
2833/// traits.
2834///
2835/// This will complete any types necessary, and validate the various constraints
2836/// on those operands.
2837///
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002838/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
Chandler Carruth9d342d02011-05-26 08:53:10 +00002839/// C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] all state:
2840/// Except when it is the operand of the sizeof operator ...
2841///
2842/// C++ [expr.sizeof]p4
2843/// The lvalue-to-rvalue, array-to-pointer, and function-to-pointer
2844/// standard conversions are not applied to the operand of sizeof.
2845///
2846/// This policy is followed for all of the unary trait expressions.
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00002847bool Sema::CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(QualType ExprType,
Peter Collingbournef4e3cfb2011-03-11 19:24:49 +00002848 SourceLocation OpLoc,
2849 SourceRange ExprRange,
2850 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind) {
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00002851 if (ExprType->isDependentType())
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002852 return false;
2853
Sebastian Redl5d484e82009-11-23 17:18:46 +00002854 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
2855 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
2856 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
2857 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00002858 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = ExprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2859 ExprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
Sebastian Redl5d484e82009-11-23 17:18:46 +00002860
Chandler Carruthdf1f3772011-05-26 08:53:12 +00002861 if (ExprKind == UETT_VecStep)
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00002862 return CheckVecStepTraitOperandType(*this, ExprType, OpLoc, ExprRange);
Peter Collingbournef4e3cfb2011-03-11 19:24:49 +00002863
Chandler Carruth42ec65d2011-05-26 08:53:16 +00002864 // Whitelist some types as extensions
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00002865 if (!CheckExtensionTraitOperandType(*this, ExprType, OpLoc, ExprRange,
Chandler Carruth42ec65d2011-05-26 08:53:16 +00002866 ExprKind))
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002867 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002868
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00002869 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, ExprType,
Douglas Gregor5cc07df2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002870 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
Peter Collingbournef4e3cfb2011-03-11 19:24:49 +00002871 << ExprKind << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002872 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002873
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00002874 if (CheckObjCTraitOperandConstraints(*this, ExprType, OpLoc, ExprRange,
Chandler Carruth42ec65d2011-05-26 08:53:16 +00002875 ExprKind))
Chris Lattner5cb10d32009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002876 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002877
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002878 return false;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002879}
2880
Chandler Carruth9d342d02011-05-26 08:53:10 +00002881static bool CheckAlignOfExpr(Sema &S, Expr *E) {
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002882 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002883
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002884 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002885 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2886 return false;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002887
2888 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2889 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2890 return false;
2891
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002892 if (E->getBitField()) {
Chandler Carruth9d342d02011-05-26 08:53:10 +00002893 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield)
2894 << 1 << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002895 return true;
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002896 }
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002897
2898 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2899 // bit-field.
2900 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump8e1fab22009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002901 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002902 return false;
2903
Chandler Carruth9d342d02011-05-26 08:53:10 +00002904 return S.CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(E, UETT_AlignOf);
Peter Collingbournef4e3cfb2011-03-11 19:24:49 +00002905}
2906
Chandler Carruth9d342d02011-05-26 08:53:10 +00002907bool Sema::CheckVecStepExpr(Expr *E) {
Peter Collingbournef4e3cfb2011-03-11 19:24:49 +00002908 E = E->IgnoreParens();
2909
2910 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2911 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2912 return false;
2913
Chandler Carruth9d342d02011-05-26 08:53:10 +00002914 return CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(E, UETT_VecStep);
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002915}
2916
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002917/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002918ExprResult
Peter Collingbournef4e3cfb2011-03-11 19:24:49 +00002919Sema::CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
2920 SourceLocation OpLoc,
2921 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind,
2922 SourceRange R) {
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002923 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002924 return ExprError();
2925
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002926 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002927
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002928 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
Peter Collingbournef4e3cfb2011-03-11 19:24:49 +00002929 CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(T, OpLoc, R, ExprKind))
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002930 return ExprError();
2931
2932 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
Peter Collingbournef4e3cfb2011-03-11 19:24:49 +00002933 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(ExprKind, TInfo,
2934 Context.getSizeType(),
2935 OpLoc, R.getEnd()));
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002936}
2937
2938/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2939/// operand.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002940ExprResult
Chandler Carruthe72c55b2011-05-29 07:32:14 +00002941Sema::CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2942 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind) {
Douglas Gregor4f0845e2011-06-22 23:21:00 +00002943 ExprResult PE = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
2944 if (PE.isInvalid())
2945 return ExprError();
2946
2947 E = PE.get();
2948
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002949 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2950 bool isInvalid = false;
2951 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2952 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
Peter Collingbournef4e3cfb2011-03-11 19:24:49 +00002953 } else if (ExprKind == UETT_AlignOf) {
Chandler Carruth9d342d02011-05-26 08:53:10 +00002954 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(*this, E);
Peter Collingbournef4e3cfb2011-03-11 19:24:49 +00002955 } else if (ExprKind == UETT_VecStep) {
Chandler Carruth9d342d02011-05-26 08:53:10 +00002956 isInvalid = CheckVecStepExpr(E);
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002957 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Chandler Carruth9d342d02011-05-26 08:53:10 +00002958 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002959 isInvalid = true;
2960 } else {
Chandler Carruth9d342d02011-05-26 08:53:10 +00002961 isInvalid = CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(E, UETT_SizeOf);
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002962 }
2963
2964 if (isInvalid)
2965 return ExprError();
2966
2967 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
Chandler Carruth9d342d02011-05-26 08:53:10 +00002968 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(
Chandler Carruthe72c55b2011-05-29 07:32:14 +00002969 ExprKind, E, Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
Chandler Carruth9d342d02011-05-26 08:53:10 +00002970 E->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002971}
2972
Peter Collingbournef4e3cfb2011-03-11 19:24:49 +00002973/// ActOnUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c
2974/// expr and the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002975/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002976ExprResult
Peter Collingbournef4e3cfb2011-03-11 19:24:49 +00002977Sema::ActOnUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00002978 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind, bool IsType,
Peter Collingbournef4e3cfb2011-03-11 19:24:49 +00002979 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002980 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002981 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002982
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00002983 if (IsType) {
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002984 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00002985 (void) GetTypeFromParser(ParsedType::getFromOpaquePtr(TyOrEx), &TInfo);
Peter Collingbournef4e3cfb2011-03-11 19:24:49 +00002986 return CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, ExprKind, ArgRange);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002987 }
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002988
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002989 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
Chandler Carruthe72c55b2011-05-29 07:32:14 +00002990 ExprResult Result = CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, ExprKind);
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002991 return move(Result);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002992}
2993
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00002994static QualType CheckRealImagOperand(Sema &S, ExprResult &V, SourceLocation Loc,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00002995 bool IsReal) {
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00002996 if (V.get()->isTypeDependent())
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00002997 return S.Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002998
John McCallf6a16482010-12-04 03:47:34 +00002999 // _Real and _Imag are only l-values for normal l-values.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003000 if (V.get()->getObjectKind() != OK_Ordinary) {
3001 V = S.DefaultLvalueConversion(V.take());
3002 if (V.isInvalid())
3003 return QualType();
3004 }
John McCallf6a16482010-12-04 03:47:34 +00003005
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00003006 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003007 if (const ComplexType *CT = V.get()->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00003008 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003009
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00003010 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003011 if (V.get()->getType()->isArithmeticType())
3012 return V.get()->getType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003013
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00003014 // Test for placeholders.
John McCallfb8721c2011-04-10 19:13:55 +00003015 ExprResult PR = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(V.get());
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00003016 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003017 if (PR.get() != V.get()) {
3018 V = move(PR);
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00003019 return CheckRealImagOperand(S, V, Loc, IsReal);
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00003020 }
3021
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00003022 // Reject anything else.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003023 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V.get()->getType()
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00003024 << (IsReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00003025 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00003026}
3027
3028
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003029
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003030ExprResult
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003031Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003032 tok::TokenKind Kind, Expr *Input) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003033 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003034 switch (Kind) {
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00003035 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown unary op!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003036 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PostInc; break;
3037 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PostDec; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003038 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003039
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003040 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003041}
3042
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003043ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003044Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
3045 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003046 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003047 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003048 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3049 Base = Result.take();
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003050
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003051 Expr *LHSExp = Base, *RHSExp = Idx;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003052
Douglas Gregor337c6b92008-11-19 17:17:41 +00003053 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor3384c9c2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00003054 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
Douglas Gregor3384c9c2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00003055 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00003056 Context.DependentTy,
3057 VK_LValue, OK_Ordinary,
3058 RLoc));
Douglas Gregor3384c9c2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00003059 }
3060
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003061 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003062 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman03f332a2008-12-15 22:34:21 +00003063 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
3064 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
3065 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003066 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, Base, Idx);
Douglas Gregor337c6b92008-11-19 17:17:41 +00003067 }
3068
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003069 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Base, LLoc, Idx, RLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00003070}
3071
3072
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003073ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003074Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00003075 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003076 Expr *LHSExp = Base;
3077 Expr *RHSExp = Idx;
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00003078
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00003079 // Perform default conversions.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003080 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>()) {
3081 ExprResult Result = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
3082 if (Result.isInvalid())
3083 return ExprError();
3084 LHSExp = Result.take();
3085 }
3086 ExprResult Result = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
3087 if (Result.isInvalid())
3088 return ExprError();
3089 RHSExp = Result.take();
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003090
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00003091 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00003092 ExprValueKind VK = VK_LValue;
3093 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003094
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003095 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00003096 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003097 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003098 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00003099 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
3100 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00003101 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
3102 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
3103 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
3104 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003105 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00003106 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
3107 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00003108 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003109 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner7a2e0472007-07-16 00:23:25 +00003110 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00003111 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
3112 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00003113 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003114 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003115 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003116 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
3117 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
3118 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003119 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003120 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003121 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
3122 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
3123 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
3124 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003125 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattnerc8629632007-07-31 19:29:30 +00003126 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00003127 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00003128 VK = LHSExp->getValueKind();
3129 if (VK != VK_RValue)
3130 OK = OK_VectorComponent;
Nate Begeman334a8022009-01-18 00:45:31 +00003131
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00003132 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
3133 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00003134 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
3135 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00003136 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00003137 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
3138 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
3139 // force the promotion here.
3140 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
3141 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003142 LHSExp = ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
3143 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay).take();
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00003144 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
3145
3146 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
3147 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003148 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00003149 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
3150 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
3151 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
3152 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003153 RHSExp = ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
3154 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay).take();
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00003155 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
3156
3157 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
3158 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003159 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003160 } else {
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00003161 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
3162 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003163 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003164 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00003165 if (!IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00003166 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
3167 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003168
Daniel Dunbar7e88a602009-09-17 06:31:17 +00003169 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinig0f9a5b52009-09-14 20:14:57 +00003170 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
3171 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig76e2b712009-09-14 01:58:58 +00003172 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
3173
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00003174 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003175 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
3176 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00003177 // incomplete types are not object types.
3178 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
3179 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
3180 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3181 return ExprError();
3182 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003183
Abramo Bagnara46358452010-09-13 06:50:07 +00003184 if (ResultType->isVoidType() && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
3185 // GNU extension: subscripting on pointer to void
Chandler Carruth66289692011-06-27 16:32:27 +00003186 Diag(LLoc, diag::ext_gnu_subscript_void_type)
3187 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00003188
3189 // C forbids expressions of unqualified void type from being l-values.
3190 // See IsCForbiddenLValueType.
3191 if (!ResultType.hasQualifiers()) VK = VK_RValue;
Abramo Bagnara46358452010-09-13 06:50:07 +00003192 } else if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003193 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003194 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
3195 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00003196 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003197
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00003198 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003199 if (ResultType->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00003200 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
3201 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3202 return ExprError();
3203 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003204
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00003205 assert(VK == VK_RValue || LangOpts.CPlusPlus ||
Douglas Gregor2b1ad8b2011-06-23 00:49:38 +00003206 !ResultType.isCForbiddenLValueType());
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00003207
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003208 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00003209 ResultType, VK, OK, RLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003210}
3211
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003212ExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
Nico Weber08e41a62010-11-29 18:19:25 +00003213 FunctionDecl *FD,
3214 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003215 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003216 Diag(CallLoc,
Nico Weber15d5c832010-11-30 04:44:33 +00003217 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003218 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003219 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Nico Weber15d5c832010-11-30 04:44:33 +00003220 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003221 return ExprError();
3222 }
3223
3224 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3225 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003226
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003227 // Instantiate the expression.
3228 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3229 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson25cae7f2009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003230
Nico Weber08e41a62010-11-29 18:19:25 +00003231 std::pair<const TemplateArgument *, unsigned> Innermost
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003232 = ArgList.getInnermost();
3233 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param, Innermost.first,
3234 Innermost.second);
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003235
Nico Weber08e41a62010-11-29 18:19:25 +00003236 ExprResult Result;
3237 {
3238 // C++ [dcl.fct.default]p5:
3239 // The names in the [default argument] expression are bound, and
3240 // the semantic constraints are checked, at the point where the
3241 // default argument expression appears.
Nico Weber15d5c832010-11-30 04:44:33 +00003242 ContextRAII SavedContext(*this, FD);
Nico Weber08e41a62010-11-29 18:19:25 +00003243 Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
3244 }
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003245 if (Result.isInvalid())
3246 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003247
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003248 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3249 InitializedEntity Entity
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003250 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003251 InitializationKind Kind
3252 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3253 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3254 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003255
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003256 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
3257 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
3258 MultiExprArg(*this, &ResultE, 1));
3259 if (Result.isInvalid())
3260 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003261
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003262 // Build the default argument expression.
3263 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
3264 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003265 }
3266
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003267 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3268 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3269 // be properly destroyed.
3270 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3271 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Douglas Gregor5833b0b2010-09-14 22:55:20 +00003272 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i) {
3273 CXXTemporary *Temporary = Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i);
3274 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Param->getDefaultArg()->getLocStart(),
3275 const_cast<CXXDestructorDecl*>(Temporary->getDestructor()));
3276 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Temporary);
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003277 ExprNeedsCleanups = true;
Douglas Gregor5833b0b2010-09-14 22:55:20 +00003278 }
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003279
3280 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00003281 // Just mark all of the declarations in this potentially-evaluated expression
3282 // as being "referenced".
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003283 MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Param->getDefaultArg());
Douglas Gregor036aed12009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003284 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003285}
3286
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003287/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3288/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3289/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3290/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3291/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3292/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003293bool
3294Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003295 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003296 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003297 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Peter Collingbourne1f240762011-10-02 23:49:29 +00003298 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
3299 bool IsExecConfig) {
John McCall8e10f3b2011-02-26 05:39:39 +00003300 // Bail out early if calling a builtin with custom typechecking.
3301 // We don't need to do this in the
3302 if (FDecl)
3303 if (unsigned ID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
3304 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.hasCustomTypechecking(ID))
3305 return false;
3306
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003307 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003308 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3309 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregor3fd56d72009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003310 bool Invalid = false;
Peter Collingbourneaf15b4d2011-10-02 23:49:20 +00003311 unsigned MinArgs = FDecl ? FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments() : NumArgsInProto;
Peter Collingbourne1f240762011-10-02 23:49:29 +00003312 unsigned FnKind = Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
3313 ? 1 /* block */
3314 : (IsExecConfig ? 3 /* kernel function (exec config) */
3315 : 0 /* function */);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003316
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003317 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3318 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3319 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
Peter Collingbourneaf15b4d2011-10-02 23:49:20 +00003320 if (NumArgs < MinArgs) {
3321 Diag(RParenLoc, MinArgs == NumArgsInProto
3322 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args
3323 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_at_least)
Peter Collingbourne1f240762011-10-02 23:49:29 +00003324 << FnKind
Peter Collingbourneaf15b4d2011-10-02 23:49:20 +00003325 << MinArgs << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Peter Collingbourne9aab1482011-07-29 00:24:42 +00003326
3327 // Emit the location of the prototype.
Peter Collingbourne1f240762011-10-02 23:49:29 +00003328 if (FDecl && !FDecl->getBuiltinID() && !IsExecConfig)
Peter Collingbourne9aab1482011-07-29 00:24:42 +00003329 Diag(FDecl->getLocStart(), diag::note_callee_decl)
3330 << FDecl;
3331
3332 return true;
3333 }
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003334 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003335 }
3336
3337 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3338 // them.
3339 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3340 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3341 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
Peter Collingbourneaf15b4d2011-10-02 23:49:20 +00003342 MinArgs == NumArgsInProto
3343 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args
3344 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_at_most)
Peter Collingbourne1f240762011-10-02 23:49:29 +00003345 << FnKind
Eric Christopherccfa9632010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003346 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003347 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3348 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
Ted Kremenek5862f0e2011-04-04 17:22:27 +00003349
3350 // Emit the location of the prototype.
Peter Collingbourne1f240762011-10-02 23:49:29 +00003351 if (FDecl && !FDecl->getBuiltinID() && !IsExecConfig)
Peter Collingbourne9aab1482011-07-29 00:24:42 +00003352 Diag(FDecl->getLocStart(), diag::note_callee_decl)
3353 << FDecl;
Ted Kremenek5862f0e2011-04-04 17:22:27 +00003354
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003355 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003356 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003357 return true;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003358 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003359 }
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003360 SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003361 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003362 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3363 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3364 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3365 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3366 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003367 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian2fe168f2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003368 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003369 if (Invalid)
3370 return true;
3371 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3372 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3373 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003374
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003375 return false;
3376}
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003377
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003378bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3379 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3380 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3381 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3382 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003383 SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003384 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003385 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3386 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3387 bool Invalid = false;
3388 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3389 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3390 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3391 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003392 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003393 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003394 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003395
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003396 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003397 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3398 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003399
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003400 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3401 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003402 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003403 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003404 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003405
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003406 // Pass the argument
3407 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3408 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3409 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregoraa037312009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003410
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003411 InitializedEntity Entity =
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003412 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param)
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003413 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, ProtoArgType,
3414 Proto->isArgConsumed(i));
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003415 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
John McCallf6a16482010-12-04 03:47:34 +00003416 SourceLocation(),
3417 Owned(Arg));
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003418 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3419 return true;
3420
3421 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson5e300d12009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003422 } else {
Anders Carlssoned961f92009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003423 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003424
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003425 ExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003426 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003427 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3428 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003429
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003430 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson5e300d12009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003431 }
Kaelyn Uhraind6c88652011-08-05 23:18:04 +00003432
3433 // Check for array bounds violations for each argument to the call. This
3434 // check only triggers warnings when the argument isn't a more complex Expr
3435 // with its own checking, such as a BinaryOperator.
3436 CheckArrayAccess(Arg);
3437
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003438 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003439 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003440
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003441 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003442 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
John McCall755d8492011-04-12 00:42:48 +00003443
3444 // Assume that extern "C" functions with variadic arguments that
3445 // return __unknown_anytype aren't *really* variadic.
3446 if (Proto->getResultType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy &&
3447 FDecl && FDecl->isExternC()) {
3448 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i != NumArgs; ++i) {
3449 ExprResult arg;
3450 if (isa<ExplicitCastExpr>(Args[i]->IgnoreParens()))
3451 arg = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Args[i]);
3452 else
3453 arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], CallType, FDecl);
3454 Invalid |= arg.isInvalid();
3455 AllArgs.push_back(arg.take());
3456 }
3457
3458 // Otherwise do argument promotion, (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
3459 } else {
3460 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i != NumArgs; ++i) {
Richard Trieu67e29332011-08-02 04:35:43 +00003461 ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], CallType,
3462 FDecl);
John McCall755d8492011-04-12 00:42:48 +00003463 Invalid |= Arg.isInvalid();
3464 AllArgs.push_back(Arg.take());
3465 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003466 }
Ted Kremenek615eb7c2011-09-26 23:36:13 +00003467
3468 // Check for array bounds violations.
3469 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i != NumArgs; ++i)
3470 CheckArrayAccess(Args[i]);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003471 }
Douglas Gregor3fd56d72009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003472 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003473}
3474
John McCall755d8492011-04-12 00:42:48 +00003475/// Given a function expression of unknown-any type, try to rebuild it
3476/// to have a function type.
3477static ExprResult rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(Sema &S, Expr *fn);
3478
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003479/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003480/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3481/// locations.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003482ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003483Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00003484 MultiExprArg ArgExprs, SourceLocation RParenLoc,
Peter Collingbourne1f240762011-10-02 23:49:29 +00003485 Expr *ExecConfig, bool IsExecConfig) {
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00003486 unsigned NumArgs = ArgExprs.size();
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003487
3488 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003489 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Fn);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003490 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3491 Fn = Result.take();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003492
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00003493 Expr **Args = ArgExprs.release();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003494
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003495 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003496 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3497 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3498 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3499 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3500 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003501 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003502 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3503 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003504
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003505 NumArgs = 0;
3506 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003507
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003508 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00003509 VK_RValue, RParenLoc));
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003510 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003511
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003512 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003513 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003514 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3515 // Fn.
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003516 bool Dependent = false;
3517 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3518 Dependent = true;
3519 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3520 Dependent = true;
3521
Peter Collingbournee08ce652011-02-09 21:07:24 +00003522 if (Dependent) {
3523 if (ExecConfig) {
3524 return Owned(new (Context) CUDAKernelCallExpr(
3525 Context, Fn, cast<CallExpr>(ExecConfig), Args, NumArgs,
3526 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, RParenLoc));
3527 } else {
3528 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
3529 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue,
3530 RParenLoc));
3531 }
3532 }
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003533
3534 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3535 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3536 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003537 RParenLoc));
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003538
John McCall755d8492011-04-12 00:42:48 +00003539 if (Fn->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) {
3540 ExprResult result = rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(*this, Fn);
3541 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3542 Fn = result.take();
3543 }
3544
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00003545 if (Fn->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003546 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003547 RParenLoc);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003548 }
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00003549 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003550
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00003551 // Check for overloaded calls. This can happen even in C due to extensions.
3552 if (Fn->getType() == Context.OverloadTy) {
3553 OverloadExpr::FindResult find = OverloadExpr::find(Fn);
3554
Douglas Gregoree697e62011-10-13 18:10:35 +00003555 // We aren't supposed to apply this logic for if there's an '&' involved.
Douglas Gregor64a371f2011-10-13 18:26:27 +00003556 if (!find.HasFormOfMemberPointer) {
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00003557 OverloadExpr *ovl = find.Expression;
3558 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(ovl)) {
3559 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(ovl);
3560 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3561 RParenLoc, ExecConfig);
3562 } else {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003563 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003564 RParenLoc);
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003565 }
3566 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003567 }
3568
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003569 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003570
Eli Friedmanefa42f72009-12-26 03:35:45 +00003571 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
Douglas Gregoref9b1492010-11-09 20:03:54 +00003572
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003573 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
Douglas Gregord8f0ade2010-10-25 20:48:33 +00003574 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(NakedFn))
3575 if (UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf)
3576 NakedFn = UnOp->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
3577
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003578 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
3579 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00003580 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedFn))
3581 NDecl = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)->getMemberDecl();
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003582
Peter Collingbournee08ce652011-02-09 21:07:24 +00003583 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc,
Peter Collingbourne1f240762011-10-02 23:49:29 +00003584 ExecConfig, IsExecConfig);
Peter Collingbournee08ce652011-02-09 21:07:24 +00003585}
3586
3587ExprResult
3588Sema::ActOnCUDAExecConfigExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LLLLoc,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00003589 MultiExprArg ExecConfig, SourceLocation GGGLoc) {
Peter Collingbournee08ce652011-02-09 21:07:24 +00003590 FunctionDecl *ConfigDecl = Context.getcudaConfigureCallDecl();
3591 if (!ConfigDecl)
3592 return ExprError(Diag(LLLLoc, diag::err_undeclared_var_use)
3593 << "cudaConfigureCall");
3594 QualType ConfigQTy = ConfigDecl->getType();
3595
3596 DeclRefExpr *ConfigDR = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(
3597 ConfigDecl, ConfigQTy, VK_LValue, LLLLoc);
3598
Peter Collingbourne1f240762011-10-02 23:49:29 +00003599 return ActOnCallExpr(S, ConfigDR, LLLLoc, ExecConfig, GGGLoc, 0,
3600 /*IsExecConfig=*/true);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003601}
3602
Tanya Lattner61eee0c2011-06-04 00:47:47 +00003603/// ActOnAsTypeExpr - create a new asType (bitcast) from the arguments.
3604///
3605/// __builtin_astype( value, dst type )
3606///
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00003607ExprResult Sema::ActOnAsTypeExpr(Expr *E, ParsedType ParsedDestTy,
Tanya Lattner61eee0c2011-06-04 00:47:47 +00003608 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
3609 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
3610 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue;
3611 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary;
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00003612 QualType DstTy = GetTypeFromParser(ParsedDestTy);
3613 QualType SrcTy = E->getType();
Tanya Lattner61eee0c2011-06-04 00:47:47 +00003614 if (Context.getTypeSize(DstTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
3615 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc,
3616 diag::err_invalid_astype_of_different_size)
Peter Collingbourneaf9cddf2011-06-08 15:15:17 +00003617 << DstTy
3618 << SrcTy
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00003619 << E->getSourceRange());
3620 return Owned(new (Context) AsTypeExpr(E, DstTy, VK, OK, BuiltinLoc,
Richard Trieu67e29332011-08-02 04:35:43 +00003621 RParenLoc));
Tanya Lattner61eee0c2011-06-04 00:47:47 +00003622}
3623
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003624/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
3625/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003626/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
3627/// block-pointer type.
3628///
3629/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003630ExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003631Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
3632 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3633 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Peter Collingbournee08ce652011-02-09 21:07:24 +00003634 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
Peter Collingbourne1f240762011-10-02 23:49:29 +00003635 Expr *Config, bool IsExecConfig) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003636 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
3637
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003638 // Promote the function operand.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003639 ExprResult Result = UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
3640 if (Result.isInvalid())
3641 return ExprError();
3642 Fn = Result.take();
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003643
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003644 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
3645 // of arguments and function on error.
Peter Collingbournee08ce652011-02-09 21:07:24 +00003646 CallExpr *TheCall;
3647 if (Config) {
3648 TheCall = new (Context) CUDAKernelCallExpr(Context, Fn,
3649 cast<CallExpr>(Config),
3650 Args, NumArgs,
3651 Context.BoolTy,
3652 VK_RValue,
3653 RParenLoc);
3654 } else {
3655 TheCall = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
3656 Args, NumArgs,
3657 Context.BoolTy,
3658 VK_RValue,
3659 RParenLoc);
3660 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003661
John McCall8e10f3b2011-02-26 05:39:39 +00003662 unsigned BuiltinID = (FDecl ? FDecl->getBuiltinID() : 0);
3663
3664 // Bail out early if calling a builtin with custom typechecking.
3665 if (BuiltinID && Context.BuiltinInfo.hasCustomTypechecking(BuiltinID))
3666 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall);
3667
John McCall1de4d4e2011-04-07 08:22:57 +00003668 retry:
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003669 const FunctionType *FuncT;
John McCall8e10f3b2011-02-26 05:39:39 +00003670 if (const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003671 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
3672 // have type pointer to function".
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003673 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
John McCall8e10f3b2011-02-26 05:39:39 +00003674 if (FuncT == 0)
3675 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3676 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3677 } else if (const BlockPointerType *BPT =
3678 Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
3679 FuncT = BPT->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
3680 } else {
John McCall1de4d4e2011-04-07 08:22:57 +00003681 // Handle calls to expressions of unknown-any type.
3682 if (Fn->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) {
John McCall755d8492011-04-12 00:42:48 +00003683 ExprResult rewrite = rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(*this, Fn);
John McCall1de4d4e2011-04-07 08:22:57 +00003684 if (rewrite.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3685 Fn = rewrite.take();
John McCalla5fc4722011-04-09 22:50:59 +00003686 TheCall->setCallee(Fn);
John McCall1de4d4e2011-04-07 08:22:57 +00003687 goto retry;
3688 }
3689
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003690 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3691 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall8e10f3b2011-02-26 05:39:39 +00003692 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003693
Peter Collingbourne0423fc62011-02-23 01:53:29 +00003694 if (getLangOptions().CUDA) {
3695 if (Config) {
3696 // CUDA: Kernel calls must be to global functions
3697 if (FDecl && !FDecl->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>())
3698 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc,diag::err_kern_call_not_global_function)
3699 << FDecl->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3700
3701 // CUDA: Kernel function must have 'void' return type
3702 if (!FuncT->getResultType()->isVoidType())
3703 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_kern_type_not_void_return)
3704 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Peter Collingbourne8591a7f2011-10-02 23:49:15 +00003705 } else {
3706 // CUDA: Calls to global functions must be configured
3707 if (FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>())
3708 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_global_call_not_config)
3709 << FDecl->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Peter Collingbourne0423fc62011-02-23 01:53:29 +00003710 }
3711 }
3712
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003713 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003714 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003715 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall,
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003716 FDecl))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003717 return ExprError();
3718
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003719 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003720 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getCallResultType(Context));
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00003721 TheCall->setValueKind(Expr::getValueKindForType(FuncT->getResultType()));
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003722
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003723 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003724 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Peter Collingbourne1f240762011-10-02 23:49:29 +00003725 RParenLoc, IsExecConfig))
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003726 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003727 } else {
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003728 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003729
Douglas Gregor74734d52009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003730 if (FDecl) {
3731 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
3732 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
3733 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis06a54a32010-07-07 11:31:19 +00003734 if (FDecl->hasBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Douglas Gregor46542412010-10-25 20:39:23 +00003735 const FunctionProtoType *Proto
3736 = Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
3737 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size()))
Eli Friedmanbc4e29f2009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003738 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
3739 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedmanbc4e29f2009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003740 }
Douglas Gregor46542412010-10-25 20:39:23 +00003741
3742 // If the function we're calling isn't a function prototype, but we have
3743 // a function prototype from a prior declaratiom, use that prototype.
3744 if (!FDecl->hasPrototype())
3745 Proto = FDecl->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregor74734d52009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003746 }
3747
Steve Naroffb291ab62007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003748 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003749 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
3750 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Douglas Gregor46542412010-10-25 20:39:23 +00003751
3752 if (Proto && i < Proto->getNumArgs()) {
Douglas Gregor46542412010-10-25 20:39:23 +00003753 InitializedEntity Entity
3754 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003755 Proto->getArgType(i),
3756 Proto->isArgConsumed(i));
Douglas Gregor46542412010-10-25 20:39:23 +00003757 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
3758 SourceLocation(),
3759 Owned(Arg));
3760 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3761 return true;
3762
3763 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
3764
3765 } else {
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003766 ExprResult ArgE = DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
3767
3768 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3769 return true;
3770
3771 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor46542412010-10-25 20:39:23 +00003772 }
3773
Douglas Gregor0700bbf2010-10-26 05:45:40 +00003774 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3775 Arg->getType(),
3776 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3777 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
3778 return ExprError();
3779
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003780 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroffb291ab62007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003781 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003782 }
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003783
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003784 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
3785 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003786 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
3787 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003788
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +00003789 // Check for sentinels
3790 if (NDecl)
3791 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003792
Chris Lattner59907c42007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003793 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003794 if (FDecl) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003795 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003796 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003797
John McCall8e10f3b2011-02-26 05:39:39 +00003798 if (BuiltinID)
Fariborz Jahanian67aba812010-11-30 17:35:24 +00003799 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall);
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003800 } else if (NDecl) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003801 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003802 return ExprError();
3803 }
Chris Lattner59907c42007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003804
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003805 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003806}
3807
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003808ExprResult
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00003809Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003810 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *InitExpr) {
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003811 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroffaff1edd2007-07-19 21:32:11 +00003812 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003813 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003814
3815 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3816 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
3817 if (!TInfo)
3818 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
3819
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003820 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, InitExpr);
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003821}
3822
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003823ExprResult
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003824Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00003825 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *LiteralExpr) {
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003826 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Anders Carlssond35c8322007-12-05 07:24:19 +00003827
Eli Friedman6223c222008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003828 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidise6fe9a22010-11-08 19:14:19 +00003829 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Context.getBaseElementType(literalType),
3830 PDiag(diag::err_illegal_decl_array_incomplete_type)
3831 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00003832 LiteralExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Argyrios Kyrtzidise6fe9a22010-11-08 19:14:19 +00003833 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnerc63a1f22008-08-04 07:31:14 +00003834 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003835 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00003836 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, LiteralExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor690dc7f2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00003837 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
3838 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003839 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003840 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00003841 LiteralExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003842 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman6223c222008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003843
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003844 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregord6542d82009-12-22 15:35:07 +00003845 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003846 InitializationKind Kind
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003847 = InitializationKind::CreateCStyleCast(LParenLoc,
3848 SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00003849 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &LiteralExpr, 1);
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003850 ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00003851 MultiExprArg(*this, &LiteralExpr, 1),
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003852 &literalType);
3853 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003854 return ExprError();
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00003855 LiteralExpr = Result.get();
Steve Naroffe9b12192008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003856
Chris Lattner371f2582008-12-04 23:50:19 +00003857 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffe9b12192008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003858 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00003859 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(LiteralExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003860 return ExprError();
Steve Naroffd0091aa2008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003861 }
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003862
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00003863 // In C, compound literals are l-values for some reason.
3864 ExprValueKind VK = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? VK_RValue : VK_LValue;
3865
Douglas Gregor751ec9b2011-06-17 04:59:12 +00003866 return MaybeBindToTemporary(
3867 new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00003868 VK, LiteralExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Naroff4aa88f82007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003869}
3870
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003871ExprResult
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00003872Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg InitArgList,
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003873 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00003874 unsigned NumInit = InitArgList.size();
3875 Expr **InitList = InitArgList.release();
Anders Carlsson66b5a8a2007-08-31 04:56:16 +00003876
Steve Naroff08d92e42007-09-15 18:49:24 +00003877 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003878 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003879
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00003880 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
3881 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00003882 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003883 return Owned(E);
Steve Naroff4aa88f82007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003884}
3885
John McCalldc05b112011-09-10 01:16:55 +00003886/// Do an explicit extend of the given block pointer if we're in ARC.
3887static void maybeExtendBlockObject(Sema &S, ExprResult &E) {
3888 assert(E.get()->getType()->isBlockPointerType());
3889 assert(E.get()->isRValue());
3890
3891 // Only do this in an r-value context.
3892 if (!S.getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount) return;
3893
3894 E = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(S.Context, E.get()->getType(),
John McCall33e56f32011-09-10 06:18:15 +00003895 CK_ARCExtendBlockObject, E.get(),
John McCalldc05b112011-09-10 01:16:55 +00003896 /*base path*/ 0, VK_RValue);
3897 S.ExprNeedsCleanups = true;
3898}
3899
3900/// Prepare a conversion of the given expression to an ObjC object
3901/// pointer type.
3902CastKind Sema::PrepareCastToObjCObjectPointer(ExprResult &E) {
3903 QualType type = E.get()->getType();
3904 if (type->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
3905 return CK_BitCast;
3906 } else if (type->isBlockPointerType()) {
3907 maybeExtendBlockObject(*this, E);
3908 return CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast;
3909 } else {
3910 assert(type->isPointerType());
3911 return CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast;
3912 }
3913}
3914
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00003915/// Prepares for a scalar cast, performing all the necessary stages
3916/// except the final cast and returning the kind required.
John McCalla180f042011-10-06 23:25:11 +00003917CastKind Sema::PrepareScalarCast(ExprResult &Src, QualType DestTy) {
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00003918 // Both Src and Dest are scalar types, i.e. arithmetic or pointer.
3919 // Also, callers should have filtered out the invalid cases with
3920 // pointers. Everything else should be possible.
3921
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003922 QualType SrcTy = Src.get()->getType();
John McCalla180f042011-10-06 23:25:11 +00003923 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003924 return CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003925
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00003926 switch (Type::ScalarTypeKind SrcKind = SrcTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00003927 case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
3928 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C");
Abramo Bagnarabb03f5d2011-01-04 09:50:03 +00003929
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00003930 case Type::STK_CPointer:
3931 case Type::STK_BlockPointer:
3932 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer:
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00003933 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00003934 case Type::STK_CPointer:
3935 return CK_BitCast;
3936 case Type::STK_BlockPointer:
3937 return (SrcKind == Type::STK_BlockPointer
3938 ? CK_BitCast : CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast);
3939 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer:
3940 if (SrcKind == Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer)
3941 return CK_BitCast;
3942 else if (SrcKind == Type::STK_CPointer)
3943 return CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast;
John McCalldc05b112011-09-10 01:16:55 +00003944 else {
John McCalla180f042011-10-06 23:25:11 +00003945 maybeExtendBlockObject(*this, Src);
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00003946 return CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast;
John McCalldc05b112011-09-10 01:16:55 +00003947 }
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00003948 case Type::STK_Bool:
3949 return CK_PointerToBoolean;
3950 case Type::STK_Integral:
3951 return CK_PointerToIntegral;
3952 case Type::STK_Floating:
3953 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
3954 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
3955 case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
3956 llvm_unreachable("illegal cast from pointer");
3957 }
3958 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003959
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00003960 case Type::STK_Bool: // casting from bool is like casting from an integer
3961 case Type::STK_Integral:
3962 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00003963 case Type::STK_CPointer:
3964 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer:
3965 case Type::STK_BlockPointer:
John McCalla180f042011-10-06 23:25:11 +00003966 if (Src.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Richard Trieu67e29332011-08-02 04:35:43 +00003967 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
John McCall404cd162010-11-13 01:35:44 +00003968 return CK_NullToPointer;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003969 return CK_IntegralToPointer;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00003970 case Type::STK_Bool:
3971 return CK_IntegralToBoolean;
3972 case Type::STK_Integral:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00003973 return CK_IntegralCast;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00003974 case Type::STK_Floating:
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003975 return CK_IntegralToFloating;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00003976 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
John McCalla180f042011-10-06 23:25:11 +00003977 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.take(),
3978 DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(),
3979 CK_IntegralCast);
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00003980 return CK_IntegralRealToComplex;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00003981 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
John McCalla180f042011-10-06 23:25:11 +00003982 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.take(),
3983 DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(),
3984 CK_IntegralToFloating);
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00003985 return CK_FloatingRealToComplex;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00003986 case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
3987 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C");
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00003988 }
3989 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003990
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00003991 case Type::STK_Floating:
3992 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
3993 case Type::STK_Floating:
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003994 return CK_FloatingCast;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00003995 case Type::STK_Bool:
3996 return CK_FloatingToBoolean;
3997 case Type::STK_Integral:
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003998 return CK_FloatingToIntegral;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00003999 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
John McCalla180f042011-10-06 23:25:11 +00004000 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.take(),
4001 DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(),
4002 CK_FloatingCast);
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004003 return CK_FloatingRealToComplex;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004004 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
John McCalla180f042011-10-06 23:25:11 +00004005 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.take(),
4006 DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(),
4007 CK_FloatingToIntegral);
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004008 return CK_IntegralRealToComplex;
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00004009 case Type::STK_CPointer:
4010 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer:
4011 case Type::STK_BlockPointer:
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004012 llvm_unreachable("valid float->pointer cast?");
4013 case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
4014 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C");
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004015 }
4016 break;
4017
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004018 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
4019 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
4020 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004021 return CK_FloatingComplexCast;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004022 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004023 return CK_FloatingComplexToIntegralComplex;
John McCall8786da72010-12-14 17:51:41 +00004024 case Type::STK_Floating: {
John McCalla180f042011-10-06 23:25:11 +00004025 QualType ET = SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType();
4026 if (Context.hasSameType(ET, DestTy))
John McCall8786da72010-12-14 17:51:41 +00004027 return CK_FloatingComplexToReal;
John McCalla180f042011-10-06 23:25:11 +00004028 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.take(), ET, CK_FloatingComplexToReal);
John McCall8786da72010-12-14 17:51:41 +00004029 return CK_FloatingCast;
4030 }
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004031 case Type::STK_Bool:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004032 return CK_FloatingComplexToBoolean;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004033 case Type::STK_Integral:
John McCalla180f042011-10-06 23:25:11 +00004034 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.take(),
4035 SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(),
4036 CK_FloatingComplexToReal);
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004037 return CK_FloatingToIntegral;
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00004038 case Type::STK_CPointer:
4039 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer:
4040 case Type::STK_BlockPointer:
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004041 llvm_unreachable("valid complex float->pointer cast?");
4042 case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
4043 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C");
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004044 }
4045 break;
4046
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004047 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
4048 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
4049 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004050 return CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004051 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004052 return CK_IntegralComplexCast;
John McCall8786da72010-12-14 17:51:41 +00004053 case Type::STK_Integral: {
John McCalla180f042011-10-06 23:25:11 +00004054 QualType ET = SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType();
4055 if (Context.hasSameType(ET, DestTy))
John McCall8786da72010-12-14 17:51:41 +00004056 return CK_IntegralComplexToReal;
John McCalla180f042011-10-06 23:25:11 +00004057 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.take(), ET, CK_IntegralComplexToReal);
John McCall8786da72010-12-14 17:51:41 +00004058 return CK_IntegralCast;
4059 }
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004060 case Type::STK_Bool:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004061 return CK_IntegralComplexToBoolean;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004062 case Type::STK_Floating:
John McCalla180f042011-10-06 23:25:11 +00004063 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.take(),
4064 SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(),
4065 CK_IntegralComplexToReal);
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004066 return CK_IntegralToFloating;
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00004067 case Type::STK_CPointer:
4068 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer:
4069 case Type::STK_BlockPointer:
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004070 llvm_unreachable("valid complex int->pointer cast?");
4071 case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
4072 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C");
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004073 }
4074 break;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004075 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004076
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004077 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled scalar cast");
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004078}
4079
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004080bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004081 CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004082 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004083
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004084 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00004085 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004086 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004087 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004088 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004089 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004090 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004091 } else
4092 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004093 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004094 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004095
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004096 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004097 return false;
4098}
4099
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004100ExprResult Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy,
4101 Expr *CastExpr, CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004102 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004103
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004104 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004105
Nate Begeman9b10da62009-06-27 22:05:55 +00004106 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
4107 // an ExtVectorType.
Tobias Grosser9df05ea2011-09-22 13:03:14 +00004108 // In OpenCL, casts between vectors of different types are not allowed.
4109 // (See OpenCL 6.2).
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004110 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
Tobias Grosser9df05ea2011-09-22 13:03:14 +00004111 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy)
4112 || (getLangOptions().OpenCL &&
4113 (DestTy.getCanonicalType() != SrcTy.getCanonicalType()))) {
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004114 Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004115 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004116 return ExprError();
4117 }
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004118 Kind = CK_BitCast;
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004119 return Owned(CastExpr);
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004120 }
4121
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004122 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004123 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
4124 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004125 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
4126 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
4127 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
4128 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004129
4130 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004131 ExprResult CastExprRes = Owned(CastExpr);
John McCalla180f042011-10-06 23:25:11 +00004132 CastKind CK = PrepareScalarCast(CastExprRes, DestElemTy);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004133 if (CastExprRes.isInvalid())
4134 return ExprError();
4135 CastExpr = ImpCastExprToType(CastExprRes.take(), DestElemTy, CK).take();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004136
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004137 Kind = CK_VectorSplat;
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004138 return Owned(CastExpr);
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004139}
4140
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004141ExprResult
Argyrios Kyrtzidis0a851832011-07-01 22:22:59 +00004142Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
4143 Declarator &D, ParsedType &Ty,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00004144 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *CastExpr) {
4145 assert(!D.isInvalidType() && (CastExpr != 0) &&
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004146 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff16beff82007-07-16 23:25:18 +00004147
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00004148 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo = GetTypeForDeclaratorCast(D, CastExpr->getType());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis0a851832011-07-01 22:22:59 +00004149 if (D.isInvalidType())
4150 return ExprError();
4151
4152 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4153 // Check that there are no default arguments (C++ only).
4154 CheckExtraCXXDefaultArguments(D);
4155 }
4156
John McCalle82247a2011-10-01 05:17:03 +00004157 checkUnusedDeclAttributes(D);
4158
Argyrios Kyrtzidis0a851832011-07-01 22:22:59 +00004159 QualType castType = castTInfo->getType();
4160 Ty = CreateParsedType(castType, castTInfo);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004161
Argyrios Kyrtzidis707f1012011-07-01 22:22:54 +00004162 bool isVectorLiteral = false;
4163
4164 // Check for an altivec or OpenCL literal,
4165 // i.e. all the elements are integer constants.
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00004166 ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(CastExpr);
4167 ParenListExpr *PLE = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(CastExpr);
Tobias Grosser37c31c22011-09-21 18:28:29 +00004168 if ((getLangOptions().AltiVec || getLangOptions().OpenCL)
4169 && castType->isVectorType() && (PE || PLE)) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis707f1012011-07-01 22:22:54 +00004170 if (PLE && PLE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4171 Diag(PLE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4172 return ExprError();
4173 }
4174 if (PE || PLE->getNumExprs() == 1) {
4175 Expr *E = (PE ? PE->getSubExpr() : PLE->getExpr(0));
4176 if (!E->getType()->isVectorType())
4177 isVectorLiteral = true;
4178 }
4179 else
4180 isVectorLiteral = true;
4181 }
4182
4183 // If this is a vector initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
4184 // then handle it as such.
4185 if (isVectorLiteral)
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00004186 return BuildVectorLiteral(LParenLoc, RParenLoc, CastExpr, castTInfo);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis707f1012011-07-01 22:22:54 +00004187
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004188 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis707f1012011-07-01 22:22:54 +00004189 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
4190 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00004191 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(CastExpr)) {
4192 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, CastExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis707f1012011-07-01 22:22:54 +00004193 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00004194 CastExpr = Result.take();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis707f1012011-07-01 22:22:54 +00004195 }
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004196
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00004197 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, CastExpr);
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004198}
4199
Argyrios Kyrtzidis707f1012011-07-01 22:22:54 +00004200ExprResult Sema::BuildVectorLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc,
4201 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *E,
4202 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
4203 assert((isa<ParenListExpr>(E) || isa<ParenExpr>(E)) &&
4204 "Expected paren or paren list expression");
4205
4206 Expr **exprs;
4207 unsigned numExprs;
4208 Expr *subExpr;
4209 if (ParenListExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(E)) {
4210 exprs = PE->getExprs();
4211 numExprs = PE->getNumExprs();
4212 } else {
4213 subExpr = cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr();
4214 exprs = &subExpr;
4215 numExprs = 1;
4216 }
4217
4218 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
4219 assert(Ty->isVectorType() && "Expected vector type");
4220
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00004221 SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
Tanya Lattner61b4bc82011-07-15 23:07:01 +00004222 const VectorType *VTy = Ty->getAs<VectorType>();
4223 unsigned numElems = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()->getNumElements();
4224
Argyrios Kyrtzidis707f1012011-07-01 22:22:54 +00004225 // '(...)' form of vector initialization in AltiVec: the number of
4226 // initializers must be one or must match the size of the vector.
4227 // If a single value is specified in the initializer then it will be
4228 // replicated to all the components of the vector
Tanya Lattner61b4bc82011-07-15 23:07:01 +00004229 if (VTy->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecVector) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis707f1012011-07-01 22:22:54 +00004230 // The number of initializers must be one or must match the size of the
4231 // vector. If a single value is specified in the initializer then it will
4232 // be replicated to all the components of the vector
4233 if (numExprs == 1) {
4234 QualType ElemTy = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()->getElementType();
4235 ExprResult Literal = Owned(exprs[0]);
4236 Literal = ImpCastExprToType(Literal.take(), ElemTy,
John McCalla180f042011-10-06 23:25:11 +00004237 PrepareScalarCast(Literal, ElemTy));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis707f1012011-07-01 22:22:54 +00004238 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Literal.take());
4239 }
4240 else if (numExprs < numElems) {
4241 Diag(E->getExprLoc(),
4242 diag::err_incorrect_number_of_vector_initializers);
4243 return ExprError();
4244 }
4245 else
4246 for (unsigned i = 0, e = numExprs; i != e; ++i)
4247 initExprs.push_back(exprs[i]);
4248 }
Tanya Lattner61b4bc82011-07-15 23:07:01 +00004249 else {
4250 // For OpenCL, when the number of initializers is a single value,
4251 // it will be replicated to all components of the vector.
4252 if (getLangOptions().OpenCL &&
4253 VTy->getVectorKind() == VectorType::GenericVector &&
4254 numExprs == 1) {
4255 QualType ElemTy = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()->getElementType();
4256 ExprResult Literal = Owned(exprs[0]);
4257 Literal = ImpCastExprToType(Literal.take(), ElemTy,
John McCalla180f042011-10-06 23:25:11 +00004258 PrepareScalarCast(Literal, ElemTy));
Tanya Lattner61b4bc82011-07-15 23:07:01 +00004259 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Literal.take());
4260 }
4261
Argyrios Kyrtzidis707f1012011-07-01 22:22:54 +00004262 for (unsigned i = 0, e = numExprs; i != e; ++i)
4263 initExprs.push_back(exprs[i]);
Tanya Lattner61b4bc82011-07-15 23:07:01 +00004264 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis707f1012011-07-01 22:22:54 +00004265 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4266 // braces instead of the original commas.
4267 InitListExpr *initE = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4268 &initExprs[0],
4269 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4270 initE->setType(Ty);
4271 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, initE);
4272}
4273
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004274/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
4275/// of comma binary operators.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004276ExprResult
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00004277Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, Expr *OrigExpr) {
4278 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(OrigExpr);
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004279 if (!E)
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00004280 return Owned(OrigExpr);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004281
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004282 ExprResult Result(E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004283
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004284 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004285 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, Result.get(),
4286 E->getExpr(i));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004287
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004288 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4289
4290 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), Result.get());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004291}
4292
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004293ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00004294 SourceLocation R,
4295 MultiExprArg Val) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004296 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4297 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004298 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4299 Expr *expr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis707f1012011-07-01 22:22:54 +00004300 if (nexprs == 1)
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004301 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4302 else
Manuel Klimek0d9106f2011-06-22 20:02:16 +00004303 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R,
4304 exprs[nexprs-1]->getType());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004305 return Owned(expr);
4306}
4307
Chandler Carruth82214a82011-02-18 23:54:50 +00004308/// \brief Emit a specialized diagnostic when one expression is a null pointer
Richard Trieu26f96072011-09-02 01:51:02 +00004309/// constant and the other is not a pointer. Returns true if a diagnostic is
4310/// emitted.
Richard Trieu33fc7572011-09-06 20:06:39 +00004311bool Sema::DiagnoseConditionalForNull(Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
Chandler Carruth82214a82011-02-18 23:54:50 +00004312 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Richard Trieu33fc7572011-09-06 20:06:39 +00004313 Expr *NullExpr = LHSExpr;
4314 Expr *NonPointerExpr = RHSExpr;
Chandler Carruth82214a82011-02-18 23:54:50 +00004315 Expr::NullPointerConstantKind NullKind =
4316 NullExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
4317 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull);
4318
4319 if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_NotNull) {
Richard Trieu33fc7572011-09-06 20:06:39 +00004320 NullExpr = RHSExpr;
4321 NonPointerExpr = LHSExpr;
Chandler Carruth82214a82011-02-18 23:54:50 +00004322 NullKind =
4323 NullExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
4324 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull);
4325 }
4326
4327 if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_NotNull)
4328 return false;
4329
4330 if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_ZeroInteger) {
4331 // In this case, check to make sure that we got here from a "NULL"
4332 // string in the source code.
4333 NullExpr = NullExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
John McCall834e3f62011-03-08 07:59:04 +00004334 SourceLocation loc = NullExpr->getExprLoc();
4335 if (!findMacroSpelling(loc, "NULL"))
Chandler Carruth82214a82011-02-18 23:54:50 +00004336 return false;
4337 }
4338
4339 int DiagType = (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_CXX0X_nullptr);
4340 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands_null)
4341 << NonPointerExpr->getType() << DiagType
4342 << NonPointerExpr->getSourceRange();
4343 return true;
4344}
4345
Richard Trieu26f96072011-09-02 01:51:02 +00004346/// \brief Return false if the condition expression is valid, true otherwise.
4347static bool checkCondition(Sema &S, Expr *Cond) {
4348 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4349
4350 // C99 6.5.15p2
4351 if (CondTy->isScalarType()) return false;
4352
4353 // OpenCL: Sec 6.3.i says the condition is allowed to be a vector or scalar.
4354 if (S.getLangOptions().OpenCL && CondTy->isVectorType())
4355 return false;
4356
4357 // Emit the proper error message.
4358 S.Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), S.getLangOptions().OpenCL ?
4359 diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar :
4360 diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar_or_vector)
4361 << CondTy;
4362 return true;
4363}
4364
4365/// \brief Return false if the two expressions can be converted to a vector,
4366/// true otherwise
4367static bool checkConditionalConvertScalarsToVectors(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
4368 ExprResult &RHS,
4369 QualType CondTy) {
4370 // Both operands should be of scalar type.
4371 if (!LHS.get()->getType()->isScalarType()) {
4372 S.Diag(LHS.get()->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4373 << CondTy;
4374 return true;
4375 }
4376 if (!RHS.get()->getType()->isScalarType()) {
4377 S.Diag(RHS.get()->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4378 << CondTy;
4379 return true;
4380 }
4381
4382 // Implicity convert these scalars to the type of the condition.
4383 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.take(), CondTy, CK_IntegralCast);
4384 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.take(), CondTy, CK_IntegralCast);
4385 return false;
4386}
4387
4388/// \brief Handle when one or both operands are void type.
4389static QualType checkConditionalVoidType(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
4390 ExprResult &RHS) {
4391 Expr *LHSExpr = LHS.get();
4392 Expr *RHSExpr = RHS.get();
4393
4394 if (!LHSExpr->getType()->isVoidType())
4395 S.Diag(RHSExpr->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4396 << RHSExpr->getSourceRange();
4397 if (!RHSExpr->getType()->isVoidType())
4398 S.Diag(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4399 << LHSExpr->getSourceRange();
4400 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.take(), S.Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
4401 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.take(), S.Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
4402 return S.Context.VoidTy;
4403}
4404
4405/// \brief Return false if the NullExpr can be promoted to PointerTy,
4406/// true otherwise.
4407static bool checkConditionalNullPointer(Sema &S, ExprResult &NullExpr,
4408 QualType PointerTy) {
4409 if ((!PointerTy->isAnyPointerType() && !PointerTy->isBlockPointerType()) ||
4410 !NullExpr.get()->isNullPointerConstant(S.Context,
4411 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
4412 return true;
4413
4414 NullExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(NullExpr.take(), PointerTy, CK_NullToPointer);
4415 return false;
4416}
4417
4418/// \brief Checks compatibility between two pointers and return the resulting
4419/// type.
4420static QualType checkConditionalPointerCompatibility(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
4421 ExprResult &RHS,
4422 SourceLocation Loc) {
4423 QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
4424 QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType();
4425
4426 if (S.Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, RHSTy)) {
4427 // Two identical pointers types are always compatible.
4428 return LHSTy;
4429 }
4430
4431 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
4432
4433 // Get the pointee types.
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00004434 if (const BlockPointerType *LHSBTy = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4435 lhptee = LHSBTy->getPointeeType();
4436 rhptee = RHSTy->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Richard Trieu26f96072011-09-02 01:51:02 +00004437 } else {
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00004438 lhptee = LHSTy->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4439 rhptee = RHSTy->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Richard Trieu26f96072011-09-02 01:51:02 +00004440 }
4441
4442 if (!S.Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4443 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4444 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4445 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
4446 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
4447 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4448 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4449 // to get a consistent AST.
4450 QualType incompatTy = S.Context.getPointerType(S.Context.VoidTy);
4451 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.take(), incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4452 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.take(), incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4453 return incompatTy;
4454 }
4455
4456 // The pointer types are compatible.
4457 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4458 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4459 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4460 // type.
4461 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4462 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
4463
4464 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.take(), LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4465 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.take(), LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4466 return LHSTy;
4467}
4468
4469/// \brief Return the resulting type when the operands are both block pointers.
4470static QualType checkConditionalBlockPointerCompatibility(Sema &S,
4471 ExprResult &LHS,
4472 ExprResult &RHS,
4473 SourceLocation Loc) {
4474 QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
4475 QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType();
4476
4477 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4478 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4479 QualType destType = S.Context.getPointerType(S.Context.VoidTy);
4480 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.take(), destType, CK_BitCast);
4481 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.take(), destType, CK_BitCast);
4482 return destType;
4483 }
4484 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4485 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
4486 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
4487 return QualType();
4488 }
4489
4490 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4491 return checkConditionalPointerCompatibility(S, LHS, RHS, Loc);
4492}
4493
4494/// \brief Return the resulting type when the operands are both pointers.
4495static QualType
4496checkConditionalObjectPointersCompatibility(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
4497 ExprResult &RHS,
4498 SourceLocation Loc) {
4499 // get the pointer types
4500 QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
4501 QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType();
4502
4503 // get the "pointed to" types
4504 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4505 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4506
4507 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4508 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4509 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
4510 QualType destPointee
4511 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4512 QualType destType = S.Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4513 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4514 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.take(), destType, CK_NoOp);
4515 // Promote to void*.
4516 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.take(), destType, CK_BitCast);
4517 return destType;
4518 }
4519 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4520 QualType destPointee
4521 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4522 QualType destType = S.Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4523 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4524 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.take(), destType, CK_NoOp);
4525 // Promote to void*.
4526 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.take(), destType, CK_BitCast);
4527 return destType;
4528 }
4529
4530 return checkConditionalPointerCompatibility(S, LHS, RHS, Loc);
4531}
4532
4533/// \brief Return false if the first expression is not an integer and the second
4534/// expression is not a pointer, true otherwise.
4535static bool checkPointerIntegerMismatch(Sema &S, ExprResult &Int,
4536 Expr* PointerExpr, SourceLocation Loc,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00004537 bool IsIntFirstExpr) {
Richard Trieu26f96072011-09-02 01:51:02 +00004538 if (!PointerExpr->getType()->isPointerType() ||
4539 !Int.get()->getType()->isIntegerType())
4540 return false;
4541
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00004542 Expr *Expr1 = IsIntFirstExpr ? Int.get() : PointerExpr;
4543 Expr *Expr2 = IsIntFirstExpr ? PointerExpr : Int.get();
Richard Trieu26f96072011-09-02 01:51:02 +00004544
4545 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4546 << Expr1->getType() << Expr2->getType()
4547 << Expr1->getSourceRange() << Expr2->getSourceRange();
4548 Int = S.ImpCastExprToType(Int.take(), PointerExpr->getType(),
4549 CK_IntegralToPointer);
4550 return true;
4551}
4552
Richard Trieu33fc7572011-09-06 20:06:39 +00004553/// Note that LHS is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4554/// In that case, LHS = cond.
Chris Lattnera119a3b2009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004555/// C99 6.5.15
Richard Trieu67e29332011-08-02 04:35:43 +00004556QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(ExprResult &Cond, ExprResult &LHS,
4557 ExprResult &RHS, ExprValueKind &VK,
4558 ExprObjectKind &OK,
Chris Lattnera119a3b2009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004559 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00004560
Richard Trieu33fc7572011-09-06 20:06:39 +00004561 ExprResult LHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHS.get());
4562 if (!LHSResult.isUsable()) return QualType();
4563 LHS = move(LHSResult);
Douglas Gregor7ad5d422010-11-09 21:07:58 +00004564
Richard Trieu33fc7572011-09-06 20:06:39 +00004565 ExprResult RHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHS.get());
4566 if (!RHSResult.isUsable()) return QualType();
4567 RHS = move(RHSResult);
Douglas Gregor7ad5d422010-11-09 21:07:58 +00004568
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004569 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4570 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCall56ca35d2011-02-17 10:25:35 +00004571 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, VK, OK, QuestionLoc);
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00004572
4573 VK = VK_RValue;
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00004574 OK = OK_Ordinary;
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004575
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004576 Cond = UsualUnaryConversions(Cond.take());
4577 if (Cond.isInvalid())
4578 return QualType();
4579 LHS = UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.take());
4580 if (LHS.isInvalid())
4581 return QualType();
4582 RHS = UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.take());
4583 if (RHS.isInvalid())
4584 return QualType();
4585
4586 QualType CondTy = Cond.get()->getType();
4587 QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
4588 QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType();
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004589
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004590 // first, check the condition.
Richard Trieu26f96072011-09-02 01:51:02 +00004591 if (checkCondition(*this, Cond.get()))
4592 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004593
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004594 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004595 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
Eli Friedmanb9b4b782011-06-23 18:10:35 +00004596 return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc, /*isCompAssign*/false);
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004597
Nate Begeman6155d732010-09-20 22:41:17 +00004598 // OpenCL: If the condition is a vector, and both operands are scalar,
4599 // attempt to implicity convert them to the vector type to act like the
4600 // built in select.
Richard Trieu26f96072011-09-02 01:51:02 +00004601 if (getLangOptions().OpenCL && CondTy->isVectorType())
4602 if (checkConditionalConvertScalarsToVectors(*this, LHS, RHS, CondTy))
Nate Begeman6155d732010-09-20 22:41:17 +00004603 return QualType();
Nate Begeman6155d732010-09-20 22:41:17 +00004604
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004605 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4606 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004607 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4608 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004609 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
4610 return QualType();
4611 return LHS.get()->getType();
Steve Naroffa4332e22007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004612 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004613
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004614 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4615 // type.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004616 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4617 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattnera21ddb32007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004618 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004619 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004620 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004621 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004622 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004623 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004624
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004625 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffe701c0a2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004626 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004627 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
Richard Trieu26f96072011-09-02 01:51:02 +00004628 return checkConditionalVoidType(*this, LHS, RHS);
Steve Naroffe701c0a2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004629 }
Richard Trieu26f96072011-09-02 01:51:02 +00004630
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004631 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4632 // the type of the other operand."
Richard Trieu26f96072011-09-02 01:51:02 +00004633 if (!checkConditionalNullPointer(*this, RHS, LHSTy)) return LHSTy;
4634 if (!checkConditionalNullPointer(*this, LHS, RHSTy)) return RHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004635
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004636 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4637 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4638 QuestionLoc);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004639 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
4640 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004641 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4642 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004643
4644
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004645 // Handle block pointer types.
Richard Trieu26f96072011-09-02 01:51:02 +00004646 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType())
4647 return checkConditionalBlockPointerCompatibility(*this, LHS, RHS,
4648 QuestionLoc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004649
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004650 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
Richard Trieu26f96072011-09-02 01:51:02 +00004651 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType())
4652 return checkConditionalObjectPointersCompatibility(*this, LHS, RHS,
4653 QuestionLoc);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004654
John McCall404cd162010-11-13 01:35:44 +00004655 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch. Note that
4656 // null pointers have been filtered out by this point.
Richard Trieu26f96072011-09-02 01:51:02 +00004657 if (checkPointerIntegerMismatch(*this, LHS, RHS.get(), QuestionLoc,
4658 /*isIntFirstExpr=*/true))
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004659 return RHSTy;
Richard Trieu26f96072011-09-02 01:51:02 +00004660 if (checkPointerIntegerMismatch(*this, RHS, LHS.get(), QuestionLoc,
4661 /*isIntFirstExpr=*/false))
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004662 return LHSTy;
Daniel Dunbar5e155f02008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004663
Chandler Carruth82214a82011-02-18 23:54:50 +00004664 // Emit a better diagnostic if one of the expressions is a null pointer
4665 // constant and the other is not a pointer type. In this case, the user most
4666 // likely forgot to take the address of the other expression.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004667 if (DiagnoseConditionalForNull(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), QuestionLoc))
Chandler Carruth82214a82011-02-18 23:54:50 +00004668 return QualType();
4669
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004670 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004671 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Richard Trieu67e29332011-08-02 04:35:43 +00004672 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
4673 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004674 return QualType();
4675}
4676
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004677/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4678/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004679QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
Richard Trieu67e29332011-08-02 04:35:43 +00004680 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004681 QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
4682 QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004683
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004684 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4685 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4686 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4687 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
Douglas Gregor01a4cf12011-08-11 20:58:55 +00004688 (Context.hasSameType(RHSTy, Context.getObjCClassRedefinitionType()))) {
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00004689 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.take(), LHSTy, CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004690 return LHSTy;
4691 }
4692 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
Douglas Gregor01a4cf12011-08-11 20:58:55 +00004693 (Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, Context.getObjCClassRedefinitionType()))) {
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00004694 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.take(), RHSTy, CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004695 return RHSTy;
4696 }
4697 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4698 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
Douglas Gregor01a4cf12011-08-11 20:58:55 +00004699 (Context.hasSameType(RHSTy, Context.getObjCIdRedefinitionType()))) {
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00004700 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.take(), LHSTy, CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004701 return LHSTy;
4702 }
4703 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
Douglas Gregor01a4cf12011-08-11 20:58:55 +00004704 (Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, Context.getObjCIdRedefinitionType()))) {
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00004705 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.take(), RHSTy, CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004706 return RHSTy;
4707 }
4708 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4709 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
Douglas Gregor01a4cf12011-08-11 20:58:55 +00004710 (Context.hasSameType(RHSTy, Context.getObjCSelRedefinitionType()))) {
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004711 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.take(), LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004712 return LHSTy;
4713 }
4714 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
Douglas Gregor01a4cf12011-08-11 20:58:55 +00004715 (Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, Context.getObjCSelRedefinitionType()))) {
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004716 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.take(), RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004717 return RHSTy;
4718 }
4719 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4720 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004721
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004722 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4723 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4724 return LHSTy;
4725 }
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00004726 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4727 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004728 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004729
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004730 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4731 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4732 // type. This allows
4733 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4734 // where B is a subclass of A.
4735 //
4736 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4737 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4738 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4739 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004740
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004741 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4742 // It could return the composite type.
4743 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4744 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4745 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4746 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4747 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4748 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4749 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4750 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4751 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4752 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4753 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4754 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4755 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4756 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004757 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004758 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4759 ;
4760 else {
4761 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4762 << LHSTy << RHSTy
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004763 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004764 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004765 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.take(), incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4766 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.take(), incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004767 return incompatTy;
4768 }
4769 // The object pointer types are compatible.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004770 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.take(), compositeType, CK_BitCast);
4771 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.take(), compositeType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004772 return compositeType;
4773 }
4774 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
4775 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4776 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4777 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4778 QualType destPointee
4779 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4780 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4781 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004782 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.take(), destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004783 // Promote to void*.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004784 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.take(), destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004785 return destType;
4786 }
4787 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4788 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4789 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4790 QualType destPointee
4791 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4792 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4793 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004794 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.take(), destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004795 // Promote to void*.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004796 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.take(), destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004797 return destType;
4798 }
4799 return QualType();
4800}
4801
Chandler Carruthf0b60d62011-06-16 01:05:14 +00004802/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a note with a fixit hint that wraps
Hans Wennborg9cfdae32011-06-03 18:00:36 +00004803/// ParenRange in parentheses.
4804static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
Chandler Carruthf0b60d62011-06-16 01:05:14 +00004805 const PartialDiagnostic &Note,
4806 SourceRange ParenRange) {
4807 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(ParenRange.getEnd());
4808 if (ParenRange.getBegin().isFileID() && ParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() &&
4809 EndLoc.isValid()) {
4810 Self.Diag(Loc, Note)
4811 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(ParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
4812 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
4813 } else {
4814 // We can't display the parentheses, so just show the bare note.
4815 Self.Diag(Loc, Note) << ParenRange;
Hans Wennborg9cfdae32011-06-03 18:00:36 +00004816 }
Hans Wennborg9cfdae32011-06-03 18:00:36 +00004817}
4818
4819static bool IsArithmeticOp(BinaryOperatorKind Opc) {
4820 return Opc >= BO_Mul && Opc <= BO_Shr;
4821}
4822
Hans Wennborg2f072b42011-06-09 17:06:51 +00004823/// IsArithmeticBinaryExpr - Returns true if E is an arithmetic binary
4824/// expression, either using a built-in or overloaded operator,
Richard Trieu33fc7572011-09-06 20:06:39 +00004825/// and sets *OpCode to the opcode and *RHSExprs to the right-hand side
4826/// expression.
Hans Wennborg2f072b42011-06-09 17:06:51 +00004827static bool IsArithmeticBinaryExpr(Expr *E, BinaryOperatorKind *Opcode,
Richard Trieu33fc7572011-09-06 20:06:39 +00004828 Expr **RHSExprs) {
Hans Wennborgcb4d7c22011-09-12 12:07:30 +00004829 // Don't strip parenthesis: we should not warn if E is in parenthesis.
4830 E = E->IgnoreImpCasts();
Hans Wennborg2f072b42011-06-09 17:06:51 +00004831 E = E->IgnoreConversionOperator();
Hans Wennborgcb4d7c22011-09-12 12:07:30 +00004832 E = E->IgnoreImpCasts();
Hans Wennborg2f072b42011-06-09 17:06:51 +00004833
4834 // Built-in binary operator.
4835 if (BinaryOperator *OP = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
4836 if (IsArithmeticOp(OP->getOpcode())) {
4837 *Opcode = OP->getOpcode();
Richard Trieu33fc7572011-09-06 20:06:39 +00004838 *RHSExprs = OP->getRHS();
Hans Wennborg2f072b42011-06-09 17:06:51 +00004839 return true;
4840 }
4841 }
4842
4843 // Overloaded operator.
4844 if (CXXOperatorCallExpr *Call = dyn_cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
4845 if (Call->getNumArgs() != 2)
4846 return false;
4847
4848 // Make sure this is really a binary operator that is safe to pass into
4849 // BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOpcode(), e.g. it's not a subscript op.
4850 OverloadedOperatorKind OO = Call->getOperator();
4851 if (OO < OO_Plus || OO > OO_Arrow)
4852 return false;
4853
4854 BinaryOperatorKind OpKind = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOpcode(OO);
4855 if (IsArithmeticOp(OpKind)) {
4856 *Opcode = OpKind;
Richard Trieu33fc7572011-09-06 20:06:39 +00004857 *RHSExprs = Call->getArg(1);
Hans Wennborg2f072b42011-06-09 17:06:51 +00004858 return true;
4859 }
4860 }
4861
4862 return false;
4863}
4864
Hans Wennborg9cfdae32011-06-03 18:00:36 +00004865static bool IsLogicOp(BinaryOperatorKind Opc) {
4866 return (Opc >= BO_LT && Opc <= BO_NE) || (Opc >= BO_LAnd && Opc <= BO_LOr);
4867}
4868
Hans Wennborg2f072b42011-06-09 17:06:51 +00004869/// ExprLooksBoolean - Returns true if E looks boolean, i.e. it has boolean type
4870/// or is a logical expression such as (x==y) which has int type, but is
4871/// commonly interpreted as boolean.
4872static bool ExprLooksBoolean(Expr *E) {
4873 E = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
4874
4875 if (E->getType()->isBooleanType())
4876 return true;
4877 if (BinaryOperator *OP = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E))
4878 return IsLogicOp(OP->getOpcode());
4879 if (UnaryOperator *OP = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E))
4880 return OP->getOpcode() == UO_LNot;
4881
4882 return false;
4883}
4884
Hans Wennborg9cfdae32011-06-03 18:00:36 +00004885/// DiagnoseConditionalPrecedence - Emit a warning when a conditional operator
4886/// and binary operator are mixed in a way that suggests the programmer assumed
4887/// the conditional operator has higher precedence, for example:
4888/// "int x = a + someBinaryCondition ? 1 : 2".
4889static void DiagnoseConditionalPrecedence(Sema &Self,
4890 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Chandler Carruth43bc78d2011-06-16 01:05:08 +00004891 Expr *Condition,
Richard Trieu33fc7572011-09-06 20:06:39 +00004892 Expr *LHSExpr,
4893 Expr *RHSExpr) {
Hans Wennborg2f072b42011-06-09 17:06:51 +00004894 BinaryOperatorKind CondOpcode;
4895 Expr *CondRHS;
Hans Wennborg9cfdae32011-06-03 18:00:36 +00004896
Chandler Carruth43bc78d2011-06-16 01:05:08 +00004897 if (!IsArithmeticBinaryExpr(Condition, &CondOpcode, &CondRHS))
Hans Wennborg2f072b42011-06-09 17:06:51 +00004898 return;
4899 if (!ExprLooksBoolean(CondRHS))
4900 return;
Hans Wennborg9cfdae32011-06-03 18:00:36 +00004901
Hans Wennborg2f072b42011-06-09 17:06:51 +00004902 // The condition is an arithmetic binary expression, with a right-
4903 // hand side that looks boolean, so warn.
Hans Wennborg9cfdae32011-06-03 18:00:36 +00004904
Chandler Carruthf0b60d62011-06-16 01:05:14 +00004905 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_precedence_conditional)
Chandler Carruth43bc78d2011-06-16 01:05:08 +00004906 << Condition->getSourceRange()
Hans Wennborg2f072b42011-06-09 17:06:51 +00004907 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(CondOpcode);
Hans Wennborg9cfdae32011-06-03 18:00:36 +00004908
Chandler Carruthf0b60d62011-06-16 01:05:14 +00004909 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
4910 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_conditional_silence)
4911 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(CondOpcode),
4912 SourceRange(Condition->getLocStart(), Condition->getLocEnd()));
Chandler Carruth9d5353c2011-06-21 23:04:18 +00004913
4914 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
4915 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_conditional_first),
Richard Trieu33fc7572011-09-06 20:06:39 +00004916 SourceRange(CondRHS->getLocStart(), RHSExpr->getLocEnd()));
Hans Wennborg9cfdae32011-06-03 18:00:36 +00004917}
4918
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004919/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004920/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004921ExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
John McCall56ca35d2011-02-17 10:25:35 +00004922 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
4923 Expr *CondExpr, Expr *LHSExpr,
4924 Expr *RHSExpr) {
Chris Lattnera21ddb32007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004925 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
4926 // was the condition.
John McCall56ca35d2011-02-17 10:25:35 +00004927 OpaqueValueExpr *opaqueValue = 0;
4928 Expr *commonExpr = 0;
4929 if (LHSExpr == 0) {
4930 commonExpr = CondExpr;
4931
4932 // We usually want to apply unary conversions *before* saving, except
4933 // in the special case of a C++ l-value conditional.
4934 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
4935 && !commonExpr->isTypeDependent()
4936 && commonExpr->getValueKind() == RHSExpr->getValueKind()
4937 && commonExpr->isGLValue()
4938 && commonExpr->isOrdinaryOrBitFieldObject()
4939 && RHSExpr->isOrdinaryOrBitFieldObject()
4940 && Context.hasSameType(commonExpr->getType(), RHSExpr->getType()))) {
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004941 ExprResult commonRes = UsualUnaryConversions(commonExpr);
4942 if (commonRes.isInvalid())
4943 return ExprError();
4944 commonExpr = commonRes.take();
John McCall56ca35d2011-02-17 10:25:35 +00004945 }
4946
4947 opaqueValue = new (Context) OpaqueValueExpr(commonExpr->getExprLoc(),
4948 commonExpr->getType(),
4949 commonExpr->getValueKind(),
4950 commonExpr->getObjectKind());
4951 LHSExpr = CondExpr = opaqueValue;
Fariborz Jahanianf9b949f2010-08-31 18:02:20 +00004952 }
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004953
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00004954 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue;
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00004955 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary;
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004956 ExprResult Cond = Owned(CondExpr), LHS = Owned(LHSExpr), RHS = Owned(RHSExpr);
4957 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS,
John McCall56ca35d2011-02-17 10:25:35 +00004958 VK, OK, QuestionLoc);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004959 if (result.isNull() || Cond.isInvalid() || LHS.isInvalid() ||
4960 RHS.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004961 return ExprError();
4962
Hans Wennborg9cfdae32011-06-03 18:00:36 +00004963 DiagnoseConditionalPrecedence(*this, QuestionLoc, Cond.get(), LHS.get(),
4964 RHS.get());
4965
John McCall56ca35d2011-02-17 10:25:35 +00004966 if (!commonExpr)
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004967 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(Cond.take(), QuestionLoc,
4968 LHS.take(), ColonLoc,
4969 RHS.take(), result, VK, OK));
John McCall56ca35d2011-02-17 10:25:35 +00004970
4971 return Owned(new (Context)
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004972 BinaryConditionalOperator(commonExpr, opaqueValue, Cond.take(), LHS.take(),
Richard Trieu67e29332011-08-02 04:35:43 +00004973 RHS.take(), QuestionLoc, ColonLoc, result, VK,
4974 OK));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004975}
4976
John McCalle4be87e2011-01-31 23:13:11 +00004977// checkPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004978// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004979// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
4980// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
4981// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
John McCalle4be87e2011-01-31 23:13:11 +00004982static Sema::AssignConvertType
Richard Trieu1da27a12011-09-06 20:21:22 +00004983checkPointerTypesForAssignment(Sema &S, QualType LHSType, QualType RHSType) {
4984 assert(LHSType.isCanonical() && "LHS not canonicalized!");
4985 assert(RHSType.isCanonical() && "RHS not canonicalized!");
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004986
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004987 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
John McCall86c05f32011-02-01 00:10:29 +00004988 const Type *lhptee, *rhptee;
4989 Qualifiers lhq, rhq;
Richard Trieu1da27a12011-09-06 20:21:22 +00004990 llvm::tie(lhptee, lhq) = cast<PointerType>(LHSType)->getPointeeType().split();
4991 llvm::tie(rhptee, rhq) = cast<PointerType>(RHSType)->getPointeeType().split();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004992
John McCalle4be87e2011-01-31 23:13:11 +00004993 Sema::AssignConvertType ConvTy = Sema::Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004994
4995 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
4996 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
4997 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
John McCall86c05f32011-02-01 00:10:29 +00004998 Qualifiers lq;
4999
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005000 // As a special case, 'non-__weak A *' -> 'non-__weak const *' is okay.
5001 if (lhq.getObjCLifetime() != rhq.getObjCLifetime() &&
5002 lhq.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(rhq)) {
5003 // Ignore lifetime for further calculation.
5004 lhq.removeObjCLifetime();
5005 rhq.removeObjCLifetime();
5006 }
5007
John McCall86c05f32011-02-01 00:10:29 +00005008 if (!lhq.compatiblyIncludes(rhq)) {
5009 // Treat address-space mismatches as fatal. TODO: address subspaces
5010 if (lhq.getAddressSpace() != rhq.getAddressSpace())
5011 ConvTy = Sema::IncompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
5012
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005013 // It's okay to add or remove GC or lifetime qualifiers when converting to
John McCall22348732011-03-26 02:56:45 +00005014 // and from void*.
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005015 else if (lhq.withoutObjCGCAttr().withoutObjCGLifetime()
5016 .compatiblyIncludes(
5017 rhq.withoutObjCGCAttr().withoutObjCGLifetime())
John McCall22348732011-03-26 02:56:45 +00005018 && (lhptee->isVoidType() || rhptee->isVoidType()))
5019 ; // keep old
5020
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005021 // Treat lifetime mismatches as fatal.
5022 else if (lhq.getObjCLifetime() != rhq.getObjCLifetime())
5023 ConvTy = Sema::IncompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
5024
John McCall86c05f32011-02-01 00:10:29 +00005025 // For GCC compatibility, other qualifier mismatches are treated
5026 // as still compatible in C.
5027 else ConvTy = Sema::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
5028 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005029
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005030 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
5031 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005032 // version of void...
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00005033 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00005034 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005035 return ConvTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005036
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00005037 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00005038 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
John McCalle4be87e2011-01-31 23:13:11 +00005039 return Sema::FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00005040 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005041
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00005042 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00005043 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005044 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00005045
5046 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00005047 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
John McCalle4be87e2011-01-31 23:13:11 +00005048 return Sema::FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00005049 }
John McCall86c05f32011-02-01 00:10:29 +00005050
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005051 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005052 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
John McCall86c05f32011-02-01 00:10:29 +00005053 QualType ltrans = QualType(lhptee, 0), rtrans = QualType(rhptee, 0);
5054 if (!S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ltrans, rtrans)) {
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00005055 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
5056 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
5057 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00005058 if (lhptee->isCharType())
John McCall86c05f32011-02-01 00:10:29 +00005059 ltrans = S.Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005060 else if (lhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
John McCall86c05f32011-02-01 00:10:29 +00005061 ltrans = S.Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(ltrans);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005062
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00005063 if (rhptee->isCharType())
John McCall86c05f32011-02-01 00:10:29 +00005064 rtrans = S.Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005065 else if (rhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
John McCall86c05f32011-02-01 00:10:29 +00005066 rtrans = S.Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rtrans);
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00005067
John McCall86c05f32011-02-01 00:10:29 +00005068 if (ltrans == rtrans) {
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00005069 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
5070 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
5071 // warning can be disabled.
John McCalle4be87e2011-01-31 23:13:11 +00005072 if (ConvTy != Sema::Compatible)
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00005073 return ConvTy;
John McCall86c05f32011-02-01 00:10:29 +00005074
John McCalle4be87e2011-01-31 23:13:11 +00005075 return Sema::IncompatiblePointerSign;
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00005076 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005077
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00005078 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
5079 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
5080 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
5081 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
John McCalle4be87e2011-01-31 23:13:11 +00005082 if (isa<PointerType>(lhptee) && isa<PointerType>(rhptee)) {
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00005083 do {
John McCall86c05f32011-02-01 00:10:29 +00005084 lhptee = cast<PointerType>(lhptee)->getPointeeType().getTypePtr();
5085 rhptee = cast<PointerType>(rhptee)->getPointeeType().getTypePtr();
John McCalle4be87e2011-01-31 23:13:11 +00005086 } while (isa<PointerType>(lhptee) && isa<PointerType>(rhptee));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005087
John McCall86c05f32011-02-01 00:10:29 +00005088 if (lhptee == rhptee)
John McCalle4be87e2011-01-31 23:13:11 +00005089 return Sema::IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00005090 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005091
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00005092 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
John McCalle4be87e2011-01-31 23:13:11 +00005093 return Sema::IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00005094 }
Fariborz Jahanian53c81672011-10-05 00:05:34 +00005095 if (!S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
5096 S.IsNoReturnConversion(ltrans, rtrans, ltrans))
5097 return Sema::IncompatiblePointer;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005098 return ConvTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005099}
5100
John McCalle4be87e2011-01-31 23:13:11 +00005101/// checkBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005102/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
5103/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
5104// types.
John McCalle4be87e2011-01-31 23:13:11 +00005105static Sema::AssignConvertType
Richard Trieu1da27a12011-09-06 20:21:22 +00005106checkBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(Sema &S, QualType LHSType,
5107 QualType RHSType) {
5108 assert(LHSType.isCanonical() && "LHS not canonicalized!");
5109 assert(RHSType.isCanonical() && "RHS not canonicalized!");
John McCalle4be87e2011-01-31 23:13:11 +00005110
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005111 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005112
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005113 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Richard Trieu1da27a12011-09-06 20:21:22 +00005114 lhptee = cast<BlockPointerType>(LHSType)->getPointeeType();
5115 rhptee = cast<BlockPointerType>(RHSType)->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005116
John McCalle4be87e2011-01-31 23:13:11 +00005117 // In C++, the types have to match exactly.
5118 if (S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
5119 return Sema::IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005120
John McCalle4be87e2011-01-31 23:13:11 +00005121 Sema::AssignConvertType ConvTy = Sema::Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005122
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005123 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
John McCalle4be87e2011-01-31 23:13:11 +00005124 if (lhptee.getLocalQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalQualifiers())
5125 ConvTy = Sema::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005126
Richard Trieu1da27a12011-09-06 20:21:22 +00005127 if (!S.Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(LHSType, RHSType))
John McCalle4be87e2011-01-31 23:13:11 +00005128 return Sema::IncompatibleBlockPointer;
5129
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005130 return ConvTy;
5131}
5132
John McCalle4be87e2011-01-31 23:13:11 +00005133/// checkObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00005134/// for assignment compatibility.
John McCalle4be87e2011-01-31 23:13:11 +00005135static Sema::AssignConvertType
Richard Trieu1da27a12011-09-06 20:21:22 +00005136checkObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(Sema &S, QualType LHSType,
5137 QualType RHSType) {
5138 assert(LHSType.isCanonical() && "LHS was not canonicalized!");
5139 assert(RHSType.isCanonical() && "RHS was not canonicalized!");
John McCalle4be87e2011-01-31 23:13:11 +00005140
Richard Trieu1da27a12011-09-06 20:21:22 +00005141 if (LHSType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00005142 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Richard Trieu1da27a12011-09-06 20:21:22 +00005143 if (LHSType->isObjCClassType() && !RHSType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
5144 !RHSType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
John McCalle4be87e2011-01-31 23:13:11 +00005145 return Sema::IncompatiblePointer;
5146 return Sema::Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00005147 }
Richard Trieu1da27a12011-09-06 20:21:22 +00005148 if (RHSType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Richard Trieu1da27a12011-09-06 20:21:22 +00005149 if (RHSType->isObjCClassType() && !LHSType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
5150 !LHSType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahanian412a4962011-09-15 20:40:18 +00005151 return Sema::IncompatiblePointer;
John McCalle4be87e2011-01-31 23:13:11 +00005152 return Sema::Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00005153 }
Richard Trieu1da27a12011-09-06 20:21:22 +00005154 QualType lhptee = LHSType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5155 QualType rhptee = RHSType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005156
John McCalle4be87e2011-01-31 23:13:11 +00005157 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
5158 return Sema::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
5159
Richard Trieu1da27a12011-09-06 20:21:22 +00005160 if (S.Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSType, RHSType))
John McCalle4be87e2011-01-31 23:13:11 +00005161 return Sema::Compatible;
Richard Trieu1da27a12011-09-06 20:21:22 +00005162 if (LHSType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || RHSType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
John McCalle4be87e2011-01-31 23:13:11 +00005163 return Sema::IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
5164 return Sema::IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00005165}
5166
John McCall1c23e912010-11-16 02:32:08 +00005167Sema::AssignConvertType
Douglas Gregorb608b982011-01-28 02:26:04 +00005168Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(SourceLocation Loc,
Richard Trieu1da27a12011-09-06 20:21:22 +00005169 QualType LHSType, QualType RHSType) {
John McCall1c23e912010-11-16 02:32:08 +00005170 // Fake up an opaque expression. We don't actually care about what
5171 // cast operations are required, so if CheckAssignmentConstraints
5172 // adds casts to this they'll be wasted, but fortunately that doesn't
5173 // usually happen on valid code.
Richard Trieu1da27a12011-09-06 20:21:22 +00005174 OpaqueValueExpr RHSExpr(Loc, RHSType, VK_RValue);
5175 ExprResult RHSPtr = &RHSExpr;
John McCall1c23e912010-11-16 02:32:08 +00005176 CastKind K = CK_Invalid;
5177
Richard Trieu1da27a12011-09-06 20:21:22 +00005178 return CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSPtr, K);
John McCall1c23e912010-11-16 02:32:08 +00005179}
5180
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005181/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
5182/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005183/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
5184///
5185/// int a, *pint;
5186/// short *pshort;
5187/// struct foo *pfoo;
5188///
5189/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
5190/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
5191/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
5192/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
5193///
5194/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005195/// C99 spec dictates.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005196///
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005197/// Sets 'Kind' for any result kind except Incompatible.
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005198Sema::AssignConvertType
Richard Trieufacef2e2011-09-06 20:30:53 +00005199Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType LHSType, ExprResult &RHS,
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005200 CastKind &Kind) {
Richard Trieufacef2e2011-09-06 20:30:53 +00005201 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType();
5202 QualType OrigLHSType = LHSType;
John McCall1c23e912010-11-16 02:32:08 +00005203
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00005204 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
5205 // them.
Richard Trieufacef2e2011-09-06 20:30:53 +00005206 LHSType = Context.getCanonicalType(LHSType).getUnqualifiedType();
5207 RHSType = Context.getCanonicalType(RHSType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00005208
Eli Friedmanb001de72011-10-06 23:00:33 +00005209 // We can't do assignment from/to atomics yet.
5210 if (LHSType->isAtomicType())
5211 return Incompatible;
5212
John McCallb6cfa242011-01-31 22:28:28 +00005213 // Common case: no conversion required.
Richard Trieufacef2e2011-09-06 20:30:53 +00005214 if (LHSType == RHSType) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005215 Kind = CK_NoOp;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005216 return Compatible;
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00005217 }
5218
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00005219 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
5220 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
5221 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
5222 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
5223 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
Richard Trieufacef2e2011-09-06 20:30:53 +00005224 // LHSType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00005225 // type.
Richard Trieufacef2e2011-09-06 20:30:53 +00005226 if (const ReferenceType *LHSTypeRef = LHSType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
5227 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSTypeRef->getPointeeType(), RHSType)) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005228 Kind = CK_LValueBitCast;
Anders Carlsson793680e2007-10-12 23:56:29 +00005229 return Compatible;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005230 }
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00005231 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahanian411f3732007-12-19 17:45:58 +00005232 }
John McCallb6cfa242011-01-31 22:28:28 +00005233
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005234 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
5235 // to the same ExtVector type.
Richard Trieufacef2e2011-09-06 20:30:53 +00005236 if (LHSType->isExtVectorType()) {
5237 if (RHSType->isExtVectorType())
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005238 return Incompatible;
Richard Trieufacef2e2011-09-06 20:30:53 +00005239 if (RHSType->isArithmeticType()) {
John McCall1c23e912010-11-16 02:32:08 +00005240 // CK_VectorSplat does T -> vector T, so first cast to the
5241 // element type.
Richard Trieufacef2e2011-09-06 20:30:53 +00005242 QualType elType = cast<ExtVectorType>(LHSType)->getElementType();
5243 if (elType != RHSType) {
John McCalla180f042011-10-06 23:25:11 +00005244 Kind = PrepareScalarCast(RHS, elType);
Richard Trieufacef2e2011-09-06 20:30:53 +00005245 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.take(), elType, Kind);
John McCall1c23e912010-11-16 02:32:08 +00005246 }
5247 Kind = CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005248 return Compatible;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005249 }
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005250 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005251
John McCallb6cfa242011-01-31 22:28:28 +00005252 // Conversions to or from vector type.
Richard Trieufacef2e2011-09-06 20:30:53 +00005253 if (LHSType->isVectorType() || RHSType->isVectorType()) {
5254 if (LHSType->isVectorType() && RHSType->isVectorType()) {
Bob Wilsonde3deea2010-12-02 00:25:15 +00005255 // Allow assignments of an AltiVec vector type to an equivalent GCC
5256 // vector type and vice versa
Richard Trieufacef2e2011-09-06 20:30:53 +00005257 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(LHSType, RHSType)) {
Bob Wilsonde3deea2010-12-02 00:25:15 +00005258 Kind = CK_BitCast;
5259 return Compatible;
5260 }
5261
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005262 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
5263 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
5264 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
5265 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
Richard Trieufacef2e2011-09-06 20:30:53 +00005266 (Context.getTypeSize(LHSType) == Context.getTypeSize(RHSType))) {
John McCall0c6d28d2010-11-15 10:08:00 +00005267 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005268 return IncompatibleVectors;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005269 }
Chris Lattnere8b3e962008-01-04 23:32:24 +00005270 }
5271 return Incompatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005272 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00005273
John McCallb6cfa242011-01-31 22:28:28 +00005274 // Arithmetic conversions.
Richard Trieufacef2e2011-09-06 20:30:53 +00005275 if (LHSType->isArithmeticType() && RHSType->isArithmeticType() &&
5276 !(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && LHSType->isEnumeralType())) {
John McCalla180f042011-10-06 23:25:11 +00005277 Kind = PrepareScalarCast(RHS, LHSType);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005278 return Compatible;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005279 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00005280
John McCallb6cfa242011-01-31 22:28:28 +00005281 // Conversions to normal pointers.
Richard Trieufacef2e2011-09-06 20:30:53 +00005282 if (const PointerType *LHSPointer = dyn_cast<PointerType>(LHSType)) {
John McCallb6cfa242011-01-31 22:28:28 +00005283 // U* -> T*
Richard Trieufacef2e2011-09-06 20:30:53 +00005284 if (isa<PointerType>(RHSType)) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005285 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Richard Trieufacef2e2011-09-06 20:30:53 +00005286 return checkPointerTypesForAssignment(*this, LHSType, RHSType);
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005287 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005288
John McCallb6cfa242011-01-31 22:28:28 +00005289 // int -> T*
Richard Trieufacef2e2011-09-06 20:30:53 +00005290 if (RHSType->isIntegerType()) {
John McCallb6cfa242011-01-31 22:28:28 +00005291 Kind = CK_IntegralToPointer; // FIXME: null?
5292 return IntToPointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005293 }
John McCallb6cfa242011-01-31 22:28:28 +00005294
5295 // C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers,
5296 // with two exceptions:
Richard Trieufacef2e2011-09-06 20:30:53 +00005297 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(RHSType)) {
John McCallb6cfa242011-01-31 22:28:28 +00005298 // - conversions to void*
Richard Trieufacef2e2011-09-06 20:30:53 +00005299 if (LHSPointer->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00005300 Kind = CK_BitCast;
John McCallb6cfa242011-01-31 22:28:28 +00005301 return Compatible;
5302 }
5303
5304 // - conversions from 'Class' to the redefinition type
Richard Trieufacef2e2011-09-06 20:30:53 +00005305 if (RHSType->isObjCClassType() &&
5306 Context.hasSameType(LHSType,
Douglas Gregor01a4cf12011-08-11 20:58:55 +00005307 Context.getObjCClassRedefinitionType())) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005308 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00005309 return Compatible;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005310 }
Douglas Gregorc737acb2011-09-27 16:10:05 +00005311
John McCallb6cfa242011-01-31 22:28:28 +00005312 Kind = CK_BitCast;
5313 return IncompatiblePointer;
5314 }
5315
5316 // U^ -> void*
Richard Trieufacef2e2011-09-06 20:30:53 +00005317 if (RHSType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
5318 if (LHSPointer->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
John McCallb6cfa242011-01-31 22:28:28 +00005319 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00005320 return Compatible;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005321 }
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00005322 }
John McCallb6cfa242011-01-31 22:28:28 +00005323
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005324 return Incompatible;
5325 }
5326
John McCallb6cfa242011-01-31 22:28:28 +00005327 // Conversions to block pointers.
Richard Trieufacef2e2011-09-06 20:30:53 +00005328 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(LHSType)) {
John McCallb6cfa242011-01-31 22:28:28 +00005329 // U^ -> T^
Richard Trieufacef2e2011-09-06 20:30:53 +00005330 if (RHSType->isBlockPointerType()) {
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00005331 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Richard Trieufacef2e2011-09-06 20:30:53 +00005332 return checkBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(*this, LHSType, RHSType);
John McCallb6cfa242011-01-31 22:28:28 +00005333 }
5334
5335 // int or null -> T^
Richard Trieufacef2e2011-09-06 20:30:53 +00005336 if (RHSType->isIntegerType()) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005337 Kind = CK_IntegralToPointer; // FIXME: null
Eli Friedmand8f4f432009-02-25 04:20:42 +00005338 return IntToBlockPointer;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005339 }
5340
John McCallb6cfa242011-01-31 22:28:28 +00005341 // id -> T^
Richard Trieufacef2e2011-09-06 20:30:53 +00005342 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && RHSType->isObjCIdType()) {
John McCallb6cfa242011-01-31 22:28:28 +00005343 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast;
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00005344 return Compatible;
John McCallb6cfa242011-01-31 22:28:28 +00005345 }
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00005346
John McCallb6cfa242011-01-31 22:28:28 +00005347 // void* -> T^
Richard Trieufacef2e2011-09-06 20:30:53 +00005348 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = RHSType->getAs<PointerType>())
John McCallb6cfa242011-01-31 22:28:28 +00005349 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
5350 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast;
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00005351 return Compatible;
John McCallb6cfa242011-01-31 22:28:28 +00005352 }
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005353
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00005354 return Incompatible;
5355 }
5356
John McCallb6cfa242011-01-31 22:28:28 +00005357 // Conversions to Objective-C pointers.
Richard Trieufacef2e2011-09-06 20:30:53 +00005358 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(LHSType)) {
John McCallb6cfa242011-01-31 22:28:28 +00005359 // A* -> B*
Richard Trieufacef2e2011-09-06 20:30:53 +00005360 if (RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
John McCallb6cfa242011-01-31 22:28:28 +00005361 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Fariborz Jahanian04e5a252011-07-07 18:55:47 +00005362 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
Richard Trieufacef2e2011-09-06 20:30:53 +00005363 checkObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(*this, LHSType, RHSType);
Fariborz Jahanian04e5a252011-07-07 18:55:47 +00005364 if (getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount &&
5365 result == Compatible &&
Richard Trieufacef2e2011-09-06 20:30:53 +00005366 !CheckObjCARCUnavailableWeakConversion(OrigLHSType, RHSType))
Fariborz Jahanian7a084ec2011-07-07 23:04:17 +00005367 result = IncompatibleObjCWeakRef;
Fariborz Jahanian04e5a252011-07-07 18:55:47 +00005368 return result;
John McCallb6cfa242011-01-31 22:28:28 +00005369 }
5370
5371 // int or null -> A*
Richard Trieufacef2e2011-09-06 20:30:53 +00005372 if (RHSType->isIntegerType()) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005373 Kind = CK_IntegralToPointer; // FIXME: null
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005374 return IntToPointer;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005375 }
5376
John McCallb6cfa242011-01-31 22:28:28 +00005377 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers,
5378 // with two exceptions:
Richard Trieufacef2e2011-09-06 20:30:53 +00005379 if (isa<PointerType>(RHSType)) {
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00005380 Kind = CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast;
5381
John McCallb6cfa242011-01-31 22:28:28 +00005382 // - conversions from 'void*'
Richard Trieufacef2e2011-09-06 20:30:53 +00005383 if (RHSType->isVoidPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00005384 return Compatible;
John McCallb6cfa242011-01-31 22:28:28 +00005385 }
5386
5387 // - conversions to 'Class' from its redefinition type
Richard Trieufacef2e2011-09-06 20:30:53 +00005388 if (LHSType->isObjCClassType() &&
5389 Context.hasSameType(RHSType,
Douglas Gregor01a4cf12011-08-11 20:58:55 +00005390 Context.getObjCClassRedefinitionType())) {
John McCallb6cfa242011-01-31 22:28:28 +00005391 return Compatible;
5392 }
5393
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00005394 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005395 }
John McCallb6cfa242011-01-31 22:28:28 +00005396
5397 // T^ -> A*
Richard Trieufacef2e2011-09-06 20:30:53 +00005398 if (RHSType->isBlockPointerType()) {
John McCalldc05b112011-09-10 01:16:55 +00005399 maybeExtendBlockObject(*this, RHS);
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00005400 Kind = CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005401 return Compatible;
John McCallb6cfa242011-01-31 22:28:28 +00005402 }
5403
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005404 return Incompatible;
5405 }
John McCallb6cfa242011-01-31 22:28:28 +00005406
5407 // Conversions from pointers that are not covered by the above.
Richard Trieufacef2e2011-09-06 20:30:53 +00005408 if (isa<PointerType>(RHSType)) {
John McCallb6cfa242011-01-31 22:28:28 +00005409 // T* -> _Bool
Richard Trieufacef2e2011-09-06 20:30:53 +00005410 if (LHSType == Context.BoolTy) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005411 Kind = CK_PointerToBoolean;
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00005412 return Compatible;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005413 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00005414
John McCallb6cfa242011-01-31 22:28:28 +00005415 // T* -> int
Richard Trieufacef2e2011-09-06 20:30:53 +00005416 if (LHSType->isIntegerType()) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005417 Kind = CK_PointerToIntegral;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00005418 return PointerToInt;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005419 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005420
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00005421 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00005422 }
John McCallb6cfa242011-01-31 22:28:28 +00005423
5424 // Conversions from Objective-C pointers that are not covered by the above.
Richard Trieufacef2e2011-09-06 20:30:53 +00005425 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(RHSType)) {
John McCallb6cfa242011-01-31 22:28:28 +00005426 // T* -> _Bool
Richard Trieufacef2e2011-09-06 20:30:53 +00005427 if (LHSType == Context.BoolTy) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005428 Kind = CK_PointerToBoolean;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005429 return Compatible;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005430 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005431
John McCallb6cfa242011-01-31 22:28:28 +00005432 // T* -> int
Richard Trieufacef2e2011-09-06 20:30:53 +00005433 if (LHSType->isIntegerType()) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005434 Kind = CK_PointerToIntegral;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005435 return PointerToInt;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005436 }
5437
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005438 return Incompatible;
5439 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00005440
John McCallb6cfa242011-01-31 22:28:28 +00005441 // struct A -> struct B
Richard Trieufacef2e2011-09-06 20:30:53 +00005442 if (isa<TagType>(LHSType) && isa<TagType>(RHSType)) {
5443 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSType, RHSType)) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005444 Kind = CK_NoOp;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005445 return Compatible;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005446 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005447 }
John McCallb6cfa242011-01-31 22:28:28 +00005448
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005449 return Incompatible;
5450}
5451
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005452/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
5453/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Richard Trieu67e29332011-08-02 04:35:43 +00005454static void ConstructTransparentUnion(Sema &S, ASTContext &C,
5455 ExprResult &EResult, QualType UnionType,
5456 FieldDecl *Field) {
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005457 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
5458 // of the transparent union.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00005459 Expr *E = EResult.take();
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00005460 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenekba7bc552010-02-19 01:50:18 +00005461 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005462 SourceLocation());
5463 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
5464 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
5465
5466 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
5467 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00005468 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00005469 EResult = S.Owned(
5470 new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
5471 VK_RValue, Initializer, false));
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005472}
5473
5474Sema::AssignConvertType
Richard Trieu67e29332011-08-02 04:35:43 +00005475Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType,
Richard Trieuf7720da2011-09-06 20:40:12 +00005476 ExprResult &RHS) {
5477 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType();
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005478
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005479 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005480 // transparent_union GCC extension.
5481 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00005482 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005483 return Incompatible;
5484
5485 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
5486 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
5487 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
5488 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00005489 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
5490 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005491 it != itend; ++it) {
5492 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
5493 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
5494 // 1) void pointer
5495 // 2) null pointer constant
Richard Trieuf7720da2011-09-06 20:40:12 +00005496 if (RHSType->isPointerType())
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00005497 if (RHSType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
Richard Trieuf7720da2011-09-06 20:40:12 +00005498 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.take(), it->getType(), CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005499 InitField = *it;
5500 break;
5501 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005502
Richard Trieuf7720da2011-09-06 20:40:12 +00005503 if (RHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
5504 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
5505 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.take(), it->getType(),
5506 CK_NullToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005507 InitField = *it;
5508 break;
5509 }
5510 }
5511
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005512 CastKind Kind = CK_Invalid;
Richard Trieuf7720da2011-09-06 20:40:12 +00005513 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), RHS, Kind)
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005514 == Compatible) {
Richard Trieuf7720da2011-09-06 20:40:12 +00005515 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.take(), it->getType(), Kind);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005516 InitField = *it;
5517 break;
5518 }
5519 }
5520
5521 if (!InitField)
5522 return Incompatible;
5523
Richard Trieuf7720da2011-09-06 20:40:12 +00005524 ConstructTransparentUnion(*this, Context, RHS, ArgType, InitField);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005525 return Compatible;
5526}
5527
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005528Sema::AssignConvertType
Sebastian Redl14b0c192011-09-24 17:48:00 +00005529Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType LHSType, ExprResult &RHS,
5530 bool Diagnose) {
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005531 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedmanb001de72011-10-06 23:00:33 +00005532 if (!LHSType->isRecordType() && !LHSType->isAtomicType()) {
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005533 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
5534 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
5535 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Richard Trieuf7720da2011-09-06 20:40:12 +00005536 ExprResult Res = PerformImplicitConversion(RHS.get(),
5537 LHSType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Sebastian Redl14b0c192011-09-24 17:48:00 +00005538 AA_Assigning, Diagnose);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00005539 if (Res.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005540 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahanian7a084ec2011-07-07 23:04:17 +00005541 Sema::AssignConvertType result = Compatible;
5542 if (getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount &&
Richard Trieuf7720da2011-09-06 20:40:12 +00005543 !CheckObjCARCUnavailableWeakConversion(LHSType,
5544 RHS.get()->getType()))
Fariborz Jahanian7a084ec2011-07-07 23:04:17 +00005545 result = IncompatibleObjCWeakRef;
Richard Trieuf7720da2011-09-06 20:40:12 +00005546 RHS = move(Res);
Fariborz Jahanian7a084ec2011-07-07 23:04:17 +00005547 return result;
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005548 }
5549
5550 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
5551 // structures.
Eli Friedmanb001de72011-10-06 23:00:33 +00005552 // FIXME: We also fall through for atomics; not sure what should
5553 // happen there, though.
Sebastian Redl14b0c192011-09-24 17:48:00 +00005554 }
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005555
Steve Naroff529a4ad2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00005556 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
5557 // a null pointer constant.
Richard Trieuf7720da2011-09-06 20:40:12 +00005558 if ((LHSType->isPointerType() ||
5559 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
5560 LHSType->isBlockPointerType())
5561 && RHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
5562 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
5563 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.take(), LHSType, CK_NullToPointer);
Steve Naroff529a4ad2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00005564 return Compatible;
5565 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005566
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005567 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005568 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregor02a24ee2009-11-03 16:56:39 +00005569 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Nick Lewyckyc133e9e2010-08-05 06:27:49 +00005570 // expressions that suppress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005571 //
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005572 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Richard Trieuf7720da2011-09-06 20:40:12 +00005573 if (!LHSType->isReferenceType()) {
5574 RHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.take());
5575 if (RHS.isInvalid())
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00005576 return Incompatible;
5577 }
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005578
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005579 CastKind Kind = CK_Invalid;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005580 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
Richard Trieuf7720da2011-09-06 20:40:12 +00005581 CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHS, Kind);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005582
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005583 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
5584 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00005585 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
5586 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
5587 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
5588 // does not have reference type.
Richard Trieuf7720da2011-09-06 20:40:12 +00005589 if (result != Incompatible && RHS.get()->getType() != LHSType)
5590 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.take(),
5591 LHSType.getNonLValueExprType(Context), Kind);
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005592 return result;
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005593}
5594
Richard Trieuf7720da2011-09-06 20:40:12 +00005595QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, ExprResult &LHS,
5596 ExprResult &RHS) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005597 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Richard Trieuf7720da2011-09-06 20:40:12 +00005598 << LHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getType()
5599 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005600 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005601}
5602
Richard Trieu08062aa2011-09-06 21:01:04 +00005603QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00005604 SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005605 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman1330b0e2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005606 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Richard Trieu08062aa2011-09-06 21:01:04 +00005607 QualType LHSType =
5608 Context.getCanonicalType(LHS.get()->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
5609 QualType RHSType =
5610 Context.getCanonicalType(RHS.get()->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005611
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005612 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Richard Trieu08062aa2011-09-06 21:01:04 +00005613 if (LHSType == RHSType)
5614 return LHSType;
Nate Begeman4119d1a2007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005615
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005616 // Handle the case of equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
Richard Trieu08062aa2011-09-06 21:01:04 +00005617 if (LHSType->isVectorType() && RHSType->isVectorType() &&
5618 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(LHSType, RHSType)) {
5619 if (LHSType->isExtVectorType()) {
5620 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.take(), LHSType, CK_BitCast);
5621 return LHSType;
Eli Friedmanb9b4b782011-06-23 18:10:35 +00005622 }
5623
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00005624 if (!IsCompAssign)
Richard Trieu08062aa2011-09-06 21:01:04 +00005625 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.take(), RHSType, CK_BitCast);
5626 return RHSType;
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005627 }
5628
Eli Friedmanb9b4b782011-06-23 18:10:35 +00005629 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
Richard Trieu08062aa2011-09-06 21:01:04 +00005630 Context.getTypeSize(LHSType) == Context.getTypeSize(RHSType)) {
Eli Friedmanb9b4b782011-06-23 18:10:35 +00005631 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
5632 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a
5633 // bitcast; no bits are changed but the result type is different.
5634 // FIXME: Should we really be allowing this?
Richard Trieu08062aa2011-09-06 21:01:04 +00005635 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.take(), LHSType, CK_BitCast);
5636 return LHSType;
Eli Friedmanb9b4b782011-06-23 18:10:35 +00005637 }
5638
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005639 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
5640 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
5641 bool swapped = false;
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00005642 if (RHSType->isExtVectorType() && !IsCompAssign) {
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005643 swapped = true;
Richard Trieu08062aa2011-09-06 21:01:04 +00005644 std::swap(RHS, LHS);
5645 std::swap(RHSType, LHSType);
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005646 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005647
Nate Begemandde25982009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005648 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
Richard Trieu08062aa2011-09-06 21:01:04 +00005649 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = LHSType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005650 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
Richard Trieu08062aa2011-09-06 21:01:04 +00005651 if (EltTy->isIntegralType(Context) && RHSType->isIntegralType(Context)) {
5652 int order = Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, RHSType);
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005653 if (order > 0)
Richard Trieu08062aa2011-09-06 21:01:04 +00005654 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.take(), EltTy, CK_IntegralCast);
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005655 if (order >= 0) {
Richard Trieu08062aa2011-09-06 21:01:04 +00005656 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.take(), LHSType, CK_VectorSplat);
5657 if (swapped) std::swap(RHS, LHS);
5658 return LHSType;
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005659 }
5660 }
Richard Trieu08062aa2011-09-06 21:01:04 +00005661 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && RHSType->isScalarType() &&
5662 RHSType->isRealFloatingType()) {
5663 int order = Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, RHSType);
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005664 if (order > 0)
Richard Trieu08062aa2011-09-06 21:01:04 +00005665 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.take(), EltTy, CK_FloatingCast);
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005666 if (order >= 0) {
Richard Trieu08062aa2011-09-06 21:01:04 +00005667 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.take(), LHSType, CK_VectorSplat);
5668 if (swapped) std::swap(RHS, LHS);
5669 return LHSType;
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005670 }
Nate Begeman4119d1a2007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005671 }
5672 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005673
Nate Begemandde25982009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005674 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Richard Trieu08062aa2011-09-06 21:01:04 +00005675 if (swapped) std::swap(RHS, LHS);
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005676 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Richard Trieu08062aa2011-09-06 21:01:04 +00005677 << LHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getType()
5678 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005679 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00005680}
5681
Richard Trieu481037f2011-09-16 00:53:10 +00005682// checkArithmeticNull - Detect when a NULL constant is used improperly in an
5683// expression. These are mainly cases where the null pointer is used as an
5684// integer instead of a pointer.
5685static void checkArithmeticNull(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
5686 SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompare) {
5687 // The canonical way to check for a GNU null is with isNullPointerConstant,
5688 // but we use a bit of a hack here for speed; this is a relatively
5689 // hot path, and isNullPointerConstant is slow.
5690 bool LHSNull = isa<GNUNullExpr>(LHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts());
5691 bool RHSNull = isa<GNUNullExpr>(RHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts());
5692
5693 QualType NonNullType = LHSNull ? RHS.get()->getType() : LHS.get()->getType();
5694
5695 // Avoid analyzing cases where the result will either be invalid (and
5696 // diagnosed as such) or entirely valid and not something to warn about.
5697 if ((!LHSNull && !RHSNull) || NonNullType->isBlockPointerType() ||
5698 NonNullType->isMemberPointerType() || NonNullType->isFunctionType())
5699 return;
5700
5701 // Comparison operations would not make sense with a null pointer no matter
5702 // what the other expression is.
5703 if (!IsCompare) {
5704 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_null_in_arithmetic_operation)
5705 << (LHSNull ? LHS.get()->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
5706 << (RHSNull ? RHS.get()->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
5707 return;
5708 }
5709
5710 // The rest of the operations only make sense with a null pointer
5711 // if the other expression is a pointer.
5712 if (LHSNull == RHSNull || NonNullType->isAnyPointerType() ||
5713 NonNullType->canDecayToPointerType())
5714 return;
5715
5716 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_null_in_comparison_operation)
5717 << LHSNull /* LHS is NULL */ << NonNullType
5718 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
5719}
5720
Richard Trieu08062aa2011-09-06 21:01:04 +00005721QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
Richard Trieu67e29332011-08-02 04:35:43 +00005722 SourceLocation Loc,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00005723 bool IsCompAssign, bool IsDiv) {
Richard Trieu481037f2011-09-16 00:53:10 +00005724 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false);
5725
Richard Trieu08062aa2011-09-06 21:01:04 +00005726 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
5727 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType())
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00005728 return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005729
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00005730 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS, IsCompAssign);
Richard Trieu08062aa2011-09-06 21:01:04 +00005731 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00005732 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005733
Richard Trieu08062aa2011-09-06 21:01:04 +00005734 if (!LHS.get()->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
5735 !RHS.get()->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5736 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005737
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005738 // Check for division by zero.
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00005739 if (IsDiv &&
Richard Trieu08062aa2011-09-06 21:01:04 +00005740 RHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Richard Trieu67e29332011-08-02 04:35:43 +00005741 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Richard Trieu08062aa2011-09-06 21:01:04 +00005742 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, RHS.get(), PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
5743 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005744
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005745 return compType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005746}
5747
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005748QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00005749 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign) {
Richard Trieu481037f2011-09-16 00:53:10 +00005750 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false);
5751
Richard Trieu08062aa2011-09-06 21:01:04 +00005752 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
5753 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5754 if (LHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5755 RHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00005756 return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign);
Richard Trieu08062aa2011-09-06 21:01:04 +00005757 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
Daniel Dunbar523aa602009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005758 }
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005759
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00005760 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS, IsCompAssign);
Richard Trieu08062aa2011-09-06 21:01:04 +00005761 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00005762 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005763
Richard Trieu08062aa2011-09-06 21:01:04 +00005764 if (!LHS.get()->getType()->isIntegerType() ||
5765 !RHS.get()->getType()->isIntegerType())
5766 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005767
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005768 // Check for remainder by zero.
Richard Trieu08062aa2011-09-06 21:01:04 +00005769 if (RHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Richard Trieu67e29332011-08-02 04:35:43 +00005770 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Richard Trieu08062aa2011-09-06 21:01:04 +00005771 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, RHS.get(), PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
5772 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005773
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005774 return compType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005775}
5776
Chandler Carruth13b21be2011-06-27 08:02:19 +00005777/// \brief Diagnose invalid arithmetic on two void pointers.
5778static void diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoVoidPointers(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
Richard Trieudef75842011-09-06 21:13:51 +00005779 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
Chandler Carruth13b21be2011-06-27 08:02:19 +00005780 S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
5781 ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type
5782 : diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
Richard Trieudef75842011-09-06 21:13:51 +00005783 << 1 /* two pointers */ << LHSExpr->getSourceRange()
5784 << RHSExpr->getSourceRange();
Chandler Carruth13b21be2011-06-27 08:02:19 +00005785}
5786
5787/// \brief Diagnose invalid arithmetic on a void pointer.
5788static void diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
5789 Expr *Pointer) {
5790 S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
5791 ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type
5792 : diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5793 << 0 /* one pointer */ << Pointer->getSourceRange();
5794}
5795
5796/// \brief Diagnose invalid arithmetic on two function pointers.
5797static void diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoFunctionPointers(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
5798 Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) {
5799 assert(LHS->getType()->isAnyPointerType());
5800 assert(RHS->getType()->isAnyPointerType());
5801 S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
5802 ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type
5803 : diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5804 << 1 /* two pointers */ << LHS->getType()->getPointeeType()
5805 // We only show the second type if it differs from the first.
5806 << (unsigned)!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(LHS->getType(),
5807 RHS->getType())
5808 << RHS->getType()->getPointeeType()
5809 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
5810}
5811
5812/// \brief Diagnose invalid arithmetic on a function pointer.
5813static void diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
5814 Expr *Pointer) {
5815 assert(Pointer->getType()->isAnyPointerType());
5816 S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
5817 ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type
5818 : diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5819 << 0 /* one pointer */ << Pointer->getType()->getPointeeType()
5820 << 0 /* one pointer, so only one type */
5821 << Pointer->getSourceRange();
5822}
5823
Richard Trieud9f19342011-09-12 18:08:02 +00005824/// \brief Emit error if Operand is incomplete pointer type
Richard Trieu097ecd22011-09-02 02:15:37 +00005825///
5826/// \returns True if pointer has incomplete type
5827static bool checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
5828 Expr *Operand) {
5829 if ((Operand->getType()->isPointerType() &&
5830 !Operand->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
5831 Operand->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
5832 QualType PointeeTy = Operand->getType()->getPointeeType();
5833 if (S.RequireCompleteType(
5834 Loc, PointeeTy,
5835 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5836 << PointeeTy << Operand->getSourceRange()))
5837 return true;
5838 }
5839 return false;
5840}
5841
Chandler Carruth13b21be2011-06-27 08:02:19 +00005842/// \brief Check the validity of an arithmetic pointer operand.
5843///
5844/// If the operand has pointer type, this code will check for pointer types
5845/// which are invalid in arithmetic operations. These will be diagnosed
5846/// appropriately, including whether or not the use is supported as an
5847/// extension.
5848///
5849/// \returns True when the operand is valid to use (even if as an extension).
5850static bool checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
5851 Expr *Operand) {
5852 if (!Operand->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) return true;
5853
5854 QualType PointeeTy = Operand->getType()->getPointeeType();
5855 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
5856 diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(S, Loc, Operand);
5857 return !S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus;
5858 }
5859 if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
5860 diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(S, Loc, Operand);
5861 return !S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus;
5862 }
5863
Richard Trieu097ecd22011-09-02 02:15:37 +00005864 if (checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, Loc, Operand)) return false;
Chandler Carruth13b21be2011-06-27 08:02:19 +00005865
5866 return true;
5867}
5868
5869/// \brief Check the validity of a binary arithmetic operation w.r.t. pointer
5870/// operands.
5871///
5872/// This routine will diagnose any invalid arithmetic on pointer operands much
5873/// like \see checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand. However, it has special logic
5874/// for emitting a single diagnostic even for operations where both LHS and RHS
5875/// are (potentially problematic) pointers.
5876///
5877/// \returns True when the operand is valid to use (even if as an extension).
5878static bool checkArithmeticBinOpPointerOperands(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
Richard Trieudef75842011-09-06 21:13:51 +00005879 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
5880 bool isLHSPointer = LHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType();
5881 bool isRHSPointer = RHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType();
Chandler Carruth13b21be2011-06-27 08:02:19 +00005882 if (!isLHSPointer && !isRHSPointer) return true;
5883
5884 QualType LHSPointeeTy, RHSPointeeTy;
Richard Trieudef75842011-09-06 21:13:51 +00005885 if (isLHSPointer) LHSPointeeTy = LHSExpr->getType()->getPointeeType();
5886 if (isRHSPointer) RHSPointeeTy = RHSExpr->getType()->getPointeeType();
Chandler Carruth13b21be2011-06-27 08:02:19 +00005887
5888 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5889 bool isLHSVoidPtr = isLHSPointer && LHSPointeeTy->isVoidType();
5890 bool isRHSVoidPtr = isRHSPointer && RHSPointeeTy->isVoidType();
5891 if (isLHSVoidPtr || isRHSVoidPtr) {
Richard Trieudef75842011-09-06 21:13:51 +00005892 if (!isRHSVoidPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(S, Loc, LHSExpr);
5893 else if (!isLHSVoidPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(S, Loc, RHSExpr);
5894 else diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoVoidPointers(S, Loc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
Chandler Carruth13b21be2011-06-27 08:02:19 +00005895
5896 return !S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus;
5897 }
5898
5899 bool isLHSFuncPtr = isLHSPointer && LHSPointeeTy->isFunctionType();
5900 bool isRHSFuncPtr = isRHSPointer && RHSPointeeTy->isFunctionType();
5901 if (isLHSFuncPtr || isRHSFuncPtr) {
Richard Trieudef75842011-09-06 21:13:51 +00005902 if (!isRHSFuncPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(S, Loc, LHSExpr);
5903 else if (!isLHSFuncPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(S, Loc,
5904 RHSExpr);
5905 else diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoFunctionPointers(S, Loc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
Chandler Carruth13b21be2011-06-27 08:02:19 +00005906
5907 return !S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus;
5908 }
5909
Richard Trieudef75842011-09-06 21:13:51 +00005910 if (checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, Loc, LHSExpr)) return false;
5911 if (checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, Loc, RHSExpr)) return false;
Richard Trieu097ecd22011-09-02 02:15:37 +00005912
Chandler Carruth13b21be2011-06-27 08:02:19 +00005913 return true;
5914}
5915
Richard Trieudb44a6b2011-09-01 22:53:23 +00005916/// \brief Check bad cases where we step over interface counts.
5917static bool checkArithmethicPointerOnNonFragileABI(Sema &S,
5918 SourceLocation OpLoc,
5919 Expr *Op) {
5920 assert(Op->getType()->isAnyPointerType());
5921 QualType PointeeTy = Op->getType()->getPointeeType();
5922 if (!PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() || !S.LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI)
5923 return true;
5924
5925 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5926 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
5927 return false;
5928}
5929
Richard Trieud9f19342011-09-12 18:08:02 +00005930/// \brief Emit error when two pointers are incompatible.
Richard Trieudb44a6b2011-09-01 22:53:23 +00005931static void diagnosePointerIncompatibility(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
Richard Trieudef75842011-09-06 21:13:51 +00005932 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
5933 assert(LHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType());
5934 assert(RHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType());
Richard Trieudb44a6b2011-09-01 22:53:23 +00005935 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
Richard Trieudef75842011-09-06 21:13:51 +00005936 << LHSExpr->getType() << RHSExpr->getType() << LHSExpr->getSourceRange()
5937 << RHSExpr->getSourceRange();
Richard Trieudb44a6b2011-09-01 22:53:23 +00005938}
5939
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005940QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Richard Trieudef75842011-09-06 21:13:51 +00005941 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Richard Trieu481037f2011-09-16 00:53:10 +00005942 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false);
5943
Richard Trieudef75842011-09-06 21:13:51 +00005944 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
5945 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5946 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005947 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5948 return compType;
5949 }
Steve Naroff49b45262007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005950
Richard Trieudef75842011-09-06 21:13:51 +00005951 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS, CompLHSTy);
5952 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00005953 return QualType();
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005954
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005955 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Richard Trieudef75842011-09-06 21:13:51 +00005956 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5957 RHS.get()->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005958 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005959 return compType;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005960 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005961
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005962 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
Richard Trieudef75842011-09-06 21:13:51 +00005963 Expr* PExp = LHS.get(), *IExp = RHS.get();
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005964 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005965 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5966
Richard Trieu6eef9fb2011-09-12 18:37:54 +00005967 if (!PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
5968 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
Chandler Carruth13b21be2011-06-27 08:02:19 +00005969
Richard Trieu6eef9fb2011-09-12 18:37:54 +00005970 if (!IExp->getType()->isIntegerType())
5971 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005972
Richard Trieu6eef9fb2011-09-12 18:37:54 +00005973 if (!checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(*this, Loc, PExp))
5974 return QualType();
Kaelyn Uhraind6c88652011-08-05 23:18:04 +00005975
Richard Trieu6eef9fb2011-09-12 18:37:54 +00005976 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
5977 if (!checkArithmethicPointerOnNonFragileABI(*this, Loc, PExp))
5978 return QualType();
5979
5980 // Check array bounds for pointer arithemtic
5981 CheckArrayAccess(PExp, IExp);
5982
5983 if (CompLHSTy) {
5984 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(LHS.get());
5985 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5986 LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
5987 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5988 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005989 }
Richard Trieu6eef9fb2011-09-12 18:37:54 +00005990 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005991 }
5992
Richard Trieu6eef9fb2011-09-12 18:37:54 +00005993 return PExp->getType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005994}
5995
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005996// C99 6.5.6
Richard Trieudef75842011-09-06 21:13:51 +00005997QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
Richard Trieu67e29332011-08-02 04:35:43 +00005998 SourceLocation Loc,
5999 QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Richard Trieu481037f2011-09-16 00:53:10 +00006000 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false);
6001
Richard Trieudef75842011-09-06 21:13:51 +00006002 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
6003 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) {
6004 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006005 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
6006 return compType;
6007 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006008
Richard Trieudef75842011-09-06 21:13:51 +00006009 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS, CompLHSTy);
6010 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00006011 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006012
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00006013 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006014
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00006015 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Richard Trieudef75842011-09-06 21:13:51 +00006016 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
6017 RHS.get()->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006018 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00006019 return compType;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006020 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006021
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00006022 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Richard Trieudef75842011-09-06 21:13:51 +00006023 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
6024 QualType lpointee = LHS.get()->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006025
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00006026 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
Richard Trieudef75842011-09-06 21:13:51 +00006027 if (!checkArithmethicPointerOnNonFragileABI(*this, Loc, LHS.get()))
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00006028 return QualType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006029
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00006030 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Richard Trieudef75842011-09-06 21:13:51 +00006031 if (RHS.get()->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
6032 if (!checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(*this, Loc, LHS.get()))
Chandler Carruth13b21be2011-06-27 08:02:19 +00006033 return QualType();
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00006034
Richard Trieudef75842011-09-06 21:13:51 +00006035 Expr *IExpr = RHS.get()->IgnoreParenCasts();
Kaelyn Uhraind6c88652011-08-05 23:18:04 +00006036 UnaryOperator negRex(IExpr, UO_Minus, IExpr->getType(), VK_RValue,
6037 OK_Ordinary, IExpr->getExprLoc());
6038 // Check array bounds for pointer arithemtic
Richard Trieudef75842011-09-06 21:13:51 +00006039 CheckArrayAccess(LHS.get()->IgnoreParenCasts(), &negRex);
Kaelyn Uhraind6c88652011-08-05 23:18:04 +00006040
Richard Trieudef75842011-09-06 21:13:51 +00006041 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
6042 return LHS.get()->getType();
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00006043 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006044
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00006045 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Richard Trieu67e29332011-08-02 04:35:43 +00006046 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy
Richard Trieudef75842011-09-06 21:13:51 +00006047 = RHS.get()->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman8e54ad02008-02-08 01:19:44 +00006048 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006049
Eli Friedman88d936b2009-05-16 13:54:38 +00006050 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6051 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
6052 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Richard Trieudef75842011-09-06 21:13:51 +00006053 diagnosePointerIncompatibility(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get());
Eli Friedman88d936b2009-05-16 13:54:38 +00006054 }
6055 } else {
6056 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
6057 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
6058 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
6059 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
Richard Trieudef75842011-09-06 21:13:51 +00006060 diagnosePointerIncompatibility(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get());
Eli Friedman88d936b2009-05-16 13:54:38 +00006061 return QualType();
6062 }
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00006063 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006064
Chandler Carruth13b21be2011-06-27 08:02:19 +00006065 if (!checkArithmeticBinOpPointerOperands(*this, Loc,
Richard Trieudef75842011-09-06 21:13:51 +00006066 LHS.get(), RHS.get()))
Chandler Carruth13b21be2011-06-27 08:02:19 +00006067 return QualType();
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006068
Richard Trieudef75842011-09-06 21:13:51 +00006069 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00006070 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
6071 }
6072 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006073
Richard Trieudef75842011-09-06 21:13:51 +00006074 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006075}
6076
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00006077static bool isScopedEnumerationType(QualType T) {
6078 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(T))
6079 return ET->getDecl()->isScoped();
6080 return false;
6081}
6082
Richard Trieu1c8cfbf2011-09-06 21:21:28 +00006083static void DiagnoseBadShiftValues(Sema& S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
Chandler Carruth21206d52011-02-23 23:34:11 +00006084 SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc,
Richard Trieu1c8cfbf2011-09-06 21:21:28 +00006085 QualType LHSType) {
Chandler Carruth21206d52011-02-23 23:34:11 +00006086 llvm::APSInt Right;
6087 // Check right/shifter operand
Richard Trieu1c8cfbf2011-09-06 21:21:28 +00006088 if (RHS.get()->isValueDependent() ||
6089 !RHS.get()->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, S.Context))
Chandler Carruth21206d52011-02-23 23:34:11 +00006090 return;
6091
6092 if (Right.isNegative()) {
Richard Trieu1c8cfbf2011-09-06 21:21:28 +00006093 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, RHS.get(),
Ted Kremenek082bf7a2011-03-01 18:09:31 +00006094 S.PDiag(diag::warn_shift_negative)
Richard Trieu1c8cfbf2011-09-06 21:21:28 +00006095 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange());
Chandler Carruth21206d52011-02-23 23:34:11 +00006096 return;
6097 }
6098 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
Richard Trieu1c8cfbf2011-09-06 21:21:28 +00006099 S.Context.getTypeSize(LHS.get()->getType()));
Chandler Carruth21206d52011-02-23 23:34:11 +00006100 if (Right.uge(LeftBits)) {
Richard Trieu1c8cfbf2011-09-06 21:21:28 +00006101 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, RHS.get(),
Ted Kremenek425a31e2011-03-01 19:13:22 +00006102 S.PDiag(diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth)
Richard Trieu1c8cfbf2011-09-06 21:21:28 +00006103 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange());
Chandler Carruth21206d52011-02-23 23:34:11 +00006104 return;
6105 }
6106 if (Opc != BO_Shl)
6107 return;
6108
6109 // When left shifting an ICE which is signed, we can check for overflow which
6110 // according to C++ has undefined behavior ([expr.shift] 5.8/2). Unsigned
6111 // integers have defined behavior modulo one more than the maximum value
6112 // representable in the result type, so never warn for those.
6113 llvm::APSInt Left;
Richard Trieu1c8cfbf2011-09-06 21:21:28 +00006114 if (LHS.get()->isValueDependent() ||
6115 !LHS.get()->isIntegerConstantExpr(Left, S.Context) ||
6116 LHSType->hasUnsignedIntegerRepresentation())
Chandler Carruth21206d52011-02-23 23:34:11 +00006117 return;
6118 llvm::APInt ResultBits =
6119 static_cast<llvm::APInt&>(Right) + Left.getMinSignedBits();
6120 if (LeftBits.uge(ResultBits))
6121 return;
6122 llvm::APSInt Result = Left.extend(ResultBits.getLimitedValue());
6123 Result = Result.shl(Right);
6124
Ted Kremenekfa821382011-06-15 00:54:52 +00006125 // Print the bit representation of the signed integer as an unsigned
6126 // hexadecimal number.
6127 llvm::SmallString<40> HexResult;
6128 Result.toString(HexResult, 16, /*Signed =*/false, /*Literal =*/true);
6129
Chandler Carruth21206d52011-02-23 23:34:11 +00006130 // If we are only missing a sign bit, this is less likely to result in actual
6131 // bugs -- if the result is cast back to an unsigned type, it will have the
6132 // expected value. Thus we place this behind a different warning that can be
6133 // turned off separately if needed.
6134 if (LeftBits == ResultBits - 1) {
Ted Kremenekfa821382011-06-15 00:54:52 +00006135 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_result_sets_sign_bit)
Richard Trieu1c8cfbf2011-09-06 21:21:28 +00006136 << HexResult.str() << LHSType
6137 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
Chandler Carruth21206d52011-02-23 23:34:11 +00006138 return;
6139 }
6140
6141 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_result_gt_typewidth)
Richard Trieu1c8cfbf2011-09-06 21:21:28 +00006142 << HexResult.str() << Result.getMinSignedBits() << LHSType
6143 << Left.getBitWidth() << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
6144 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
Chandler Carruth21206d52011-02-23 23:34:11 +00006145}
6146
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00006147// C99 6.5.7
Richard Trieu1c8cfbf2011-09-06 21:21:28 +00006148QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
Richard Trieu67e29332011-08-02 04:35:43 +00006149 SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00006150 bool IsCompAssign) {
Richard Trieu481037f2011-09-16 00:53:10 +00006151 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false);
6152
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00006153 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
Richard Trieu1c8cfbf2011-09-06 21:21:28 +00006154 if (!LHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() ||
6155 !RHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
6156 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006157
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00006158 // C++0x: Don't allow scoped enums. FIXME: Use something better than
6159 // hasIntegerRepresentation() above instead of this.
Richard Trieu1c8cfbf2011-09-06 21:21:28 +00006160 if (isScopedEnumerationType(LHS.get()->getType()) ||
6161 isScopedEnumerationType(RHS.get()->getType())) {
6162 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00006163 }
6164
Nate Begeman2207d792009-10-25 02:26:48 +00006165 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
Richard Trieu1c8cfbf2011-09-06 21:21:28 +00006166 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
6167 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType())
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00006168 return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign);
Nate Begeman2207d792009-10-25 02:26:48 +00006169
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00006170 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
6171 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006172
John McCall1bc80af2010-12-16 19:28:59 +00006173 // For the LHS, do usual unary conversions, but then reset them away
6174 // if this is a compound assignment.
Richard Trieu1c8cfbf2011-09-06 21:21:28 +00006175 ExprResult OldLHS = LHS;
6176 LHS = UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.take());
6177 if (LHS.isInvalid())
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00006178 return QualType();
Richard Trieu1c8cfbf2011-09-06 21:21:28 +00006179 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType();
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00006180 if (IsCompAssign) LHS = OldLHS;
John McCall1bc80af2010-12-16 19:28:59 +00006181
6182 // The RHS is simpler.
Richard Trieu1c8cfbf2011-09-06 21:21:28 +00006183 RHS = UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.take());
6184 if (RHS.isInvalid())
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00006185 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006186
Ryan Flynnd0439682009-08-07 16:20:20 +00006187 // Sanity-check shift operands
Richard Trieu1c8cfbf2011-09-06 21:21:28 +00006188 DiagnoseBadShiftValues(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, Opc, LHSType);
Ryan Flynnd0439682009-08-07 16:20:20 +00006189
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00006190 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Richard Trieu1c8cfbf2011-09-06 21:21:28 +00006191 return LHSType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006192}
6193
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00006194static bool IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(Decl *D) {
6195 if (DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext()) {
6196 if (isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(DC))
6197 return true;
6198 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DC))
6199 return FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization();
6200 }
6201 return false;
6202}
6203
Richard Trieue648ac32011-09-02 03:48:46 +00006204/// If two different enums are compared, raise a warning.
Richard Trieuba261492011-09-06 21:27:33 +00006205static void checkEnumComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, ExprResult &LHS,
6206 ExprResult &RHS) {
6207 QualType LHSStrippedType = LHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getType();
6208 QualType RHSStrippedType = RHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getType();
Richard Trieue648ac32011-09-02 03:48:46 +00006209
6210 const EnumType *LHSEnumType = LHSStrippedType->getAs<EnumType>();
6211 if (!LHSEnumType)
6212 return;
6213 const EnumType *RHSEnumType = RHSStrippedType->getAs<EnumType>();
6214 if (!RHSEnumType)
6215 return;
6216
6217 // Ignore anonymous enums.
6218 if (!LHSEnumType->getDecl()->getIdentifier())
6219 return;
6220 if (!RHSEnumType->getDecl()->getIdentifier())
6221 return;
6222
6223 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(LHSStrippedType, RHSStrippedType))
6224 return;
6225
6226 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_comparison_of_mixed_enum_types)
6227 << LHSStrippedType << RHSStrippedType
Richard Trieuba261492011-09-06 21:27:33 +00006228 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
Richard Trieue648ac32011-09-02 03:48:46 +00006229}
6230
Richard Trieu7be1be02011-09-02 02:55:45 +00006231/// \brief Diagnose bad pointer comparisons.
6232static void diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
Richard Trieuba261492011-09-06 21:27:33 +00006233 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00006234 bool IsError) {
6235 S.Diag(Loc, IsError ? diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers
Richard Trieu7be1be02011-09-02 02:55:45 +00006236 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Richard Trieuba261492011-09-06 21:27:33 +00006237 << LHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getType()
6238 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
Richard Trieu7be1be02011-09-02 02:55:45 +00006239}
6240
6241/// \brief Returns false if the pointers are converted to a composite type,
6242/// true otherwise.
6243static bool convertPointersToCompositeType(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
Richard Trieuba261492011-09-06 21:27:33 +00006244 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS) {
Richard Trieu7be1be02011-09-02 02:55:45 +00006245 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
6246 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
6247 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
6248 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
6249 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
6250 //
6251 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
6252 // comparisons of pointers.
6253
6254 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
6255 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
6256 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
6257 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
6258 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
6259 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
6260 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
6261 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
6262 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
6263 // types.
6264
Richard Trieuba261492011-09-06 21:27:33 +00006265 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType();
6266 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType();
6267 assert((LHSType->isPointerType() && RHSType->isPointerType()) ||
6268 (LHSType->isMemberPointerType() && RHSType->isMemberPointerType()));
Richard Trieu7be1be02011-09-02 02:55:45 +00006269
6270 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Richard Trieu43dff1b2011-09-02 21:44:27 +00006271 bool *BoolPtr = S.isSFINAEContext() ? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType;
Richard Trieuba261492011-09-06 21:27:33 +00006272 QualType T = S.FindCompositePointerType(Loc, LHS, RHS, BoolPtr);
Richard Trieu7be1be02011-09-02 02:55:45 +00006273 if (T.isNull()) {
Richard Trieuba261492011-09-06 21:27:33 +00006274 diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(S, Loc, LHS, RHS, /*isError*/true);
Richard Trieu7be1be02011-09-02 02:55:45 +00006275 return true;
6276 }
6277
6278 if (NonStandardCompositeType)
6279 S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Richard Trieuba261492011-09-06 21:27:33 +00006280 << LHSType << RHSType << T << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
6281 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
Richard Trieu7be1be02011-09-02 02:55:45 +00006282
Richard Trieuba261492011-09-06 21:27:33 +00006283 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.take(), T, CK_BitCast);
6284 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.take(), T, CK_BitCast);
Richard Trieu7be1be02011-09-02 02:55:45 +00006285 return false;
6286}
6287
6288static void diagnoseFunctionPointerToVoidComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
Richard Trieuba261492011-09-06 21:27:33 +00006289 ExprResult &LHS,
6290 ExprResult &RHS,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00006291 bool IsError) {
6292 S.Diag(Loc, IsError ? diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void
6293 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
Richard Trieuba261492011-09-06 21:27:33 +00006294 << LHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getType()
6295 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
Richard Trieu7be1be02011-09-02 02:55:45 +00006296}
6297
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00006298// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006299QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
Richard Trieu67e29332011-08-02 04:35:43 +00006300 SourceLocation Loc, unsigned OpaqueOpc,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00006301 bool IsRelational) {
Richard Trieu481037f2011-09-16 00:53:10 +00006302 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/true);
6303
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006304 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) OpaqueOpc;
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006305
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00006306 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006307 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
6308 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType())
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00006309 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsRelational);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006310
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006311 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType();
6312 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType();
Benjamin Kramerfec09592011-09-03 08:46:20 +00006313
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006314 Expr *LHSStripped = LHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
6315 Expr *RHSStripped = RHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
Chandler Carruth543cb652011-02-17 08:37:06 +00006316
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006317 checkEnumComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS);
Chandler Carruth543cb652011-02-17 08:37:06 +00006318
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006319 if (!LHSType->hasFloatingRepresentation() &&
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00006320 !(LHSType->isBlockPointerType() && IsRelational) &&
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006321 !LHS.get()->getLocStart().isMacroID() &&
6322 !RHS.get()->getLocStart().isMacroID()) {
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00006323 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
6324 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
6325 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Chandler Carruth64d092c2010-07-12 06:23:38 +00006326 //
6327 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparison expressions resulting from macro
6328 // expansion. Also don't warn about comparisons which are only self
6329 // comparisons within a template specialization. The warnings should catch
6330 // obvious cases in the definition of the template anyways. The idea is to
6331 // warn when the typed comparison operator will always evaluate to the same
6332 // result.
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00006333 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped)) {
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00006334 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped)) {
Ted Kremenekfbcb0eb2010-09-16 00:03:01 +00006335 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() &&
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00006336 !IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(DRL->getDecl())) {
Ted Kremenek351ba912011-02-23 01:52:04 +00006337 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, 0, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00006338 << 0 // self-
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006339 << (Opc == BO_EQ
6340 || Opc == BO_LE
6341 || Opc == BO_GE));
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006342 } else if (LHSType->isArrayType() && RHSType->isArrayType() &&
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00006343 !DRL->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
6344 !DRR->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
6345 // what is it always going to eval to?
6346 char always_evals_to;
6347 switch(Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006348 case BO_EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00006349 always_evals_to = 0; // false
6350 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006351 case BO_NE: // e.g. array1 != array2
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00006352 always_evals_to = 1; // true
6353 break;
6354 default:
6355 // best we can say is 'a constant'
6356 always_evals_to = 2; // e.g. array1 <= array2
6357 break;
6358 }
Ted Kremenek351ba912011-02-23 01:52:04 +00006359 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, 0, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00006360 << 1 // array
6361 << always_evals_to);
6362 }
6363 }
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00006364 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006365
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00006366 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
6367 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
6368 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
6369 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006370
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00006371 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
6372 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006373 Expr *literalString = 0;
6374 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00006375 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006376 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006377 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006378 literalString = LHS.get();
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006379 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00006380 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
6381 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006382 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006383 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006384 literalString = RHS.get();
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006385 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
6386 }
6387
6388 if (literalString) {
6389 std::string resultComparison;
6390 switch (Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006391 case BO_LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
6392 case BO_GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
6393 case BO_LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
6394 case BO_GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
6395 case BO_EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
6396 case BO_NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00006397 default: llvm_unreachable("Invalid comparison operator");
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006398 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006399
Ted Kremenek351ba912011-02-23 01:52:04 +00006400 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, 0,
Douglas Gregord1e4d9b2010-01-12 23:18:54 +00006401 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
6402 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek03a4bee2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00006403 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006404 }
Ted Kremenek3ca0bf22007-10-29 16:58:49 +00006405 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006406
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00006407 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006408 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
6409 RHS.get()->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
6410 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
6411 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00006412 return QualType();
6413 }
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00006414 else {
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006415 LHS = UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.take());
6416 if (LHS.isInvalid())
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00006417 return QualType();
6418
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006419 RHS = UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.take());
6420 if (RHS.isInvalid())
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00006421 return QualType();
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00006422 }
6423
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006424 LHSType = LHS.get()->getType();
6425 RHSType = RHS.get()->getType();
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00006426
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006427 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis16f744b2011-02-18 20:55:15 +00006428 QualType ResultTy = Context.getLogicalOperationType();
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006429
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00006430 if (IsRelational) {
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006431 if (LHSType->isRealType() && RHSType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006432 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00006433 } else {
Ted Kremenek72cb1ae2007-10-29 17:13:39 +00006434 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006435 if (LHSType->hasFloatingRepresentation())
6436 CheckFloatComparison(Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006437
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006438 if (LHSType->isArithmeticType() && RHSType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006439 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00006440 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006441
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006442 bool LHSIsNull = LHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006443 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006444 bool RHSIsNull = RHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006445 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006446
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006447 // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except
6448 // when handling null pointer constants.
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006449 if (LHSType->isPointerType() && RHSType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattnerbc896f52008-04-03 05:07:25 +00006450 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00006451 LHSType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getCanonicalType();
Chris Lattnerbc896f52008-04-03 05:07:25 +00006452 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00006453 RHSType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getCanonicalType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006454
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00006455 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00006456 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
6457 return ResultTy;
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00006458 if (!IsRelational &&
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00006459 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
6460 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
6461 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006462 // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain
6463 // conformance with the C++ standard.
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00006464 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
6465 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Richard Trieu7be1be02011-09-02 02:55:45 +00006466 diagnoseFunctionPointerToVoidComparison(
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006467 *this, Loc, LHS, RHS, /*isError*/ isSFINAEContext());
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006468
6469 if (isSFINAEContext())
6470 return QualType();
6471
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006472 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.take(), LHSType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00006473 return ResultTy;
6474 }
6475 }
Anders Carlsson0c8209e2010-11-04 03:17:43 +00006476
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006477 if (convertPointersToCompositeType(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS))
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00006478 return QualType();
Richard Trieu7be1be02011-09-02 02:55:45 +00006479 else
6480 return ResultTy;
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00006481 }
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00006482 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
6483 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
6484 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
6485 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00006486 if (IsRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00006487 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006488 << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
6489 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00006490 }
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00006491 } else if (!IsRelational &&
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00006492 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
6493 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
6494 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
Richard Trieu7be1be02011-09-02 02:55:45 +00006495 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull)
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006496 diagnoseFunctionPointerToVoidComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS,
Richard Trieu7be1be02011-09-02 02:55:45 +00006497 /*isError*/false);
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00006498 } else {
6499 // Invalid
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006500 diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS, /*isError*/false);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006501 }
John McCall34d6f932011-03-11 04:25:25 +00006502 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy) {
6503 if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull)
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006504 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.take(), RHSType, CK_BitCast);
John McCall34d6f932011-03-11 04:25:25 +00006505 else
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006506 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.take(), LHSType, CK_BitCast);
John McCall34d6f932011-03-11 04:25:25 +00006507 }
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006508 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe77fd3c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00006509 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006510
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00006511 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Anders Carlsson0c8209e2010-11-04 03:17:43 +00006512 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006513 if (LHSType->isNullPtrType() && RHSType->isNullPtrType())
Anders Carlsson0c8209e2010-11-04 03:17:43 +00006514 return ResultTy;
6515
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006516 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006517 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006518 if (RHSIsNull &&
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006519 ((LHSType->isAnyPointerType() || LHSType->isNullPtrType()) ||
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00006520 (!IsRelational &&
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006521 (LHSType->isMemberPointerType() || LHSType->isBlockPointerType())))) {
6522 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.take(), LHSType,
6523 LHSType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006524 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
John McCall404cd162010-11-13 01:35:44 +00006525 : CK_NullToPointer);
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00006526 return ResultTy;
6527 }
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006528 if (LHSIsNull &&
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006529 ((RHSType->isAnyPointerType() || RHSType->isNullPtrType()) ||
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00006530 (!IsRelational &&
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006531 (RHSType->isMemberPointerType() || RHSType->isBlockPointerType())))) {
6532 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.take(), RHSType,
6533 RHSType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006534 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
John McCall404cd162010-11-13 01:35:44 +00006535 : CK_NullToPointer);
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00006536 return ResultTy;
6537 }
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006538
6539 // Comparison of member pointers.
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00006540 if (!IsRelational &&
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006541 LHSType->isMemberPointerType() && RHSType->isMemberPointerType()) {
6542 if (convertPointersToCompositeType(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS))
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006543 return QualType();
Richard Trieu7be1be02011-09-02 02:55:45 +00006544 else
6545 return ResultTy;
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006546 }
Douglas Gregor90566c02011-03-01 17:16:20 +00006547
6548 // Handle scoped enumeration types specifically, since they don't promote
6549 // to integers.
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006550 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isEnumeralType() &&
6551 Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(LHS.get()->getType(),
6552 RHS.get()->getType()))
Douglas Gregor90566c02011-03-01 17:16:20 +00006553 return ResultTy;
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00006554 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006555
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00006556 // Handle block pointer types.
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00006557 if (!IsRelational && LHSType->isBlockPointerType() &&
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006558 RHSType->isBlockPointerType()) {
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00006559 QualType lpointee = LHSType->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
6560 QualType rpointee = RHSType->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006561
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00006562 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedman26784c12009-06-08 05:08:54 +00006563 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00006564 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006565 << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
6566 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00006567 }
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006568 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.take(), LHSType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006569 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00006570 }
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00006571
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00006572 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00006573 if (!IsRelational
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006574 && ((LHSType->isBlockPointerType() && RHSType->isPointerType())
6575 || (LHSType->isPointerType() && RHSType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00006576 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006577 if (!((RHSType->isPointerType() && RHSType->castAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00006578 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006579 || (LHSType->isPointerType() && LHSType->castAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00006580 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
6581 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006582 << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
6583 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00006584 }
John McCall34d6f932011-03-11 04:25:25 +00006585 if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull)
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00006586 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.take(), RHSType,
6587 RHSType->isPointerType() ? CK_BitCast
6588 : CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast);
John McCall34d6f932011-03-11 04:25:25 +00006589 else
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00006590 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.take(), LHSType,
6591 LHSType->isPointerType() ? CK_BitCast
6592 : CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006593 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00006594 }
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00006595
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006596 if (LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
6597 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
6598 const PointerType *LPT = LHSType->getAs<PointerType>();
6599 const PointerType *RPT = RHSType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall34d6f932011-03-11 04:25:25 +00006600 if (LPT || RPT) {
6601 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ? LPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType() : false;
6602 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ? RPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006603
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00006604 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006605 !Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSType, RHSType)) {
6606 diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS,
Richard Trieu7be1be02011-09-02 02:55:45 +00006607 /*isError*/false);
Steve Naroffa5ad8632008-10-27 10:33:19 +00006608 }
John McCall34d6f932011-03-11 04:25:25 +00006609 if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull)
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00006610 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.take(), RHSType,
6611 RPT ? CK_BitCast :CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast);
John McCall34d6f932011-03-11 04:25:25 +00006612 else
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00006613 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.take(), LHSType,
6614 LPT ? CK_BitCast :CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006615 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff87f3b932008-10-20 18:19:10 +00006616 }
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006617 if (LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
6618 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
6619 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(LHSType, RHSType))
6620 diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS,
Richard Trieu7be1be02011-09-02 02:55:45 +00006621 /*isError*/false);
John McCall34d6f932011-03-11 04:25:25 +00006622 if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull)
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006623 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.take(), RHSType, CK_BitCast);
John McCall34d6f932011-03-11 04:25:25 +00006624 else
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006625 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.take(), LHSType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006626 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff20373222008-06-03 14:04:54 +00006627 }
Fariborz Jahanian7359f042007-12-20 01:06:58 +00006628 }
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006629 if ((LHSType->isAnyPointerType() && RHSType->isIntegerType()) ||
6630 (LHSType->isIntegerType() && RHSType->isAnyPointerType())) {
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00006631 unsigned DiagID = 0;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006632 bool isError = false;
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006633 if ((LHSIsNull && LHSType->isIntegerType()) ||
6634 (RHSIsNull && RHSType->isIntegerType())) {
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00006635 if (IsRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00006636 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00006637 } else if (IsRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00006638 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006639 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6640 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
6641 isError = true;
6642 } else
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00006643 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006644
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00006645 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00006646 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006647 << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
6648 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006649 if (isError)
6650 return QualType();
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00006651 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006652
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006653 if (LHSType->isIntegerType())
6654 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.take(), RHSType,
John McCall404cd162010-11-13 01:35:44 +00006655 LHSIsNull ? CK_NullToPointer : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00006656 else
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006657 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.take(), LHSType,
John McCall404cd162010-11-13 01:35:44 +00006658 RHSIsNull ? CK_NullToPointer : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006659 return ResultTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006660 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006661
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00006662 // Handle block pointers.
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00006663 if (!IsRelational && RHSIsNull
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006664 && LHSType->isBlockPointerType() && RHSType->isIntegerType()) {
6665 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.take(), LHSType, CK_NullToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006666 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00006667 }
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00006668 if (!IsRelational && LHSIsNull
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006669 && LHSType->isIntegerType() && RHSType->isBlockPointerType()) {
6670 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.take(), RHSType, CK_NullToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006671 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00006672 }
Douglas Gregor90566c02011-03-01 17:16:20 +00006673
Richard Trieuf1775fb2011-09-06 21:43:51 +00006674 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006675}
6676
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006677/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006678/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006679/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
6680/// types.
Richard Trieu9f60dee2011-09-07 01:19:57 +00006681QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006682 SourceLocation Loc,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00006683 bool IsRelational) {
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006684 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
6685 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Richard Trieu9f60dee2011-09-07 01:19:57 +00006686 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompAssign*/false);
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006687 if (vType.isNull())
6688 return vType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006689
Richard Trieu9f60dee2011-09-07 01:19:57 +00006690 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType();
6691 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006692
Anton Yartsev7870b132011-03-27 15:36:07 +00006693 // If AltiVec, the comparison results in a numeric type, i.e.
6694 // bool for C++, int for C
Anton Yartsev6305f722011-03-28 21:00:05 +00006695 if (vType->getAs<VectorType>()->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecVector)
Anton Yartsev7870b132011-03-27 15:36:07 +00006696 return Context.getLogicalOperationType();
6697
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006698 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
6699 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
6700 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Richard Trieu9f60dee2011-09-07 01:19:57 +00006701 if (!LHSType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
6702 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHS.get()->IgnoreParens()))
6703 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHS.get()->IgnoreParens()))
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006704 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Ted Kremenek351ba912011-02-23 01:52:04 +00006705 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, 0,
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00006706 PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
6707 << 0 // self-
6708 << 2 // "a constant"
6709 );
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006710 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006711
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006712 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00006713 if (!IsRelational && LHSType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
Richard Trieu9f60dee2011-09-07 01:19:57 +00006714 assert (RHSType->hasFloatingRepresentation());
6715 CheckFloatComparison(Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get());
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006716 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006717
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006718 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
6719 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
6720 // elements for floating point vectors.
Richard Trieu9f60dee2011-09-07 01:19:57 +00006721 if (LHSType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
6722 return LHSType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006723
Richard Trieu9f60dee2011-09-07 01:19:57 +00006724 const VectorType *VTy = LHSType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006725 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00006726 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006727 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattnerd013aa12009-03-31 07:46:52 +00006728 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00006729 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
6730
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006731 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00006732 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006733 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
6734}
6735
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006736inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00006737 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign) {
Richard Trieu481037f2011-09-16 00:53:10 +00006738 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false);
6739
Richard Trieu9f60dee2011-09-07 01:19:57 +00006740 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
6741 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) {
6742 if (LHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
6743 RHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00006744 return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign);
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00006745
Richard Trieu9f60dee2011-09-07 01:19:57 +00006746 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00006747 }
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00006748
Richard Trieu9f60dee2011-09-07 01:19:57 +00006749 ExprResult LHSResult = Owned(LHS), RHSResult = Owned(RHS);
6750 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHSResult, RHSResult,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00006751 IsCompAssign);
Richard Trieu9f60dee2011-09-07 01:19:57 +00006752 if (LHSResult.isInvalid() || RHSResult.isInvalid())
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00006753 return QualType();
Richard Trieu9f60dee2011-09-07 01:19:57 +00006754 LHS = LHSResult.take();
6755 RHS = RHSResult.take();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006756
Richard Trieu9f60dee2011-09-07 01:19:57 +00006757 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
6758 RHS.get()->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType())
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00006759 return compType;
Richard Trieu9f60dee2011-09-07 01:19:57 +00006760 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006761}
6762
6763inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Richard Trieu9f60dee2011-09-07 01:19:57 +00006764 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc) {
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006765
6766 // Diagnose cases where the user write a logical and/or but probably meant a
6767 // bitwise one. We do this when the LHS is a non-bool integer and the RHS
6768 // is a constant.
Richard Trieu9f60dee2011-09-07 01:19:57 +00006769 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isIntegerType() &&
6770 !LHS.get()->getType()->isBooleanType() &&
6771 RHS.get()->getType()->isIntegerType() && !RHS.get()->isValueDependent() &&
Richard Trieue5adf592011-07-15 00:00:51 +00006772 // Don't warn in macros or template instantiations.
6773 !Loc.isMacroID() && ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty()) {
Chris Lattnerb7690b42010-07-24 01:10:11 +00006774 // If the RHS can be constant folded, and if it constant folds to something
6775 // that isn't 0 or 1 (which indicate a potential logical operation that
6776 // happened to fold to true/false) then warn.
Chandler Carruth0683a142011-05-31 05:41:42 +00006777 // Parens on the RHS are ignored.
Chris Lattnerb7690b42010-07-24 01:10:11 +00006778 Expr::EvalResult Result;
Richard Trieu9f60dee2011-09-07 01:19:57 +00006779 if (RHS.get()->Evaluate(Result, Context) && !Result.HasSideEffects)
6780 if ((getLangOptions().Bool && !RHS.get()->getType()->isBooleanType()) ||
Chandler Carruth0683a142011-05-31 05:41:42 +00006781 (Result.Val.getInt() != 0 && Result.Val.getInt() != 1)) {
6782 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_logical_instead_of_bitwise)
Richard Trieu9f60dee2011-09-07 01:19:57 +00006783 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange()
Matt Beaumont-Gay9b127f32011-08-15 17:50:06 +00006784 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&&" : "||");
6785 // Suggest replacing the logical operator with the bitwise version
6786 Diag(Loc, diag::note_logical_instead_of_bitwise_change_operator)
6787 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|")
6788 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(
6789 Loc, Lexer::getLocForEndOfToken(Loc, 0, getSourceManager(),
6790 getLangOptions())),
6791 Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|");
6792 if (Opc == BO_LAnd)
6793 // Suggest replacing "Foo() && kNonZero" with "Foo()"
6794 Diag(Loc, diag::note_logical_instead_of_bitwise_remove_constant)
6795 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
6796 SourceRange(
Richard Trieu9f60dee2011-09-07 01:19:57 +00006797 Lexer::getLocForEndOfToken(LHS.get()->getLocEnd(),
Matt Beaumont-Gay9b127f32011-08-15 17:50:06 +00006798 0, getSourceManager(),
6799 getLangOptions()),
Richard Trieu9f60dee2011-09-07 01:19:57 +00006800 RHS.get()->getLocEnd()));
Matt Beaumont-Gay9b127f32011-08-15 17:50:06 +00006801 }
Chris Lattnerb7690b42010-07-24 01:10:11 +00006802 }
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006803
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006804 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Richard Trieu9f60dee2011-09-07 01:19:57 +00006805 LHS = UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.take());
6806 if (LHS.isInvalid())
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00006807 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006808
Richard Trieu9f60dee2011-09-07 01:19:57 +00006809 RHS = UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.take());
6810 if (RHS.isInvalid())
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00006811 return QualType();
6812
Richard Trieu9f60dee2011-09-07 01:19:57 +00006813 if (!LHS.get()->getType()->isScalarType() ||
6814 !RHS.get()->getType()->isScalarType())
6815 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006816
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006817 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson04905012009-10-16 01:44:21 +00006818 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006819
John McCall75f7c0f2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00006820 // The following is safe because we only use this method for
6821 // non-overloadable operands.
6822
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006823 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
6824 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
John McCall75f7c0f2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00006825 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool.
Richard Trieu9f60dee2011-09-07 01:19:57 +00006826 ExprResult LHSRes = PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(LHS.get());
6827 if (LHSRes.isInvalid())
6828 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
6829 LHS = move(LHSRes);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00006830
Richard Trieu9f60dee2011-09-07 01:19:57 +00006831 ExprResult RHSRes = PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(RHS.get());
6832 if (RHSRes.isInvalid())
6833 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
6834 RHS = move(RHSRes);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006835
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006836 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
6837 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
6838 // The result is a bool.
6839 return Context.BoolTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006840}
6841
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006842/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
6843/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
6844/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
6845///
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006846static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006847 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
6848 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
John McCall12f78a62010-12-02 01:19:52 +00006849 if (PropExpr->isImplicitProperty()) return false;
6850
6851 ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getExplicitProperty();
6852 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->isSuperReceiver() ?
6853 PropExpr->getSuperReceiverType() :
Fariborz Jahanian8ac2d442010-10-14 16:04:05 +00006854 PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
6855
John McCall12f78a62010-12-02 01:19:52 +00006856 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
6857 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
6858 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
6859 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
6860 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006861 }
6862 return false;
6863}
6864
Fariborz Jahanian14086762011-03-28 23:47:18 +00006865static bool IsConstProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
6866 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
6867 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
6868 if (PropExpr->isImplicitProperty()) return false;
6869
6870 ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getExplicitProperty();
6871 QualType T = PDecl->getType();
6872 if (T->isReferenceType())
Fariborz Jahanian61750f22011-03-30 16:59:30 +00006873 T = T->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanian14086762011-03-28 23:47:18 +00006874 CanQualType CT = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T);
6875 return CT.isConstQualified();
6876 }
6877 return false;
6878}
6879
Fariborz Jahanian077f4902011-03-26 19:48:30 +00006880static bool IsReadonlyMessage(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
6881 if (E->getStmtClass() != Expr::MemberExprClass)
6882 return false;
6883 const MemberExpr *ME = cast<MemberExpr>(E);
6884 NamedDecl *Member = ME->getMemberDecl();
6885 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
6886 Expr *Base = ME->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
6887 if (Base->getStmtClass() != Expr::ObjCMessageExprClass)
6888 return false;
6889 return cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Base)->getMethodDecl() != 0;
6890 }
6891 return false;
6892}
6893
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006894/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
6895/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
6896static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006897 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006898 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006899 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006900 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
6901 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Fariborz Jahanian14086762011-03-28 23:47:18 +00006902 else if (Expr::MLV_ConstQualified && IsConstProperty(E, S))
6903 IsLV = Expr::MLV_Valid;
Fariborz Jahanian077f4902011-03-26 19:48:30 +00006904 else if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary && IsReadonlyMessage(E, S))
6905 IsLV = Expr::MLV_InvalidMessageExpression;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006906 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
6907 return false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006908
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006909 unsigned Diag = 0;
6910 bool NeedType = false;
6911 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00006912 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified:
6913 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const;
6914
John McCall7acddac2011-06-17 06:42:21 +00006915 // In ARC, use some specialized diagnostics for occasions where we
6916 // infer 'const'. These are always pseudo-strong variables.
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00006917 if (S.getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount) {
6918 DeclRefExpr *declRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParenCasts());
6919 if (declRef && isa<VarDecl>(declRef->getDecl())) {
6920 VarDecl *var = cast<VarDecl>(declRef->getDecl());
6921
John McCall7acddac2011-06-17 06:42:21 +00006922 // Use the normal diagnostic if it's pseudo-__strong but the
6923 // user actually wrote 'const'.
6924 if (var->isARCPseudoStrong() &&
6925 (!var->getTypeSourceInfo() ||
6926 !var->getTypeSourceInfo()->getType().isConstQualified())) {
6927 // There are two pseudo-strong cases:
6928 // - self
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00006929 ObjCMethodDecl *method = S.getCurMethodDecl();
6930 if (method && var == method->getSelfDecl())
6931 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_arr_assign_self;
John McCall7acddac2011-06-17 06:42:21 +00006932
6933 // - fast enumeration variables
6934 else
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00006935 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_arr_assign_enumeration;
John McCall7acddac2011-06-17 06:42:21 +00006936
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00006937 SourceRange Assign;
6938 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
6939 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
6940 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
6941 // We need to preserve the AST regardless, so migration tool
6942 // can do its job.
6943 return false;
6944 }
6945 }
6946 }
6947
6948 break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006949 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006950 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6951 NeedType = true;
6952 break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006953 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006954 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6955 NeedType = true;
6956 break;
Chris Lattnerca354fa2008-11-17 19:51:54 +00006957 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006958 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
6959 break;
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006960 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
6961 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006962 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006963 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
6964 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006965 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6966 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006967 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
6968 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregor86447ec2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00006969 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006970 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00006971 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006972 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006973 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
6974 break;
Steve Naroff4f6a7d72008-09-26 14:41:28 +00006975 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006976 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6977 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5daf5702008-11-22 18:39:36 +00006978 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
6979 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
6980 break;
Fariborz Jahanianba8d2d62008-11-22 20:25:50 +00006981 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
6982 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
6983 break;
Fariborz Jahanian077f4902011-03-26 19:48:30 +00006984 case Expr::MLV_InvalidMessageExpression:
6985 Diag = diag::error_readonly_message_assignment;
6986 break;
Fariborz Jahanian2514a302009-12-15 23:59:41 +00006987 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
6988 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
6989 break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006990 }
Steve Naroffd1861fd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00006991
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006992 SourceRange Assign;
6993 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
6994 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006995 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006996 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006997 else
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006998 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006999 return true;
7000}
7001
7002
7003
7004// C99 6.5.16.1
Richard Trieu268942b2011-09-07 01:33:52 +00007005QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHSExpr, ExprResult &RHS,
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00007006 SourceLocation Loc,
7007 QualType CompoundType) {
7008 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
Richard Trieu268942b2011-09-07 01:33:52 +00007009 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHSExpr, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00007010 return QualType();
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00007011
Richard Trieu268942b2011-09-07 01:33:52 +00007012 QualType LHSType = LHSExpr->getType();
Richard Trieu67e29332011-08-02 04:35:43 +00007013 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS.get()->getType() :
7014 CompoundType;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007015 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00007016 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane2a901a2010-06-07 22:02:01 +00007017 QualType LHSTy(LHSType);
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00007018 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Richard Trieu268942b2011-09-07 01:33:52 +00007019 if (LHSExpr->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
7020 ExprResult LHSResult = Owned(LHSExpr);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007021 ConvertPropertyForLValue(LHSResult, RHS, LHSTy);
7022 if (LHSResult.isInvalid())
7023 return QualType();
Richard Trieu268942b2011-09-07 01:33:52 +00007024 LHSExpr = LHSResult.take();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007025 }
Fariborz Jahaniane2a901a2010-06-07 22:02:01 +00007026 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007027 if (RHS.isInvalid())
7028 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00007029 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
7030 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
7031 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Narofff4954562009-07-16 15:41:00 +00007032 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00007033 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Narofff4954562009-07-16 15:41:00 +00007034 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00007035 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007036
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007037 if (ConvTy == Compatible &&
7038 getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI &&
7039 LHSType->isObjCObjectType())
7040 Diag(Loc, diag::err_assignment_requires_nonfragile_object)
7041 << LHSType;
7042
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00007043 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
7044 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
7045 // instead of "x += 4".
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007046 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS.get();
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00007047 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
7048 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
7049 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007050 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ||
7051 UO->getOpcode() == UO_Minus) &&
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00007052 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00007053 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa64ccef2011-09-19 20:40:19 +00007054 Loc.getLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
Chris Lattner399bd1b2009-03-08 06:51:10 +00007055 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
7056 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa64ccef2011-09-19 20:40:19 +00007057 Loc.getLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
Chris Lattner3e872092009-03-09 07:11:10 +00007058 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00007059 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007060 << (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ? "+" : "-")
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00007061 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner399bd1b2009-03-08 06:51:10 +00007062 }
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00007063 }
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007064
7065 if (ConvTy == Compatible) {
7066 if (LHSType.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Strong)
Richard Trieu268942b2011-09-07 01:33:52 +00007067 checkRetainCycles(LHSExpr, RHS.get());
Fariborz Jahanian921c1432011-06-24 18:25:34 +00007068 else if (getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount)
Richard Trieu268942b2011-09-07 01:33:52 +00007069 checkUnsafeExprAssigns(Loc, LHSExpr, RHS.get());
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007070 }
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00007071 } else {
7072 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Douglas Gregorb608b982011-01-28 02:26:04 +00007073 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(Loc, LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00007074 }
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007075
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00007076 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007077 RHS.get(), AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007078 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007079
Richard Trieu268942b2011-09-07 01:33:52 +00007080 CheckForNullPointerDereference(*this, LHSExpr);
Kaelyn Uhraind6c88652011-08-05 23:18:04 +00007081
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007082 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
7083 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007084 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007085 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
7086 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007087 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00007088 // operand.
John McCall2bf6f492010-10-12 02:19:57 +00007089 return (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
7090 ? LHSType : LHSType.getUnqualifiedType());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007091}
7092
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00007093// C99 6.5.17
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007094static QualType CheckCommaOperands(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007095 SourceLocation Loc) {
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007096 S.DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS.get());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis25973452010-06-30 10:53:14 +00007097
John McCallfb8721c2011-04-10 19:13:55 +00007098 LHS = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHS.take());
7099 RHS = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHS.take());
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007100 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor7ad5d422010-11-09 21:07:58 +00007101 return QualType();
7102
John McCallcf2e5062010-10-12 07:14:40 +00007103 // C's comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1) on both its
7104 // operands, but not unary promotions.
7105 // C++'s comma does not do any conversions at all (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007106
John McCallf6a16482010-12-04 03:47:34 +00007107 // So we treat the LHS as a ignored value, and in C++ we allow the
7108 // containing site to determine what should be done with the RHS.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007109 LHS = S.IgnoredValueConversions(LHS.take());
7110 if (LHS.isInvalid())
7111 return QualType();
John McCallf6a16482010-12-04 03:47:34 +00007112
7113 if (!S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007114 RHS = S.DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.take());
7115 if (RHS.isInvalid())
7116 return QualType();
7117 if (!RHS.get()->getType()->isVoidType())
Richard Trieu67e29332011-08-02 04:35:43 +00007118 S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, RHS.get()->getType(),
7119 diag::err_incomplete_type);
John McCallcf2e5062010-10-12 07:14:40 +00007120 }
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007121
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007122 return RHS.get()->getType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007123}
7124
Steve Naroff49b45262007-07-13 16:58:59 +00007125/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
7126/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007127static QualType CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Sema &S, Expr *Op,
7128 ExprValueKind &VK,
7129 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00007130 bool IsInc, bool IsPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007131 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007132 return S.Context.DependentTy;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007133
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00007134 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
7135 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007136
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007137 if (S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00007138 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00007139 if (!IsInc) {
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007140 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00007141 return QualType();
7142 }
7143 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007144 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00007145 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00007146 // OK!
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00007147 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00007148 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Chandler Carruth13b21be2011-06-27 08:02:19 +00007149 if (!checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(S, OpLoc, Op))
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00007150 return QualType();
Chandler Carruth13b21be2011-06-27 08:02:19 +00007151
Fariborz Jahanian9f8a04f2009-07-16 17:59:14 +00007152 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
Richard Trieudb44a6b2011-09-01 22:53:23 +00007153 else if (!checkArithmethicPointerOnNonFragileABI(S, OpLoc, Op))
Fariborz Jahanian9f8a04f2009-07-16 17:59:14 +00007154 return QualType();
Eli Friedman5b088a12010-01-03 00:20:48 +00007155 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00007156 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007157 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00007158 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007159 } else if (ResType->isPlaceholderType()) {
John McCallfb8721c2011-04-10 19:13:55 +00007160 ExprResult PR = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op);
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007161 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007162 return CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(S, PR.take(), VK, OpLoc,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00007163 IsInc, IsPrefix);
Anton Yartsev683564a2011-02-07 02:17:30 +00007164 } else if (S.getLangOptions().AltiVec && ResType->isVectorType()) {
7165 // OK! ( C/C++ Language Extensions for CBEA(Version 2.6) 10.3 )
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00007166 } else {
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007167 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00007168 << ResType << int(IsInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00007169 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007170 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007171 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroffdd10e022007-08-23 21:37:33 +00007172 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007173 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, S))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007174 return QualType();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007175 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
7176 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
7177 // operand.
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00007178 if (IsPrefix && S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007179 VK = VK_LValue;
7180 return ResType;
7181 } else {
7182 VK = VK_RValue;
7183 return ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
7184 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007185}
7186
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007187ExprResult Sema::ConvertPropertyForRValue(Expr *E) {
John McCallf6a16482010-12-04 03:47:34 +00007188 assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_LValue &&
7189 E->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty);
7190 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr *PRE = E->getObjCProperty();
7191
Douglas Gregor926df6c2011-06-11 01:09:30 +00007192 QualType T = E->getType();
7193 QualType ReceiverType;
7194 if (PRE->isObjectReceiver())
7195 ReceiverType = PRE->getBase()->getType();
7196 else if (PRE->isSuperReceiver())
7197 ReceiverType = PRE->getSuperReceiverType();
7198 else
7199 ReceiverType = Context.getObjCInterfaceType(PRE->getClassReceiver());
7200
John McCallf6a16482010-12-04 03:47:34 +00007201 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue;
7202 if (PRE->isImplicitProperty()) {
Douglas Gregor926df6c2011-06-11 01:09:30 +00007203 if (ObjCMethodDecl *GetterMethod =
Fariborz Jahanian99130e52010-12-22 19:46:35 +00007204 PRE->getImplicitPropertyGetter()) {
Douglas Gregor926df6c2011-06-11 01:09:30 +00007205 T = getMessageSendResultType(ReceiverType, GetterMethod,
7206 PRE->isClassReceiver(),
7207 PRE->isSuperReceiver());
7208 VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(GetterMethod->getResultType());
Fariborz Jahanian99130e52010-12-22 19:46:35 +00007209 }
7210 else {
7211 Diag(PRE->getLocation(), diag::err_getter_not_found)
7212 << PRE->getBase()->getType();
7213 }
John McCallf6a16482010-12-04 03:47:34 +00007214 }
Fariborz Jahanianc6ac3222011-10-03 17:58:21 +00007215 else {
Fariborz Jahanian597cad62011-10-14 18:35:31 +00007216 // lvalue-ness of an explicit property is determined by
7217 // getter type.
Fariborz Jahanian2e8b97c2011-10-14 18:31:36 +00007218 QualType ResT = PRE->getGetterResultType();
Fariborz Jahanian597cad62011-10-14 18:35:31 +00007219 VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResT);
Fariborz Jahanianc6ac3222011-10-03 17:58:21 +00007220 }
7221
Douglas Gregor926df6c2011-06-11 01:09:30 +00007222 E = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, T, CK_GetObjCProperty,
John McCallf6a16482010-12-04 03:47:34 +00007223 E, 0, VK);
John McCalldb67e2f2010-12-10 01:49:45 +00007224
7225 ExprResult Result = MaybeBindToTemporary(E);
7226 if (!Result.isInvalid())
7227 E = Result.take();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007228
7229 return Owned(E);
John McCallf6a16482010-12-04 03:47:34 +00007230}
7231
Richard Trieu67e29332011-08-02 04:35:43 +00007232void Sema::ConvertPropertyForLValue(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
7233 QualType &LHSTy) {
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007234 assert(LHS.get()->getValueKind() == VK_LValue &&
7235 LHS.get()->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty);
7236 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr *PropRef = LHS.get()->getObjCProperty();
John McCallf6a16482010-12-04 03:47:34 +00007237
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007238 bool Consumed = false;
7239
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007240 if (PropRef->isImplicitProperty()) {
John McCallf6a16482010-12-04 03:47:34 +00007241 // If using property-dot syntax notation for assignment, and there is a
7242 // setter, RHS expression is being passed to the setter argument. So,
7243 // type conversion (and comparison) is RHS to setter's argument type.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007244 if (const ObjCMethodDecl *SetterMD = PropRef->getImplicitPropertySetter()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis491306a2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00007245 ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator P = SetterMD->param_begin();
John McCallf6a16482010-12-04 03:47:34 +00007246 LHSTy = (*P)->getType();
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007247 Consumed = (getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount &&
7248 (*P)->hasAttr<NSConsumedAttr>());
John McCallf6a16482010-12-04 03:47:34 +00007249
7250 // Otherwise, if the getter returns an l-value, just call that.
7251 } else {
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007252 QualType Result = PropRef->getImplicitPropertyGetter()->getResultType();
John McCallf6a16482010-12-04 03:47:34 +00007253 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(Result);
7254 if (VK == VK_LValue) {
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007255 LHS = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, LHS.get()->getType(),
7256 CK_GetObjCProperty, LHS.take(), 0, VK);
John McCallf6a16482010-12-04 03:47:34 +00007257 return;
John McCall12f78a62010-12-02 01:19:52 +00007258 }
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00007259 }
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007260 } else if (getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount) {
7261 const ObjCMethodDecl *setter
7262 = PropRef->getExplicitProperty()->getSetterMethodDecl();
7263 if (setter) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis491306a2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00007264 ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator P = setter->param_begin();
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007265 LHSTy = (*P)->getType();
7266 Consumed = (*P)->hasAttr<NSConsumedAttr>();
7267 }
John McCallf6a16482010-12-04 03:47:34 +00007268 }
7269
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007270 if ((getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && LHSTy->isRecordType()) ||
7271 getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount) {
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00007272 InitializedEntity Entity =
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007273 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, LHSTy, Consumed);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007274 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity, SourceLocation(), RHS);
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007275 if (!ArgE.isInvalid()) {
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007276 RHS = ArgE;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007277 if (getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount && !PropRef->isSuperReceiver())
7278 checkRetainCycles(const_cast<Expr*>(PropRef->getBase()), RHS.get());
7279 }
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00007280 }
7281}
7282
7283
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00007284/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007285/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00007286/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
7287/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
7288/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
7289/// - &(x) => x
7290/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
7291/// - &s.xx => s
7292/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
7293/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
7294/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
7295/// - & __real__ x -> x
John McCall5808ce42011-02-03 08:15:49 +00007296static ValueDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00007297 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007298 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00007299 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007300 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00007301 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
7302 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
7303 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00007304 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00007305 return 0;
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00007306 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00007307 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00007308 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00007309 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
7310 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00007311 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
7312 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
7313 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
7314 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
7315 }
7316 return 0;
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00007317 }
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00007318 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
7319 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007320
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00007321 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007322 case UO_Real:
7323 case UO_Imag:
7324 case UO_Extension:
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00007325 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
7326 default:
7327 return 0;
7328 }
7329 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007330 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00007331 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00007332 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00007333 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
7334 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00007335 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007336 default:
7337 return 0;
7338 }
7339}
7340
Richard Trieu5520f232011-09-07 21:46:33 +00007341namespace {
7342 enum {
7343 AO_Bit_Field = 0,
7344 AO_Vector_Element = 1,
7345 AO_Property_Expansion = 2,
7346 AO_Register_Variable = 3,
7347 AO_No_Error = 4
7348 };
7349}
Richard Trieu09a26ad2011-09-02 00:47:55 +00007350/// \brief Diagnose invalid operand for address of operations.
7351///
7352/// \param Type The type of operand which cannot have its address taken.
Richard Trieu09a26ad2011-09-02 00:47:55 +00007353static void diagnoseAddressOfInvalidType(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
7354 Expr *E, unsigned Type) {
7355 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of) << Type << E->getSourceRange();
7356}
7357
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007358/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007359/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007360/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007361/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007362/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007363/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00007364/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007365static QualType CheckAddressOfOperand(Sema &S, Expr *OrigOp,
7366 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00007367 if (OrigOp->isTypeDependent())
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007368 return S.Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregor44efed02011-10-09 19:10:41 +00007369 if (OrigOp->getType() == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
7370 if (!isa<OverloadExpr>(OrigOp->IgnoreParens())) {
7371 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
7372 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
7373 return QualType();
7374 }
7375
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007376 return S.Context.OverloadTy;
Douglas Gregor44efed02011-10-09 19:10:41 +00007377 }
John McCall755d8492011-04-12 00:42:48 +00007378 if (OrigOp->getType() == S.Context.UnknownAnyTy)
7379 return S.Context.UnknownAnyTy;
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00007380 if (OrigOp->getType() == S.Context.BoundMemberTy) {
7381 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
7382 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
7383 return QualType();
7384 }
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00007385
John McCall755d8492011-04-12 00:42:48 +00007386 assert(!OrigOp->getType()->isPlaceholderType());
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007387
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00007388 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
7389 Expr *op = OrigOp->IgnoreParens();
Douglas Gregor9103bb22008-12-17 22:52:20 +00007390
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007391 if (S.getLangOptions().C99) {
Steve Naroff08f19672008-01-13 17:10:08 +00007392 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
7393 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007394 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UO_Deref)
Steve Naroff08f19672008-01-13 17:10:08 +00007395 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
7396 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
7397 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
7398 }
7399 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
7400 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
7401 }
John McCall5808ce42011-02-03 08:15:49 +00007402 ValueDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
John McCall7eb0a9e2010-11-24 05:12:34 +00007403 Expr::LValueClassification lval = op->ClassifyLValue(S.Context);
Richard Trieu5520f232011-09-07 21:46:33 +00007404 unsigned AddressOfError = AO_No_Error;
Nuno Lopes6b6609f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00007405
Fariborz Jahanian077f4902011-03-26 19:48:30 +00007406 if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007407 bool sfinae = S.isSFINAEContext();
7408 S.Diag(OpLoc, sfinae ? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
7409 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00007410 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007411 if (sfinae)
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00007412 return QualType();
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00007413 } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op)) {
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007414 return S.Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00007415 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction) {
7416 // If it's an instance method, make a member pointer.
7417 // The expression must have exactly the form &A::foo.
7418
7419 // If the underlying expression isn't a decl ref, give up.
7420 if (!isa<DeclRefExpr>(op)) {
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007421 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00007422 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
7423 return QualType();
7424 }
7425 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(op);
7426 CXXMethodDecl *MD = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
7427
7428 // The id-expression was parenthesized.
7429 if (OrigOp != DRE) {
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007430 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_parens_pointer_member_function)
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00007431 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
7432
7433 // The method was named without a qualifier.
7434 } else if (!DRE->getQualifier()) {
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007435 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00007436 << op->getSourceRange();
7437 }
7438
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007439 return S.Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
7440 S.Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00007441 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00007442 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00007443 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00007444 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00007445 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007446 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
Chris Lattnerdcd5ef12008-11-19 05:27:50 +00007447 << op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007448 return QualType();
7449 }
John McCall7eb0a9e2010-11-24 05:12:34 +00007450 } else if (op->getObjectKind() == OK_BitField) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00007451 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
Richard Trieu5520f232011-09-07 21:46:33 +00007452 AddressOfError = AO_Bit_Field;
John McCall7eb0a9e2010-11-24 05:12:34 +00007453 } else if (op->getObjectKind() == OK_VectorComponent) {
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00007454 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Richard Trieu5520f232011-09-07 21:46:33 +00007455 AddressOfError = AO_Vector_Element;
John McCall7eb0a9e2010-11-24 05:12:34 +00007456 } else if (op->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
Fariborz Jahanian0337f212009-07-07 18:50:52 +00007457 // cannot take address of a property expression.
Richard Trieu5520f232011-09-07 21:46:33 +00007458 AddressOfError = AO_Property_Expansion;
Steve Naroffbcb2b612008-02-29 23:30:25 +00007459 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007460 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007461 // with the register storage-class specifier.
7462 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4020f872010-08-24 22:21:48 +00007463 // in C++ it is not error to take address of a register
7464 // variable (c++03 7.1.1P3)
John McCalld931b082010-08-26 03:08:43 +00007465 if (vd->getStorageClass() == SC_Register &&
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007466 !S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Richard Trieu5520f232011-09-07 21:46:33 +00007467 AddressOfError = AO_Register_Variable;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007468 }
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007469 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007470 return S.Context.OverloadTy;
John McCall5808ce42011-02-03 08:15:49 +00007471 } else if (isa<FieldDecl>(dcl) || isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor29882052008-12-10 21:26:49 +00007472 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00007473 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
7474 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregora2813ce2009-10-23 18:54:35 +00007475 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00007476 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00007477 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
John McCall5808ce42011-02-03 08:15:49 +00007478 if (dcl->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007479 S.Diag(OpLoc,
7480 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
John McCall5808ce42011-02-03 08:15:49 +00007481 << dcl->getDeclName() << dcl->getType();
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00007482 return QualType();
7483 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007484
Argyrios Kyrtzidis0413db42011-01-31 07:04:29 +00007485 while (cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
7486 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007487 return S.Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
7488 S.Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00007489 }
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00007490 }
Eli Friedman7b2f51c2011-08-26 20:28:17 +00007491 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl) && !isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(dcl))
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007492 llvm_unreachable("Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007493 }
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00007494
Richard Trieu5520f232011-09-07 21:46:33 +00007495 if (AddressOfError != AO_No_Error) {
7496 diagnoseAddressOfInvalidType(S, OpLoc, op, AddressOfError);
7497 return QualType();
7498 }
7499
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00007500 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
7501 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
7502 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
7503 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007504 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00007505 }
7506
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007507 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
Douglas Gregor8f70ddb2010-07-29 16:05:45 +00007508 if (op->getType()->isObjCObjectType())
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007509 return S.Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(op->getType());
7510 return S.Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007511}
7512
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00007513/// CheckIndirectionOperand - Type check unary indirection (prefix '*').
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007514static QualType CheckIndirectionOperand(Sema &S, Expr *Op, ExprValueKind &VK,
7515 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007516 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007517 return S.Context.DependentTy;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007518
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007519 ExprResult ConvResult = S.UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
7520 if (ConvResult.isInvalid())
7521 return QualType();
7522 Op = ConvResult.take();
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00007523 QualType OpTy = Op->getType();
7524 QualType Result;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisf4bbbf02011-05-02 18:21:19 +00007525
7526 if (isa<CXXReinterpretCastExpr>(Op)) {
7527 QualType OpOrigType = Op->IgnoreParenCasts()->getType();
7528 S.CheckCompatibleReinterpretCast(OpOrigType, OpTy, /*IsDereference*/true,
7529 Op->getSourceRange());
7530 }
7531
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00007532 // Note that per both C89 and C99, indirection is always legal, even if OpTy
7533 // is an incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about
7534 // dereferencing a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a
7535 // warning is unlikely to catch any mistakes.
7536 if (const PointerType *PT = OpTy->getAs<PointerType>())
7537 Result = PT->getPointeeType();
7538 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
7539 OpTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
7540 Result = OPT->getPointeeType();
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007541 else {
John McCallfb8721c2011-04-10 19:13:55 +00007542 ExprResult PR = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op);
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007543 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007544 if (PR.take() != Op)
7545 return CheckIndirectionOperand(S, PR.take(), VK, OpLoc);
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007546 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007547
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00007548 if (Result.isNull()) {
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007549 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00007550 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange();
7551 return QualType();
7552 }
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007553
7554 // Dereferences are usually l-values...
7555 VK = VK_LValue;
7556
7557 // ...except that certain expressions are never l-values in C.
Douglas Gregor2b1ad8b2011-06-23 00:49:38 +00007558 if (!S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Result.isCForbiddenLValueType())
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007559 VK = VK_RValue;
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00007560
7561 return Result;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007562}
7563
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007564static inline BinaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007565 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007566 BinaryOperatorKind Opc;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007567 switch (Kind) {
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007568 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown binop!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007569 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemD; break;
7570 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemI; break;
7571 case tok::star: Opc = BO_Mul; break;
7572 case tok::slash: Opc = BO_Div; break;
7573 case tok::percent: Opc = BO_Rem; break;
7574 case tok::plus: Opc = BO_Add; break;
7575 case tok::minus: Opc = BO_Sub; break;
7576 case tok::lessless: Opc = BO_Shl; break;
7577 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BO_Shr; break;
7578 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BO_LE; break;
7579 case tok::less: Opc = BO_LT; break;
7580 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BO_GE; break;
7581 case tok::greater: Opc = BO_GT; break;
7582 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BO_NE; break;
7583 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BO_EQ; break;
7584 case tok::amp: Opc = BO_And; break;
7585 case tok::caret: Opc = BO_Xor; break;
7586 case tok::pipe: Opc = BO_Or; break;
7587 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BO_LAnd; break;
7588 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BO_LOr; break;
7589 case tok::equal: Opc = BO_Assign; break;
7590 case tok::starequal: Opc = BO_MulAssign; break;
7591 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BO_DivAssign; break;
7592 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BO_RemAssign; break;
7593 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BO_AddAssign; break;
7594 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BO_SubAssign; break;
7595 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BO_ShlAssign; break;
7596 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BO_ShrAssign; break;
7597 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BO_AndAssign; break;
7598 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BO_XorAssign; break;
7599 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BO_OrAssign; break;
7600 case tok::comma: Opc = BO_Comma; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007601 }
7602 return Opc;
7603}
7604
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007605static inline UnaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007606 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007607 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007608 switch (Kind) {
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007609 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown unary op!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007610 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PreInc; break;
7611 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PreDec; break;
7612 case tok::amp: Opc = UO_AddrOf; break;
7613 case tok::star: Opc = UO_Deref; break;
7614 case tok::plus: Opc = UO_Plus; break;
7615 case tok::minus: Opc = UO_Minus; break;
7616 case tok::tilde: Opc = UO_Not; break;
7617 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UO_LNot; break;
7618 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UO_Real; break;
7619 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UO_Imag; break;
7620 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UO_Extension; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007621 }
7622 return Opc;
7623}
7624
Chandler Carruth9f7a6ee2011-01-04 06:52:15 +00007625/// DiagnoseSelfAssignment - Emits a warning if a value is assigned to itself.
7626/// This warning is only emitted for builtin assignment operations. It is also
7627/// suppressed in the event of macro expansions.
Richard Trieu268942b2011-09-07 01:33:52 +00007628static void DiagnoseSelfAssignment(Sema &S, Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
Chandler Carruth9f7a6ee2011-01-04 06:52:15 +00007629 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
7630 if (!S.ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty())
7631 return;
7632 if (OpLoc.isInvalid() || OpLoc.isMacroID())
7633 return;
Richard Trieu268942b2011-09-07 01:33:52 +00007634 LHSExpr = LHSExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
7635 RHSExpr = RHSExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
7636 const DeclRefExpr *LHSDeclRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSExpr);
7637 const DeclRefExpr *RHSDeclRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSExpr);
7638 if (!LHSDeclRef || !RHSDeclRef ||
7639 LHSDeclRef->getLocation().isMacroID() ||
7640 RHSDeclRef->getLocation().isMacroID())
Chandler Carruth9f7a6ee2011-01-04 06:52:15 +00007641 return;
Richard Trieu268942b2011-09-07 01:33:52 +00007642 const ValueDecl *LHSDecl =
7643 cast<ValueDecl>(LHSDeclRef->getDecl()->getCanonicalDecl());
7644 const ValueDecl *RHSDecl =
7645 cast<ValueDecl>(RHSDeclRef->getDecl()->getCanonicalDecl());
7646 if (LHSDecl != RHSDecl)
Chandler Carruth9f7a6ee2011-01-04 06:52:15 +00007647 return;
Richard Trieu268942b2011-09-07 01:33:52 +00007648 if (LHSDecl->getType().isVolatileQualified())
Chandler Carruth9f7a6ee2011-01-04 06:52:15 +00007649 return;
Richard Trieu268942b2011-09-07 01:33:52 +00007650 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = LHSDecl->getType()->getAs<ReferenceType>())
Chandler Carruth9f7a6ee2011-01-04 06:52:15 +00007651 if (RefTy->getPointeeType().isVolatileQualified())
7652 return;
7653
7654 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_self_assignment)
Richard Trieu268942b2011-09-07 01:33:52 +00007655 << LHSDeclRef->getType()
7656 << LHSExpr->getSourceRange() << RHSExpr->getSourceRange();
Chandler Carruth9f7a6ee2011-01-04 06:52:15 +00007657}
7658
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007659/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
7660/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
7661/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007662ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb1fa3dc2011-01-05 20:09:36 +00007663 BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Richard Trieu78ea78b2011-09-07 01:49:20 +00007664 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
7665 ExprResult LHS = Owned(LHSExpr), RHS = Owned(RHSExpr);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00007666 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00007667 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
7668 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
7669 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007670 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue;
7671 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary;
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007672
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00007673 // Check if a 'foo<int>' involved in a binary op, identifies a single
7674 // function unambiguously (i.e. an lvalue ala 13.4)
7675 // But since an assignment can trigger target based overload, exclude it in
7676 // our blind search. i.e:
7677 // template<class T> void f(); template<class T, class U> void f(U);
7678 // f<int> == 0; // resolve f<int> blindly
7679 // void (*p)(int); p = f<int>; // resolve f<int> using target
7680 if (Opc != BO_Assign) {
Richard Trieu78ea78b2011-09-07 01:49:20 +00007681 ExprResult resolvedLHS = CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHS.get());
John McCall1de4d4e2011-04-07 08:22:57 +00007682 if (!resolvedLHS.isUsable()) return ExprError();
Richard Trieu78ea78b2011-09-07 01:49:20 +00007683 LHS = move(resolvedLHS);
John McCall1de4d4e2011-04-07 08:22:57 +00007684
Richard Trieu78ea78b2011-09-07 01:49:20 +00007685 ExprResult resolvedRHS = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHS.get());
John McCall1de4d4e2011-04-07 08:22:57 +00007686 if (!resolvedRHS.isUsable()) return ExprError();
Richard Trieu78ea78b2011-09-07 01:49:20 +00007687 RHS = move(resolvedRHS);
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00007688 }
7689
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007690 switch (Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007691 case BO_Assign:
Richard Trieu78ea78b2011-09-07 01:49:20 +00007692 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, QualType());
John McCallf6a16482010-12-04 03:47:34 +00007693 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Richard Trieu78ea78b2011-09-07 01:49:20 +00007694 LHS.get()->getObjectKind() != OK_ObjCProperty) {
7695 VK = LHS.get()->getValueKind();
7696 OK = LHS.get()->getObjectKind();
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007697 }
Chandler Carruth9f7a6ee2011-01-04 06:52:15 +00007698 if (!ResultTy.isNull())
Richard Trieu78ea78b2011-09-07 01:49:20 +00007699 DiagnoseSelfAssignment(*this, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007700 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007701 case BO_PtrMemD:
7702 case BO_PtrMemI:
Richard Trieu78ea78b2011-09-07 01:49:20 +00007703 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(LHS, RHS, VK, OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007704 Opc == BO_PtrMemI);
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00007705 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007706 case BO_Mul:
7707 case BO_Div:
Richard Trieu78ea78b2011-09-07 01:49:20 +00007708 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, false,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007709 Opc == BO_Div);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007710 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007711 case BO_Rem:
Richard Trieu78ea78b2011-09-07 01:49:20 +00007712 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007713 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007714 case BO_Add:
Richard Trieu78ea78b2011-09-07 01:49:20 +00007715 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007716 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007717 case BO_Sub:
Richard Trieu78ea78b2011-09-07 01:49:20 +00007718 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007719 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007720 case BO_Shl:
7721 case BO_Shr:
Richard Trieu78ea78b2011-09-07 01:49:20 +00007722 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007723 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007724 case BO_LE:
7725 case BO_LT:
7726 case BO_GE:
7727 case BO_GT:
Richard Trieu78ea78b2011-09-07 01:49:20 +00007728 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007729 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007730 case BO_EQ:
7731 case BO_NE:
Richard Trieu78ea78b2011-09-07 01:49:20 +00007732 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007733 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007734 case BO_And:
7735 case BO_Xor:
7736 case BO_Or:
Richard Trieu78ea78b2011-09-07 01:49:20 +00007737 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007738 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007739 case BO_LAnd:
7740 case BO_LOr:
Richard Trieu78ea78b2011-09-07 01:49:20 +00007741 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007742 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007743 case BO_MulAssign:
7744 case BO_DivAssign:
Richard Trieu78ea78b2011-09-07 01:49:20 +00007745 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, true,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007746 Opc == BO_DivAssign);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00007747 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
Richard Trieu78ea78b2011-09-07 01:49:20 +00007748 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid())
7749 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007750 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007751 case BO_RemAssign:
Richard Trieu78ea78b2011-09-07 01:49:20 +00007752 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, true);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00007753 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
Richard Trieu78ea78b2011-09-07 01:49:20 +00007754 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid())
7755 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007756 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007757 case BO_AddAssign:
Richard Trieu78ea78b2011-09-07 01:49:20 +00007758 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
7759 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid())
7760 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007761 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007762 case BO_SubAssign:
Richard Trieu78ea78b2011-09-07 01:49:20 +00007763 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
7764 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid())
7765 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007766 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007767 case BO_ShlAssign:
7768 case BO_ShrAssign:
Richard Trieu78ea78b2011-09-07 01:49:20 +00007769 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00007770 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
Richard Trieu78ea78b2011-09-07 01:49:20 +00007771 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid())
7772 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007773 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007774 case BO_AndAssign:
7775 case BO_XorAssign:
7776 case BO_OrAssign:
Richard Trieu78ea78b2011-09-07 01:49:20 +00007777 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, true);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00007778 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
Richard Trieu78ea78b2011-09-07 01:49:20 +00007779 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid())
7780 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007781 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007782 case BO_Comma:
Richard Trieu78ea78b2011-09-07 01:49:20 +00007783 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(*this, LHS, RHS, OpLoc);
7784 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !RHS.isInvalid()) {
7785 VK = RHS.get()->getValueKind();
7786 OK = RHS.get()->getObjectKind();
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007787 }
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007788 break;
7789 }
Richard Trieu78ea78b2011-09-07 01:49:20 +00007790 if (ResultTy.isNull() || LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00007791 return ExprError();
Kaelyn Uhraind6c88652011-08-05 23:18:04 +00007792
7793 // Check for array bounds violations for both sides of the BinaryOperator
Richard Trieu78ea78b2011-09-07 01:49:20 +00007794 CheckArrayAccess(LHS.get());
7795 CheckArrayAccess(RHS.get());
Kaelyn Uhraind6c88652011-08-05 23:18:04 +00007796
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00007797 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Richard Trieu78ea78b2011-09-07 01:49:20 +00007798 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(LHS.take(), RHS.take(), Opc,
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007799 ResultTy, VK, OK, OpLoc));
Richard Trieu78ea78b2011-09-07 01:49:20 +00007800 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && LHS.get()->getObjectKind() !=
Richard Trieu67e29332011-08-02 04:35:43 +00007801 OK_ObjCProperty) {
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007802 VK = VK_LValue;
Richard Trieu78ea78b2011-09-07 01:49:20 +00007803 OK = LHS.get()->getObjectKind();
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007804 }
Richard Trieu78ea78b2011-09-07 01:49:20 +00007805 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(LHS.take(), RHS.take(), Opc,
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007806 ResultTy, VK, OK, CompLHSTy,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007807 CompResultTy, OpLoc));
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007808}
7809
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00007810/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
7811/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
7812/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
7813/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007814static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Richard Trieu78ea78b2011-09-07 01:49:20 +00007815 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *LHSExpr,
7816 Expr *RHSExpr) {
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00007817 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
Richard Trieu78ea78b2011-09-07 01:49:20 +00007818 BinOp::Opcode LHSopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
7819 RHSopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
7820 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(LHSExpr))
7821 LHSopc = BO->getOpcode();
7822 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(RHSExpr))
7823 RHSopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00007824
7825 // Subs are not binary operators.
Richard Trieu78ea78b2011-09-07 01:49:20 +00007826 if (LHSopc == -1 && RHSopc == -1)
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00007827 return;
7828
7829 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
7830 // Don't diagnose this.
Richard Trieu78ea78b2011-09-07 01:49:20 +00007831 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(LHSopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(LHSopc)) &&
7832 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(RHSopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(RHSopc)))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00007833 return;
7834
Richard Trieu78ea78b2011-09-07 01:49:20 +00007835 bool isLeftComp = BinOp::isComparisonOp(LHSopc);
7836 bool isRightComp = BinOp::isComparisonOp(RHSopc);
Richard Trieu70979d42011-08-10 22:41:34 +00007837 if (!isLeftComp && !isRightComp) return;
7838
Richard Trieu78ea78b2011-09-07 01:49:20 +00007839 SourceRange DiagRange = isLeftComp ? SourceRange(LHSExpr->getLocStart(),
7840 OpLoc)
7841 : SourceRange(OpLoc, RHSExpr->getLocEnd());
7842 std::string OpStr = isLeftComp ? BinOp::getOpcodeStr(LHSopc)
7843 : BinOp::getOpcodeStr(RHSopc);
Richard Trieu70979d42011-08-10 22:41:34 +00007844 SourceRange ParensRange = isLeftComp ?
Richard Trieu78ea78b2011-09-07 01:49:20 +00007845 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(LHSExpr)->getRHS()->getLocStart(),
7846 RHSExpr->getLocEnd())
7847 : SourceRange(LHSExpr->getLocStart(),
7848 cast<BinOp>(RHSExpr)->getLHS()->getLocStart());
Richard Trieu70979d42011-08-10 22:41:34 +00007849
7850 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
7851 << DiagRange << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << OpStr;
7852 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
7853 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence) << OpStr,
Richard Trieu78ea78b2011-09-07 01:49:20 +00007854 RHSExpr->getSourceRange());
Richard Trieu70979d42011-08-10 22:41:34 +00007855 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
7856 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
7857 ParensRange);
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00007858}
7859
Argyrios Kyrtzidis33f46e22011-06-20 18:41:26 +00007860/// \brief It accepts a '&' expr that is inside a '|' one.
7861/// Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps the '&' expression
7862/// in parentheses.
7863static void
7864EmitDiagnosticForBitwiseAndInBitwiseOr(Sema &Self, SourceLocation OpLoc,
7865 BinaryOperator *Bop) {
7866 assert(Bop->getOpcode() == BO_And);
7867 Self.Diag(Bop->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_bitwise_and_in_bitwise_or)
7868 << Bop->getSourceRange() << OpLoc;
7869 SuggestParentheses(Self, Bop->getOperatorLoc(),
7870 Self.PDiag(diag::note_bitwise_and_in_bitwise_or_silence),
7871 Bop->getSourceRange());
7872}
7873
Argyrios Kyrtzidis567bb712010-11-17 18:26:36 +00007874/// \brief It accepts a '&&' expr that is inside a '||' one.
7875/// Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps the '&&' expression
7876/// in parentheses.
7877static void
7878EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(Sema &Self, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa61aedc2011-04-22 19:16:27 +00007879 BinaryOperator *Bop) {
7880 assert(Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd);
Chandler Carruthf0b60d62011-06-16 01:05:14 +00007881 Self.Diag(Bop->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_logical_and_in_logical_or)
7882 << Bop->getSourceRange() << OpLoc;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa61aedc2011-04-22 19:16:27 +00007883 SuggestParentheses(Self, Bop->getOperatorLoc(),
Argyrios Kyrtzidis567bb712010-11-17 18:26:36 +00007884 Self.PDiag(diag::note_logical_and_in_logical_or_silence),
Chandler Carruthf0b60d62011-06-16 01:05:14 +00007885 Bop->getSourceRange());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis567bb712010-11-17 18:26:36 +00007886}
7887
7888/// \brief Returns true if the given expression can be evaluated as a constant
7889/// 'true'.
7890static bool EvaluatesAsTrue(Sema &S, Expr *E) {
7891 bool Res;
7892 return E->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(Res, S.getASTContext()) && Res;
7893}
7894
Argyrios Kyrtzidis47d512c2010-11-17 19:18:19 +00007895/// \brief Returns true if the given expression can be evaluated as a constant
7896/// 'false'.
7897static bool EvaluatesAsFalse(Sema &S, Expr *E) {
7898 bool Res;
7899 return E->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(Res, S.getASTContext()) && !Res;
7900}
7901
Argyrios Kyrtzidis567bb712010-11-17 18:26:36 +00007902/// \brief Look for '&&' in the left hand of a '||' expr.
7903static void DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrLHS(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Richard Trieubefece12011-09-07 02:02:10 +00007904 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
7905 if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSExpr)) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisbee77f72010-11-16 21:00:12 +00007906 if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis47d512c2010-11-17 19:18:19 +00007907 // If it's "a && b || 0" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter.
Richard Trieubefece12011-09-07 02:02:10 +00007908 if (EvaluatesAsFalse(S, RHSExpr))
Argyrios Kyrtzidis47d512c2010-11-17 19:18:19 +00007909 return;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis567bb712010-11-17 18:26:36 +00007910 // If it's "1 && a || b" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter.
7911 if (!EvaluatesAsTrue(S, Bop->getLHS()))
7912 return EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(S, OpLoc, Bop);
7913 } else if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LOr) {
7914 if (BinaryOperator *RBop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Bop->getRHS())) {
7915 // If it's "a || b && 1 || c" we didn't warn earlier for
7916 // "a || b && 1", but warn now.
7917 if (RBop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd && EvaluatesAsTrue(S, RBop->getRHS()))
7918 return EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(S, OpLoc, RBop);
7919 }
7920 }
7921 }
7922}
7923
7924/// \brief Look for '&&' in the right hand of a '||' expr.
7925static void DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrRHS(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Richard Trieubefece12011-09-07 02:02:10 +00007926 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
7927 if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(RHSExpr)) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis567bb712010-11-17 18:26:36 +00007928 if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis47d512c2010-11-17 19:18:19 +00007929 // If it's "0 || a && b" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter.
Richard Trieubefece12011-09-07 02:02:10 +00007930 if (EvaluatesAsFalse(S, LHSExpr))
Argyrios Kyrtzidis47d512c2010-11-17 19:18:19 +00007931 return;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis567bb712010-11-17 18:26:36 +00007932 // If it's "a || b && 1" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter.
7933 if (!EvaluatesAsTrue(S, Bop->getRHS()))
7934 return EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(S, OpLoc, Bop);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisbee77f72010-11-16 21:00:12 +00007935 }
7936 }
7937}
7938
Argyrios Kyrtzidis33f46e22011-06-20 18:41:26 +00007939/// \brief Look for '&' in the left or right hand of a '|' expr.
7940static void DiagnoseBitwiseAndInBitwiseOr(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
7941 Expr *OrArg) {
7942 if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(OrArg)) {
7943 if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_And)
7944 return EmitDiagnosticForBitwiseAndInBitwiseOr(S, OpLoc, Bop);
7945 }
7946}
7947
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00007948/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
Argyrios Kyrtzidisbee77f72010-11-16 21:00:12 +00007949/// precedence.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007950static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Richard Trieubefece12011-09-07 02:02:10 +00007951 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *LHSExpr,
7952 Expr *RHSExpr){
Argyrios Kyrtzidisbee77f72010-11-16 21:00:12 +00007953 // Diagnose "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00007954 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Richard Trieubefece12011-09-07 02:02:10 +00007955 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis33f46e22011-06-20 18:41:26 +00007956
7957 // Diagnose "arg1 & arg2 | arg3"
7958 if (Opc == BO_Or && !OpLoc.isMacroID()/* Don't warn in macros. */) {
Richard Trieubefece12011-09-07 02:02:10 +00007959 DiagnoseBitwiseAndInBitwiseOr(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr);
7960 DiagnoseBitwiseAndInBitwiseOr(Self, OpLoc, RHSExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis33f46e22011-06-20 18:41:26 +00007961 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidisbee77f72010-11-16 21:00:12 +00007962
Argyrios Kyrtzidis567bb712010-11-17 18:26:36 +00007963 // Warn about arg1 || arg2 && arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
7964 // We don't warn for 'assert(a || b && "bad")' since this is safe.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisd92ccaa2010-11-17 18:54:22 +00007965 if (Opc == BO_LOr && !OpLoc.isMacroID()/* Don't warn in macros. */) {
Richard Trieubefece12011-09-07 02:02:10 +00007966 DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrLHS(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
7967 DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrRHS(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisbee77f72010-11-16 21:00:12 +00007968 }
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00007969}
7970
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007971// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007972ExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007973 tok::TokenKind Kind,
Richard Trieubefece12011-09-07 02:02:10 +00007974 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007975 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Richard Trieubefece12011-09-07 02:02:10 +00007976 assert((LHSExpr != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
7977 assert((RHSExpr != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007978
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00007979 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
Richard Trieubefece12011-09-07 02:02:10 +00007980 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00007981
Richard Trieubefece12011-09-07 02:02:10 +00007982 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00007983}
7984
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007985ExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007986 BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Richard Trieubefece12011-09-07 02:02:10 +00007987 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
John McCall01b2e4e2010-12-06 05:26:58 +00007988 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7989 bool UseBuiltinOperator;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007990
Richard Trieubefece12011-09-07 02:02:10 +00007991 if (LHSExpr->isTypeDependent() || RHSExpr->isTypeDependent()) {
John McCall01b2e4e2010-12-06 05:26:58 +00007992 UseBuiltinOperator = false;
Richard Trieubefece12011-09-07 02:02:10 +00007993 } else if (Opc == BO_Assign &&
7994 LHSExpr->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
John McCall01b2e4e2010-12-06 05:26:58 +00007995 UseBuiltinOperator = true;
7996 } else {
Richard Trieubefece12011-09-07 02:02:10 +00007997 UseBuiltinOperator = !LHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
7998 !RHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType();
John McCall01b2e4e2010-12-06 05:26:58 +00007999 }
8000
8001 if (!UseBuiltinOperator) {
8002 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
8003 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
8004 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
8005 // the arguments.
8006 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
8007 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp
8008 = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
8009 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
Richard Trieubefece12011-09-07 02:02:10 +00008010 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, LHSExpr->getType(),
8011 RHSExpr->getType(), Functions);
John McCall01b2e4e2010-12-06 05:26:58 +00008012
8013 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
8014 // binary operation.
Richard Trieubefece12011-09-07 02:02:10 +00008015 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
John McCall01b2e4e2010-12-06 05:26:58 +00008016 }
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00008017 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008018
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00008019 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Richard Trieubefece12011-09-07 02:02:10 +00008020 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00008021}
8022
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008023ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb1fa3dc2011-01-05 20:09:36 +00008024 UnaryOperatorKind Opc,
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008025 Expr *InputExpr) {
8026 ExprResult Input = Owned(InputExpr);
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008027 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue;
8028 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00008029 QualType resultType;
8030 switch (Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008031 case UO_PreInc:
8032 case UO_PreDec:
8033 case UO_PostInc:
8034 case UO_PostDec:
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008035 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(*this, Input.get(), VK, OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008036 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
8037 Opc == UO_PostInc,
8038 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
8039 Opc == UO_PreDec);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00008040 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008041 case UO_AddrOf:
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008042 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(*this, Input.get(), OpLoc);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00008043 break;
John McCall1de4d4e2011-04-07 08:22:57 +00008044 case UO_Deref: {
John McCallfb8721c2011-04-10 19:13:55 +00008045 ExprResult resolved = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input.get());
John McCall1de4d4e2011-04-07 08:22:57 +00008046 if (!resolved.isUsable()) return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008047 Input = move(resolved);
8048 Input = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input.take());
8049 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(*this, Input.get(), VK, OpLoc);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00008050 break;
John McCall1de4d4e2011-04-07 08:22:57 +00008051 }
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008052 case UO_Plus:
8053 case UO_Minus:
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008054 Input = UsualUnaryConversions(Input.take());
8055 if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
8056 resultType = Input.get()->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00008057 if (resultType->isDependentType())
8058 break;
Douglas Gregor00619622010-06-22 23:41:02 +00008059 if (resultType->isArithmeticType() || // C99 6.5.3.3p1
8060 resultType->isVectorType())
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00008061 break;
8062 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
8063 resultType->isEnumeralType())
8064 break;
8065 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008066 Opc == UO_Plus &&
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00008067 resultType->isPointerType())
8068 break;
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00008069 else if (resultType->isPlaceholderType()) {
John McCallfb8721c2011-04-10 19:13:55 +00008070 Input = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input.take());
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008071 if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
8072 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input.take());
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00008073 }
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00008074
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00008075 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008076 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange());
8077
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008078 case UO_Not: // bitwise complement
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008079 Input = UsualUnaryConversions(Input.take());
8080 if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
8081 resultType = Input.get()->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00008082 if (resultType->isDependentType())
8083 break;
Chris Lattner02a65142008-07-25 23:52:49 +00008084 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
8085 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
8086 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00008087 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008088 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange();
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00008089 else if (resultType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
8090 break;
8091 else if (resultType->isPlaceholderType()) {
John McCallfb8721c2011-04-10 19:13:55 +00008092 Input = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input.take());
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008093 if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
8094 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input.take());
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00008095 } else {
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00008096 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008097 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange());
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00008098 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00008099 break;
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008100
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008101 case UO_LNot: // logical negation
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00008102 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008103 Input = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input.take());
8104 if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
8105 resultType = Input.get()->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00008106 if (resultType->isDependentType())
8107 break;
Abramo Bagnara737d5442011-04-07 09:26:19 +00008108 if (resultType->isScalarType()) {
8109 // C99 6.5.3.3p1: ok, fallthrough;
8110 if (Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
8111 // C++03 [expr.unary.op]p8, C++0x [expr.unary.op]p9:
8112 // operand contextually converted to bool.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008113 Input = ImpCastExprToType(Input.take(), Context.BoolTy,
8114 ScalarTypeToBooleanCastKind(resultType));
Abramo Bagnara737d5442011-04-07 09:26:19 +00008115 }
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00008116 } else if (resultType->isPlaceholderType()) {
John McCallfb8721c2011-04-10 19:13:55 +00008117 Input = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input.take());
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008118 if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
8119 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input.take());
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00008120 } else {
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00008121 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008122 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange());
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00008123 }
Douglas Gregorea844f32010-09-20 17:13:33 +00008124
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00008125 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00008126 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
Argyrios Kyrtzidis16f744b2011-02-18 20:55:15 +00008127 resultType = Context.getLogicalOperationType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00008128 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008129 case UO_Real:
8130 case UO_Imag:
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00008131 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(*this, Input, OpLoc, Opc == UO_Real);
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008132 // _Real and _Imag map ordinary l-values into ordinary l-values.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008133 if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
8134 if (Input.get()->getValueKind() != VK_RValue &&
8135 Input.get()->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary)
8136 VK = Input.get()->getValueKind();
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00008137 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008138 case UO_Extension:
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008139 resultType = Input.get()->getType();
8140 VK = Input.get()->getValueKind();
8141 OK = Input.get()->getObjectKind();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00008142 break;
8143 }
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008144 if (resultType.isNull() || Input.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00008145 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008146
Kaelyn Uhraind6c88652011-08-05 23:18:04 +00008147 // Check for array bounds violations in the operand of the UnaryOperator,
8148 // except for the '*' and '&' operators that have to be handled specially
8149 // by CheckArrayAccess (as there are special cases like &array[arraysize]
8150 // that are explicitly defined as valid by the standard).
8151 if (Opc != UO_AddrOf && Opc != UO_Deref)
8152 CheckArrayAccess(Input.get());
8153
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008154 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input.take(), Opc, resultType,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008155 VK, OK, OpLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00008156}
8157
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008158ExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00008159 UnaryOperatorKind Opc, Expr *Input) {
Anders Carlssona8a1e3d2009-11-14 21:26:41 +00008160 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
Eli Friedman957c0942010-09-05 23:15:52 +00008161 UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc) != OO_None) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008162 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
8163 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
8164 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
8165 // the arguments.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008166 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008167 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008168 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
8169 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
8170 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008171
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008172 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, Input);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008173 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008174
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008175 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008176}
8177
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00008178// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008179ExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCallf4c73712011-01-19 06:33:43 +00008180 tok::TokenKind Op, Expr *Input) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008181 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), Input);
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00008182}
8183
Steve Naroff1b273c42007-09-16 14:56:35 +00008184/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
Chris Lattnerad8dcf42011-02-17 07:39:24 +00008185ExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc, SourceLocation LabLoc,
Chris Lattner57ad3782011-02-17 20:34:02 +00008186 LabelDecl *TheDecl) {
Chris Lattnerad8dcf42011-02-17 07:39:24 +00008187 TheDecl->setUsed();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00008188 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Chris Lattnerad8dcf42011-02-17 07:39:24 +00008189 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, TheDecl,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00008190 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00008191}
8192
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008193/// Given the last statement in a statement-expression, check whether
8194/// the result is a producing expression (like a call to an
8195/// ns_returns_retained function) and, if so, rebuild it to hoist the
8196/// release out of the full-expression. Otherwise, return null.
8197/// Cannot fail.
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00008198static Expr *maybeRebuildARCConsumingStmt(Stmt *Statement) {
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008199 // Should always be wrapped with one of these.
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00008200 ExprWithCleanups *cleanups = dyn_cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Statement);
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008201 if (!cleanups) return 0;
8202
8203 ImplicitCastExpr *cast = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(cleanups->getSubExpr());
John McCall33e56f32011-09-10 06:18:15 +00008204 if (!cast || cast->getCastKind() != CK_ARCConsumeObject)
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008205 return 0;
8206
8207 // Splice out the cast. This shouldn't modify any interesting
8208 // features of the statement.
8209 Expr *producer = cast->getSubExpr();
8210 assert(producer->getType() == cast->getType());
8211 assert(producer->getValueKind() == cast->getValueKind());
8212 cleanups->setSubExpr(producer);
8213 return cleanups;
8214}
8215
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008216ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008217Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, Stmt *SubStmt,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00008218 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00008219 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
8220 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
8221
Douglas Gregordd8f5692010-03-10 04:54:39 +00008222 bool isFileScope
8223 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattner4a049f02009-04-25 19:11:05 +00008224 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00008225 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedmandca2b732009-01-24 23:09:00 +00008226
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00008227 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
8228 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
8229 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008230
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00008231 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
8232 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
8233 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00008234 bool StmtExprMayBindToTemp = false;
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00008235 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
8236 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00008237 LabelStmt *LastLabelStmt = 0;
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00008238 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00008239 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt)) {
8240 LastLabelStmt = Label;
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00008241 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00008242 }
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008243
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008244 if (Expr *LastE = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt)) {
John McCallf6a16482010-12-04 03:47:34 +00008245 // Do function/array conversion on the last expression, but not
8246 // lvalue-to-rvalue. However, initialize an unqualified type.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008247 ExprResult LastExpr = DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(LastE);
8248 if (LastExpr.isInvalid())
8249 return ExprError();
8250 Ty = LastExpr.get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
John McCallf6a16482010-12-04 03:47:34 +00008251
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008252 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && !LastExpr.get()->isTypeDependent()) {
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008253 // In ARC, if the final expression ends in a consume, splice
8254 // the consume out and bind it later. In the alternate case
8255 // (when dealing with a retainable type), the result
8256 // initialization will create a produce. In both cases the
8257 // result will be +1, and we'll need to balance that out with
8258 // a bind.
8259 if (Expr *rebuiltLastStmt
8260 = maybeRebuildARCConsumingStmt(LastExpr.get())) {
8261 LastExpr = rebuiltLastStmt;
8262 } else {
8263 LastExpr = PerformCopyInitialization(
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00008264 InitializedEntity::InitializeResult(LPLoc,
8265 Ty,
8266 false),
8267 SourceLocation(),
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008268 LastExpr);
8269 }
8270
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008271 if (LastExpr.isInvalid())
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00008272 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008273 if (LastExpr.get() != 0) {
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00008274 if (!LastLabelStmt)
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008275 Compound->setLastStmt(LastExpr.take());
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00008276 else
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008277 LastLabelStmt->setSubStmt(LastExpr.take());
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00008278 StmtExprMayBindToTemp = true;
8279 }
8280 }
8281 }
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00008282 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008283
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00008284 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
8285 // expressions are not lvalues.
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00008286 Expr *ResStmtExpr = new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc);
8287 if (StmtExprMayBindToTemp)
8288 return MaybeBindToTemporary(ResStmtExpr);
8289 return Owned(ResStmtExpr);
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00008290}
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00008291
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008292ExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00008293 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
8294 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
8295 unsigned NumComponents,
8296 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00008297 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00008298 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Abramo Bagnarabd054db2010-05-20 10:00:11 +00008299 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00008300
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00008301 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
8302 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
8303 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00008304 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00008305 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
8306 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
8307
8308 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
8309 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
8310 if (!Dependent
8311 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
8312 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
8313 << TypeRange))
8314 return ExprError();
8315
Chris Lattner9e2b75c2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00008316 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
8317 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman35183ac2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00008318 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
8319 // a system header!
Chris Lattner9e2b75c2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00008320 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerdcd5ef12008-11-19 05:27:50 +00008321 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
8322 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00008323
8324 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
8325 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
8326 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00008327 SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
8328 SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00008329 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
8330 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
8331 if (OC.isBrackets) {
8332 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
8333 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
8334 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
8335 if(!AT)
8336 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
8337 << CurrentType);
8338 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
8339 } else
8340 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
8341
8342 // The expression must be an integral expression.
8343 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
8344 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
8345 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
8346 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
8347 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
8348 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
8349 << Idx->getSourceRange());
8350
8351 // Record this array index.
8352 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
8353 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
8354 continue;
8355 }
8356
8357 // Offset of a field.
8358 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
8359 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
8360 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
8361 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
8362 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
8363 continue;
8364 }
8365
8366 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
8367 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
8368 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
8369 return ExprError();
8370
8371 // Look for the designated field.
8372 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
8373 if (!RC)
8374 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
8375 << CurrentType);
8376 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
8377
8378 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
8379 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
8380 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
8381 // (clause 9).
8382 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
8383 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
Ted Kremenek762696f2011-02-23 01:51:43 +00008384 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc, 0,
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00008385 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
8386 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
8387 << CurrentType))
8388 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
8389 }
8390
8391 // Look for the field.
8392 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
8393 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
8394 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
Francois Pichet87c2e122010-11-21 06:08:52 +00008395 IndirectFieldDecl *IndirectMemberDecl = 0;
8396 if (!MemberDecl) {
Benjamin Kramerd9811462010-11-21 14:11:41 +00008397 if ((IndirectMemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<IndirectFieldDecl>()))
Francois Pichet87c2e122010-11-21 06:08:52 +00008398 MemberDecl = IndirectMemberDecl->getAnonField();
8399 }
8400
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00008401 if (!MemberDecl)
8402 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
8403 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
8404 OC.LocEnd));
8405
Douglas Gregor9d5d60f2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00008406 // C99 7.17p3:
8407 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
8408 //
8409 // We diagnose this as an error.
Richard Smitha6b8b2c2011-10-10 18:28:20 +00008410 if (MemberDecl->isBitField()) {
Douglas Gregor9d5d60f2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00008411 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
8412 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
8413 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
8414 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
8415 return ExprError();
8416 }
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00008417
8418 RecordDecl *Parent = MemberDecl->getParent();
Francois Pichet87c2e122010-11-21 06:08:52 +00008419 if (IndirectMemberDecl)
8420 Parent = cast<RecordDecl>(IndirectMemberDecl->getDeclContext());
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00008421
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +00008422 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
8423 // the base class indirections.
8424 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
8425 /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00008426 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType, Context.getTypeDeclType(Parent), Paths)) {
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +00008427 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
8428 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
8429 B != BEnd; ++B)
8430 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
8431 }
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00008432
Francois Pichet87c2e122010-11-21 06:08:52 +00008433 if (IndirectMemberDecl) {
8434 for (IndirectFieldDecl::chain_iterator FI =
8435 IndirectMemberDecl->chain_begin(),
8436 FEnd = IndirectMemberDecl->chain_end(); FI != FEnd; FI++) {
8437 assert(isa<FieldDecl>(*FI));
8438 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart,
8439 cast<FieldDecl>(*FI), OC.LocEnd));
8440 }
8441 } else
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00008442 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
Francois Pichet87c2e122010-11-21 06:08:52 +00008443
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00008444 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
8445 }
8446
8447 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
8448 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
8449 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
8450}
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008451
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008452ExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00008453 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
8454 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00008455 ParsedType ParsedArgTy,
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00008456 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
8457 unsigned NumComponents,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00008458 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00008459
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00008460 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00008461 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(ParsedArgTy, &ArgTInfo);
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00008462 if (ArgTy.isNull())
8463 return ExprError();
8464
Eli Friedman5a15dc12010-08-05 10:15:45 +00008465 if (!ArgTInfo)
8466 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
8467
8468 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00008469 RParenLoc);
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00008470}
8471
8472
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008473ExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00008474 Expr *CondExpr,
8475 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
8476 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00008477 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
8478
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008479 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue;
8480 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00008481 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00008482 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregorc9ecc572009-05-19 22:43:30 +00008483 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00008484 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00008485 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00008486 } else {
8487 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
8488 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
8489 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
8490 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00008491 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
8492 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
8493 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00008494
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00008495 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008496 Expr *ActiveExpr = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr : RHSExpr;
8497
8498 resType = ActiveExpr->getType();
8499 ValueDependent = ActiveExpr->isValueDependent();
8500 VK = ActiveExpr->getValueKind();
8501 OK = ActiveExpr->getObjectKind();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00008502 }
8503
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00008504 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008505 resType, VK, OK, RPLoc,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00008506 resType->isDependentType(),
8507 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00008508}
8509
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00008510//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8511// Clang Extensions.
8512//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8513
8514/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00008515void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00008516 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00008517 PushBlockScope(CurScope, Block);
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00008518 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00008519 if (CurScope)
8520 PushDeclContext(CurScope, Block);
Fariborz Jahaniana729da22010-07-09 18:44:02 +00008521 else
8522 CurContext = Block;
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00008523}
8524
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00008525void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00008526 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
John McCall711c52b2011-01-05 12:14:39 +00008527 assert(ParamInfo.getContext() == Declarator::BlockLiteralContext);
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00008528 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008529
John McCallbf1a0282010-06-04 23:28:52 +00008530 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCallbf1a0282010-06-04 23:28:52 +00008531 QualType T = Sig->getType();
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00008532
John McCall711c52b2011-01-05 12:14:39 +00008533 // GetTypeForDeclarator always produces a function type for a block
8534 // literal signature. Furthermore, it is always a FunctionProtoType
8535 // unless the function was written with a typedef.
8536 assert(T->isFunctionType() &&
8537 "GetTypeForDeclarator made a non-function block signature");
8538
8539 // Look for an explicit signature in that function type.
8540 FunctionProtoTypeLoc ExplicitSignature;
8541
8542 TypeLoc tmp = Sig->getTypeLoc().IgnoreParens();
8543 if (isa<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>(tmp)) {
8544 ExplicitSignature = cast<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>(tmp);
8545
8546 // Check whether that explicit signature was synthesized by
8547 // GetTypeForDeclarator. If so, don't save that as part of the
8548 // written signature.
Abramo Bagnara796aa442011-03-12 11:17:06 +00008549 if (ExplicitSignature.getLocalRangeBegin() ==
8550 ExplicitSignature.getLocalRangeEnd()) {
John McCall711c52b2011-01-05 12:14:39 +00008551 // This would be much cheaper if we stored TypeLocs instead of
8552 // TypeSourceInfos.
8553 TypeLoc Result = ExplicitSignature.getResultLoc();
8554 unsigned Size = Result.getFullDataSize();
8555 Sig = Context.CreateTypeSourceInfo(Result.getType(), Size);
8556 Sig->getTypeLoc().initializeFullCopy(Result, Size);
8557
8558 ExplicitSignature = FunctionProtoTypeLoc();
8559 }
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00008560 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008561
John McCall711c52b2011-01-05 12:14:39 +00008562 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig);
8563 CurBlock->FunctionType = T;
8564
8565 const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>();
8566 QualType RetTy = Fn->getResultType();
8567 bool isVariadic =
8568 (isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) && cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic());
8569
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00008570 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic);
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00008571
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00008572 // Don't allow returning a objc interface by value.
8573 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
8574 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
8575 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
8576 return;
8577 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008578
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00008579 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00008580 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like:
8581 // ^ * { ... }
8582 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction"....
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00008583 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy)
8584 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008585
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00008586 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them.
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00008587 SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params;
John McCall711c52b2011-01-05 12:14:39 +00008588 if (ExplicitSignature) {
8589 for (unsigned I = 0, E = ExplicitSignature.getNumArgs(); I != E; ++I) {
8590 ParmVarDecl *Param = ExplicitSignature.getArg(I);
Fariborz Jahanian9a66c302010-02-12 21:53:14 +00008591 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
8592 !Param->isImplicit() &&
8593 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
8594 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
8595 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00008596 Params.push_back(Param);
Fariborz Jahanian9a66c302010-02-12 21:53:14 +00008597 }
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00008598
8599 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like
8600 // ^ fntype { ... }
8601 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
8602 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator
8603 I = Fn->arg_type_begin(), E = Fn->arg_type_end(); I != E; ++I) {
8604 ParmVarDecl *Param =
8605 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(CurBlock->TheDecl,
8606 ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
8607 *I);
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00008608 Params.push_back(Param);
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00008609 }
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00008610 }
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00008611
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00008612 // Set the parameters on the block decl.
Douglas Gregor82aa7132010-11-01 18:37:59 +00008613 if (!Params.empty()) {
David Blaikie4278c652011-09-21 18:16:56 +00008614 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params);
Douglas Gregor82aa7132010-11-01 18:37:59 +00008615 CheckParmsForFunctionDef(CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
8616 CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(),
8617 /*CheckParameterNames=*/false);
8618 }
8619
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00008620 // Finally we can process decl attributes.
Douglas Gregor9cdda0c2009-06-17 21:51:59 +00008621 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00008622
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00008623 if (!isVariadic && CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00008624 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
8625 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
8626 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
8627 }
8628
8629 // Put the parameter variables in scope. We can bail out immediately
8630 // if we don't have any.
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00008631 if (Params.empty())
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00008632 return;
8633
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00008634 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCall7a9813c2010-01-22 00:28:27 +00008635 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
8636 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
8637
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00008638 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00008639 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis08274082010-12-15 18:44:22 +00008640 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00008641
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00008642 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00008643 }
John McCall7a9813c2010-01-22 00:28:27 +00008644 }
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00008645}
8646
8647/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
8648/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
8649void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00008650 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner5c59e2b2009-04-21 22:38:46 +00008651 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00008652 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00008653}
8654
8655/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
8656/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008657ExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
Chris Lattnere476bdc2011-02-17 23:58:47 +00008658 Stmt *Body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9af55002009-03-27 04:18:06 +00008659 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
8660 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
8661 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008662
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00008663 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Fariborz Jahaniana729da22010-07-09 18:44:02 +00008664
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00008665 PopDeclContext();
8666
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00008667 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian7d5c74e2009-06-19 23:37:08 +00008668 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
8669 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008670
Mike Stump56925862009-07-28 22:04:01 +00008671 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00008672 QualType BlockTy;
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00008673
John McCall469a1eb2011-02-02 13:00:07 +00008674 // Set the captured variables on the block.
John McCall6b5a61b2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00008675 BSI->TheDecl->setCaptures(Context, BSI->Captures.begin(), BSI->Captures.end(),
8676 BSI->CapturesCXXThis);
John McCall469a1eb2011-02-02 13:00:07 +00008677
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00008678 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that.
8679 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) {
8680 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>();
8681
8682 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo();
8683 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true);
8684
8685 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types.
8686 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) {
John McCalle23cf432010-12-14 08:05:40 +00008687 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI;
8688 EPI.ExtInfo = Ext;
8689 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, EPI);
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00008690
8691 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type,
8692 // preserve its sugar structure.
8693 } else if (FTy->getResultType() == RetTy &&
8694 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) {
8695 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType;
8696
8697 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type.
8698 } else {
8699 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy);
John McCalle23cf432010-12-14 08:05:40 +00008700 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
8701 EPI.TypeQuals = 0; // FIXME: silently?
8702 EPI.ExtInfo = Ext;
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00008703 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy,
8704 FPT->arg_type_begin(),
8705 FPT->getNumArgs(),
John McCalle23cf432010-12-14 08:05:40 +00008706 EPI);
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00008707 }
8708
8709 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing.
8710 } else {
John McCalle23cf432010-12-14 08:05:40 +00008711 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008712 EPI.ExtInfo = FunctionType::ExtInfo().withNoReturn(NoReturn);
John McCalle23cf432010-12-14 08:05:40 +00008713 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, EPI);
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00008714 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008715
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00008716 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->param_begin(),
8717 BSI->TheDecl->param_end());
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00008718 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008719
Chris Lattner17a78302009-04-19 05:28:12 +00008720 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008721 if (getCurFunction()->NeedsScopeChecking() &&
8722 !hasAnyUnrecoverableErrorsInThisFunction())
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008723 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008724
Chris Lattnere476bdc2011-02-17 23:58:47 +00008725 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008726
Fariborz Jahanian4e7c7f22011-07-11 18:04:54 +00008727 for (BlockDecl::capture_const_iterator ci = BSI->TheDecl->capture_begin(),
8728 ce = BSI->TheDecl->capture_end(); ci != ce; ++ci) {
8729 const VarDecl *variable = ci->getVariable();
8730 QualType T = variable->getType();
8731 QualType::DestructionKind destructKind = T.isDestructedType();
8732 if (destructKind != QualType::DK_none)
8733 getCurFunction()->setHasBranchProtectedScope();
8734 }
8735
Douglas Gregorf8b7f712011-09-06 20:46:03 +00008736 computeNRVO(Body, getCurBlock());
8737
Benjamin Kramerd2486192011-07-12 14:11:05 +00008738 BlockExpr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy);
8739 const AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP = AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
8740 PopFunctionOrBlockScope(&WP, Result->getBlockDecl(), Result);
8741
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00008742 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00008743}
8744
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008745ExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00008746 Expr *E, ParsedType Ty,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00008747 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00008748 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00008749 GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
8750 return BuildVAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc);
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00008751}
8752
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008753ExprResult Sema::BuildVAArgExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008754 Expr *E, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
8755 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Chris Lattner0d20b8a2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00008756 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008757
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00008758 // Get the va_list type
8759 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00008760 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
8761 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
8762 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
8763 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00008764 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00008765 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008766 ExprResult Result = UsualUnaryConversions(E);
8767 if (Result.isInvalid())
8768 return ExprError();
8769 E = Result.take();
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00008770 } else {
8771 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
8772 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008773 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregordd027302009-05-19 23:10:31 +00008774 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00008775 return ExprError();
8776 }
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00008777
Douglas Gregordd027302009-05-19 23:10:31 +00008778 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
8779 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00008780 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
8781 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner0d20b8a2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00008782 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9dc8f192009-04-05 00:59:53 +00008783 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008784
David Majnemer0adde122011-06-14 05:17:32 +00008785 if (!TInfo->getType()->isDependentType()) {
8786 if (RequireCompleteType(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), TInfo->getType(),
8787 PDiag(diag::err_second_parameter_to_va_arg_incomplete)
8788 << TInfo->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange()))
8789 return ExprError();
David Majnemerdb11b012011-06-13 06:37:03 +00008790
David Majnemer0adde122011-06-14 05:17:32 +00008791 if (RequireNonAbstractType(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(),
8792 TInfo->getType(),
8793 PDiag(diag::err_second_parameter_to_va_arg_abstract)
8794 << TInfo->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange()))
8795 return ExprError();
8796
Douglas Gregor4eb75222011-07-30 06:45:27 +00008797 if (!TInfo->getType().isPODType(Context)) {
David Majnemer0adde122011-06-14 05:17:32 +00008798 Diag(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(),
Douglas Gregor4eb75222011-07-30 06:45:27 +00008799 TInfo->getType()->isObjCLifetimeType()
8800 ? diag::warn_second_parameter_to_va_arg_ownership_qualified
8801 : diag::warn_second_parameter_to_va_arg_not_pod)
David Majnemer0adde122011-06-14 05:17:32 +00008802 << TInfo->getType()
8803 << TInfo->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor4eb75222011-07-30 06:45:27 +00008804 }
Eli Friedman46d37c12011-07-11 21:45:59 +00008805
8806 // Check for va_arg where arguments of the given type will be promoted
8807 // (i.e. this va_arg is guaranteed to have undefined behavior).
8808 QualType PromoteType;
8809 if (TInfo->getType()->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
8810 PromoteType = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(TInfo->getType());
8811 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(PromoteType, TInfo->getType()))
8812 PromoteType = QualType();
8813 }
8814 if (TInfo->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
8815 PromoteType = Context.DoubleTy;
8816 if (!PromoteType.isNull())
8817 Diag(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(),
8818 diag::warn_second_parameter_to_va_arg_never_compatible)
8819 << TInfo->getType()
8820 << PromoteType
8821 << TInfo->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange();
David Majnemer0adde122011-06-14 05:17:32 +00008822 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008823
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00008824 QualType T = TInfo->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context);
8825 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc, T));
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00008826}
8827
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008828ExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00008829 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
8830 // pointers on the target.
8831 QualType Ty;
Douglas Gregorbcfd1f52011-09-02 00:18:52 +00008832 unsigned pw = Context.getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0);
8833 if (pw == Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth())
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00008834 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregorbcfd1f52011-09-02 00:18:52 +00008835 else if (pw == Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth())
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00008836 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Douglas Gregorbcfd1f52011-09-02 00:18:52 +00008837 else if (pw == Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth())
NAKAMURA Takumi6e5658d2011-01-19 00:11:41 +00008838 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
8839 else {
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008840 llvm_unreachable("I don't know size of pointer!");
NAKAMURA Takumi6e5658d2011-01-19 00:11:41 +00008841 }
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00008842
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00008843 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00008844}
8845
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00008846static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00008847 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00008848 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
8849 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008850
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00008851 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
8852 if (!PT)
8853 return;
8854
8855 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
8856 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
8857 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
8858 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
8859 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
8860 return;
8861 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008862
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00008863 // Strip off any parens and casts.
8864 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
Douglas Gregor5cee1192011-07-27 05:40:30 +00008865 if (!SL || !SL->isAscii())
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00008866 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008867
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00008868 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00008869}
8870
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008871bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
8872 SourceLocation Loc,
8873 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregora41a8c52010-04-22 00:20:18 +00008874 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
8875 bool *Complained) {
8876 if (Complained)
8877 *Complained = false;
8878
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008879 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
Douglas Gregor926df6c2011-06-11 01:09:30 +00008880 bool CheckInferredResultType = false;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008881 bool isInvalid = false;
8882 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00008883 FixItHint Hint;
Anna Zaks67221552011-07-28 19:51:27 +00008884 ConversionFixItGenerator ConvHints;
8885 bool MayHaveConvFixit = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008886
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008887 switch (ConvTy) {
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008888 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown conversion type");
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008889 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00008890 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008891 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
Anna Zaks67221552011-07-28 19:51:27 +00008892 ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this);
8893 MayHaveConvFixit = true;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008894 break;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00008895 case IntToPointer:
8896 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
Anna Zaks67221552011-07-28 19:51:27 +00008897 ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this);
8898 MayHaveConvFixit = true;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00008899 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008900 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00008901 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008902 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
Douglas Gregor926df6c2011-06-11 01:09:30 +00008903 CheckInferredResultType = DstType->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
8904 SrcType->isObjCObjectPointerType();
Anna Zaks67221552011-07-28 19:51:27 +00008905 if (Hint.isNull() && !CheckInferredResultType) {
8906 ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this);
8907 }
8908 MayHaveConvFixit = true;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008909 break;
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00008910 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
8911 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
8912 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008913 case FunctionVoidPointer:
8914 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
8915 break;
John McCall86c05f32011-02-01 00:10:29 +00008916 case IncompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers: {
John McCall40249e72011-02-01 23:28:01 +00008917 // Perform array-to-pointer decay if necessary.
8918 if (SrcType->isArrayType()) SrcType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(SrcType);
8919
John McCall86c05f32011-02-01 00:10:29 +00008920 Qualifiers lhq = SrcType->getPointeeType().getQualifiers();
8921 Qualifiers rhq = DstType->getPointeeType().getQualifiers();
8922 if (lhq.getAddressSpace() != rhq.getAddressSpace()) {
8923 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_incompatible_address_space;
8924 break;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008925
8926
8927 } else if (lhq.getObjCLifetime() != rhq.getObjCLifetime()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8b03132011-06-24 00:08:59 +00008928 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_incompatible_ownership;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008929 break;
John McCall86c05f32011-02-01 00:10:29 +00008930 }
8931
8932 llvm_unreachable("unknown error case for discarding qualifiers!");
8933 // fallthrough
8934 }
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008935 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +00008936 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
8937 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
8938 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
8939 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
John McCalle4be87e2011-01-31 23:13:11 +00008940 // checkPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +00008941 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
8942 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
John McCalle4be87e2011-01-31 23:13:11 +00008943 // of a larger effort to fix checkPointerTypesForAssignment for
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +00008944 // C++ semantics.
8945 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
8946 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
8947 return false;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008948 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
8949 break;
Sean Huntc9132b62009-11-08 07:46:34 +00008950 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanian3451e922009-11-09 22:16:37 +00008951 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00008952 break;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00008953 case IntToBlockPointer:
8954 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
8955 break;
8956 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stump25efa102009-04-21 22:51:42 +00008957 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00008958 break;
Steve Naroff39579072008-10-14 22:18:38 +00008959 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008960 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff39579072008-10-14 22:18:38 +00008961 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
8962 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
8963 break;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00008964 case IncompatibleVectors:
8965 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
8966 break;
Fariborz Jahanian04e5a252011-07-07 18:55:47 +00008967 case IncompatibleObjCWeakRef:
8968 DiagKind = diag::err_arc_weak_unavailable_assign;
8969 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008970 case Incompatible:
8971 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
Anna Zaks67221552011-07-28 19:51:27 +00008972 ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this);
8973 MayHaveConvFixit = true;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008974 isInvalid = true;
8975 break;
8976 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008977
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00008978 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
8979 switch (Action) {
8980 case AA_Assigning:
8981 case AA_Initializing:
8982 // The destination type comes first.
8983 FirstType = DstType;
8984 SecondType = SrcType;
8985 break;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00008986
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00008987 case AA_Returning:
8988 case AA_Passing:
8989 case AA_Converting:
8990 case AA_Sending:
8991 case AA_Casting:
8992 // The source type comes first.
8993 FirstType = SrcType;
8994 SecondType = DstType;
8995 break;
8996 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00008997
Anna Zaks67221552011-07-28 19:51:27 +00008998 PartialDiagnostic FDiag = PDiag(DiagKind);
8999 FDiag << FirstType << SecondType << Action << SrcExpr->getSourceRange();
9000
9001 // If we can fix the conversion, suggest the FixIts.
9002 assert(ConvHints.isNull() || Hint.isNull());
9003 if (!ConvHints.isNull()) {
9004 for (llvm::SmallVector<FixItHint, 1>::iterator
9005 HI = ConvHints.Hints.begin(), HE = ConvHints.Hints.end();
9006 HI != HE; ++HI)
9007 FDiag << *HI;
9008 } else {
9009 FDiag << Hint;
9010 }
9011 if (MayHaveConvFixit) { FDiag << (unsigned) (ConvHints.Kind); }
9012
9013 Diag(Loc, FDiag);
9014
Douglas Gregor926df6c2011-06-11 01:09:30 +00009015 if (CheckInferredResultType)
9016 EmitRelatedResultTypeNote(SrcExpr);
9017
Douglas Gregora41a8c52010-04-22 00:20:18 +00009018 if (Complained)
9019 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00009020 return isInvalid;
9021}
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00009022
Chris Lattner3bf68932009-04-25 21:59:05 +00009023bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00009024 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
9025 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
9026 if (Result)
9027 *Result = ICEResult;
9028 return false;
9029 }
9030
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00009031 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
9032
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00009033 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00009034 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
9035 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
9036
9037 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
9038 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
9039 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
9040 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
9041 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
9042 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
9043 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00009044
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00009045 return true;
9046 }
9047
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00009048 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
9049 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00009050
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00009051 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
Argyrios Kyrtzidis08274082010-12-15 18:44:22 +00009052 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice, EvalResult.DiagLoc)
David Blaikied6471f72011-09-25 23:23:43 +00009053 != DiagnosticsEngine::Ignored)
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00009054 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00009055
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00009056 if (Result)
9057 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
9058 return false;
9059}
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00009060
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00009061void
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009062Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00009063 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00009064 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext,
9065 ExprTemporaries.size(),
9066 ExprNeedsCleanups));
9067 ExprNeedsCleanups = false;
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00009068}
9069
Richard Trieu67e29332011-08-02 04:35:43 +00009070void Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00009071 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
9072 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
9073 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00009074
Douglas Gregor06d33692009-12-12 07:57:52 +00009075 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
9076 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
9077 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
9078 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
9079 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00009080 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregor06d33692009-12-12 07:57:52 +00009081 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
9082 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
9083 I != IEnd; ++I)
9084 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
9085 }
9086
9087 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
9088 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
9089 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
9090 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
9091 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
9092 I != IEnd; ++I)
9093 Diag(I->first, I->second);
9094 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00009095 }
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00009096
9097 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
9098 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
9099 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
9100 // will never be constructed.
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00009101 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated) {
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00009102 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
9103 ExprTemporaries.end());
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00009104 ExprNeedsCleanups = Rec.ParentNeedsCleanups;
9105
9106 // Otherwise, merge the contexts together.
9107 } else {
9108 ExprNeedsCleanups |= Rec.ParentNeedsCleanups;
9109 }
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00009110
9111 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
9112 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00009113}
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00009114
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00009115void Sema::DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext() {
9116 ExprTemporaries.erase(
9117 ExprTemporaries.begin() + ExprEvalContexts.back().NumTemporaries,
9118 ExprTemporaries.end());
9119 ExprNeedsCleanups = false;
9120}
9121
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00009122/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
9123///
9124/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
9125/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
9126/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
9127/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
9128///
9129/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
9130///
9131/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
9132void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
9133 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009134
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6b6b42a2011-04-19 19:51:10 +00009135 D->setReferenced();
9136
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00009137 if (D->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregord7f37bf2009-06-22 23:06:13 +00009138 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009139
Richard Trieu67e29332011-08-02 04:35:43 +00009140 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether
9141 // we're in a template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated
9142 // expressions (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes
9143 // (-Wunused-variables and -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00009144 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00009145 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Anders Carlsson2127ecc2010-10-22 23:37:08 +00009146 D->setUsed();
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00009147 return;
9148 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00009149
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00009150 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
9151 return;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00009152
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00009153 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
9154 // an instantiation.
9155 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
9156 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009157
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00009158 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00009159 case Unevaluated:
9160 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
9161 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009162
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00009163 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
9164 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
9165 // "used"; handle this below.
9166 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009167
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00009168 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
9169 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
9170 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
9171 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00009172 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00009173 return;
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00009174
9175 case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
9176 // Referenced declarations will only be used if the construct in the
9177 // containing expression is used.
9178 return;
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00009179 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009180
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00009181 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanianb7f4cc02009-06-22 17:30:33 +00009182 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Sebastian Redl85ea7aa2011-08-30 19:58:05 +00009183 if (Constructor->isDefaulted()) {
9184 if (Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
9185 if (Constructor->isTrivial())
9186 return;
9187 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
9188 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
9189 } else if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor()) {
9190 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
9191 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
9192 } else if (Constructor->isMoveConstructor()) {
9193 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
9194 DefineImplicitMoveConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
9195 }
Fariborz Jahanian485f0872009-06-22 23:34:40 +00009196 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00009197
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00009198 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Constructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian8d2b3562009-06-26 23:49:16 +00009199 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
Sean Huntcb45a0f2011-05-12 22:46:25 +00009200 if (Destructor->isDefaulted() && !Destructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian8d2b3562009-06-26 23:49:16 +00009201 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00009202 if (Destructor->isVirtual())
9203 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanianc75bc2d2009-06-25 21:45:19 +00009204 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
Sean Hunt2b188082011-05-14 05:23:28 +00009205 if (MethodDecl->isDefaulted() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
Fariborz Jahanianc75bc2d2009-06-25 21:45:19 +00009206 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
Sebastian Redl85ea7aa2011-08-30 19:58:05 +00009207 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed(false)) {
9208 if (MethodDecl->isCopyAssignmentOperator())
9209 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
9210 else
9211 DefineImplicitMoveAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
9212 }
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00009213 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual())
9214 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanianc75bc2d2009-06-25 21:45:19 +00009215 }
Fariborz Jahanianf5ed9e02009-06-24 22:09:44 +00009216 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
John McCall15e310a2011-02-19 02:53:41 +00009217 // Recursive functions should be marked when used from another function.
9218 if (CurContext == Function) return;
9219
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009220 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor1637be72009-06-26 00:10:03 +00009221 // class templates.
Douglas Gregor6cfacfe2010-05-17 17:34:56 +00009222 if (Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00009223 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
9224 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
9225 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
9226 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
9227 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00009228 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregor3b846b62009-10-27 20:53:28 +00009229 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00009230 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00009231 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00009232 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
9233 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
9234 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00009235 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregor3b846b62009-10-27 20:53:28 +00009236 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00009237 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
9238 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00009239
Douglas Gregor60406be2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00009240 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
9241 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
9242 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
9243 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
9244 Loc));
9245 else
Chandler Carruth62c78d52010-08-25 08:44:16 +00009246 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function, Loc));
Douglas Gregor60406be2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00009247 }
John McCall15e310a2011-02-19 02:53:41 +00009248 } else {
9249 // Walk redefinitions, as some of them may be instantiable.
Gabor Greif40181c42010-08-28 00:16:06 +00009250 for (FunctionDecl::redecl_iterator i(Function->redecls_begin()),
9251 e(Function->redecls_end()); i != e; ++i) {
Gabor Greifbe9ebe32010-08-28 01:58:12 +00009252 if (!i->isUsed(false) && i->isImplicitlyInstantiable())
Gabor Greif40181c42010-08-28 00:16:06 +00009253 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *i);
9254 }
John McCall15e310a2011-02-19 02:53:41 +00009255 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00009256
John McCall15e310a2011-02-19 02:53:41 +00009257 // Keep track of used but undefined functions.
9258 if (!Function->isPure() && !Function->hasBody() &&
9259 Function->getLinkage() != ExternalLinkage) {
9260 SourceLocation &old = UndefinedInternals[Function->getCanonicalDecl()];
9261 if (old.isInvalid()) old = Loc;
9262 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis58b52592010-08-25 10:34:54 +00009263
John McCall15e310a2011-02-19 02:53:41 +00009264 Function->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00009265 return;
Douglas Gregord7f37bf2009-06-22 23:06:13 +00009266 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009267
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00009268 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00009269 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009270 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00009271 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
9272 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
9273 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
9274 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
9275 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
9276 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Sebastian Redlf79a7192011-04-29 08:19:30 +00009277 // This is a modification of an existing AST node. Notify listeners.
9278 if (ASTMutationListener *L = getASTMutationListener())
9279 L->StaticDataMemberInstantiated(Var);
Chandler Carruth62c78d52010-08-25 08:44:16 +00009280 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00009281 }
9282 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009283
John McCall77efc682011-02-21 19:25:48 +00009284 // Keep track of used but undefined variables. We make a hole in
9285 // the warning for static const data members with in-line
9286 // initializers.
John McCall15e310a2011-02-19 02:53:41 +00009287 if (Var->hasDefinition() == VarDecl::DeclarationOnly
John McCall77efc682011-02-21 19:25:48 +00009288 && Var->getLinkage() != ExternalLinkage
9289 && !(Var->isStaticDataMember() && Var->hasInit())) {
John McCall15e310a2011-02-19 02:53:41 +00009290 SourceLocation &old = UndefinedInternals[Var->getCanonicalDecl()];
9291 if (old.isInvalid()) old = Loc;
9292 }
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00009293
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00009294 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00009295 return;
Sam Weinigcce6ebc2009-09-11 03:29:30 +00009296 }
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00009297}
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00009298
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00009299namespace {
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00009300 // Mark all of the declarations referenced
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00009301 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00009302 // of when we're entering
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00009303 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
9304 Sema &S;
9305 SourceLocation Loc;
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00009306
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00009307 public:
9308 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00009309
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00009310 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00009311
9312 bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
9313 bool TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T);
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00009314 };
9315}
9316
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00009317bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument(
9318 const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00009319 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
9320 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Arg.getAsDecl());
9321 }
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00009322
9323 return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg);
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00009324}
9325
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00009326bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T) {
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00009327 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
9328 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
9329 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Douglas Gregor910f8002010-11-07 23:05:16 +00009330 return TraverseTemplateArguments(Args.data(), Args.size());
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00009331 }
9332
Chandler Carruthe3e210c2010-06-10 10:31:57 +00009333 return true;
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00009334}
9335
9336void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
9337 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00009338 Marker.TraverseType(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00009339}
9340
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00009341namespace {
9342 /// \brief Helper class that marks all of the declarations referenced by
9343 /// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
9344 class EvaluatedExprMarker : public EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> {
9345 Sema &S;
9346
9347 public:
9348 typedef EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> Inherited;
9349
9350 explicit EvaluatedExprMarker(Sema &S) : Inherited(S.Context), S(S) { }
9351
9352 void VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
9353 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocation(), E->getDecl());
9354 }
9355
9356 void VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) {
9357 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getMemberLoc(), E->getMemberDecl());
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00009358 Inherited::VisitMemberExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00009359 }
9360
9361 void VisitCXXNewExpr(CXXNewExpr *E) {
9362 if (E->getConstructor())
9363 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor());
9364 if (E->getOperatorNew())
9365 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorNew());
9366 if (E->getOperatorDelete())
9367 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00009368 Inherited::VisitCXXNewExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00009369 }
9370
9371 void VisitCXXDeleteExpr(CXXDeleteExpr *E) {
9372 if (E->getOperatorDelete())
9373 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
Douglas Gregor5833b0b2010-09-14 22:55:20 +00009374 QualType Destroyed = S.Context.getBaseElementType(E->getDestroyedType());
9375 if (const RecordType *DestroyedRec = Destroyed->getAs<RecordType>()) {
9376 CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DestroyedRec->getDecl());
9377 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(),
9378 S.LookupDestructor(Record));
9379 }
9380
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00009381 Inherited::VisitCXXDeleteExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00009382 }
9383
9384 void VisitCXXConstructExpr(CXXConstructExpr *E) {
9385 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor());
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00009386 Inherited::VisitCXXConstructExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00009387 }
9388
9389 void VisitBlockDeclRefExpr(BlockDeclRefExpr *E) {
9390 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocation(), E->getDecl());
9391 }
Douglas Gregor102ff972010-10-19 17:17:35 +00009392
9393 void VisitCXXDefaultArgExpr(CXXDefaultArgExpr *E) {
9394 Visit(E->getExpr());
9395 }
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00009396 };
9397}
9398
9399/// \brief Mark any declarations that appear within this expression or any
9400/// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
9401void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Expr *E) {
9402 EvaluatedExprMarker(*this).Visit(E);
9403}
9404
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00009405/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
9406/// of the program being compiled.
9407///
9408/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00009409/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00009410/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
9411/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
9412/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
9413/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00009414/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00009415/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00009416///
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00009417/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
9418/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
9419/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
9420/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00009421bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc, const Stmt *Statement,
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00009422 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00009423 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00009424 case Unevaluated:
9425 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
9426 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00009427
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00009428 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00009429 case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00009430 if (Statement && getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl()) {
Ted Kremenek351ba912011-02-23 01:52:04 +00009431 FunctionScopes.back()->PossiblyUnreachableDiags.
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00009432 push_back(sema::PossiblyUnreachableDiag(PD, Loc, Statement));
Ted Kremenek351ba912011-02-23 01:52:04 +00009433 }
9434 else
9435 Diag(Loc, PD);
9436
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00009437 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00009438
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00009439 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
9440 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
9441 break;
9442 }
9443
9444 return false;
9445}
9446
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00009447bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
9448 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
9449 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
9450 return false;
9451
9452 PartialDiagnostic Note =
9453 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
9454 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
9455 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00009456
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00009457 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00009458 FD ?
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00009459 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
9460 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00009461 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00009462 << CE->getSourceRange(),
9463 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
9464 return true;
9465
9466 return false;
9467}
9468
Douglas Gregor92c3a042011-01-19 16:50:08 +00009469// Diagnose the s/=/==/ and s/\|=/!=/ typos. Note that adding parentheses
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00009470// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
9471void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
9472 SourceLocation Loc;
9473
John McCalla52ef082009-11-11 02:41:58 +00009474 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
Douglas Gregor92c3a042011-01-19 16:50:08 +00009475 bool IsOrAssign = false;
John McCalla52ef082009-11-11 02:41:58 +00009476
Chandler Carruthb33c19f2011-08-16 22:30:10 +00009477 if (BinaryOperator *Op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
Douglas Gregor92c3a042011-01-19 16:50:08 +00009478 if (Op->getOpcode() != BO_Assign && Op->getOpcode() != BO_OrAssign)
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00009479 return;
9480
Douglas Gregor92c3a042011-01-19 16:50:08 +00009481 IsOrAssign = Op->getOpcode() == BO_OrAssign;
9482
John McCallc8d8ac52009-11-12 00:06:05 +00009483 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
9484 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
9485 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
9486 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
9487
John McCallc8d8ac52009-11-12 00:06:05 +00009488 // self = [<foo> init...]
Douglas Gregorc737acb2011-09-27 16:10:05 +00009489 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS()) && Sel.getNameForSlot(0).startswith("init"))
John McCallc8d8ac52009-11-12 00:06:05 +00009490 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
9491
9492 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
Douglas Gregor813d8342011-02-18 22:29:55 +00009493 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() && Sel.getNameForSlot(0) == "nextObject")
John McCallc8d8ac52009-11-12 00:06:05 +00009494 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
9495 }
John McCalla52ef082009-11-11 02:41:58 +00009496
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00009497 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
Chandler Carruthb33c19f2011-08-16 22:30:10 +00009498 } else if (CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = dyn_cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
Douglas Gregor92c3a042011-01-19 16:50:08 +00009499 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal && Op->getOperator() != OO_PipeEqual)
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00009500 return;
9501
Douglas Gregor92c3a042011-01-19 16:50:08 +00009502 IsOrAssign = Op->getOperator() == OO_PipeEqual;
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00009503 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
9504 } else {
9505 // Not an assignment.
9506 return;
9507 }
9508
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00009509 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor92c3a042011-01-19 16:50:08 +00009510
Argyrios Kyrtzidisabdd3b32011-04-25 23:01:29 +00009511 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
9512 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
9513 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
9514 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
9515 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
9516
Douglas Gregor92c3a042011-01-19 16:50:08 +00009517 if (IsOrAssign)
9518 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_or_assign_to_comparison)
9519 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "!=");
9520 else
9521 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
9522 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00009523}
9524
Argyrios Kyrtzidis0e2dc3a2011-02-01 18:24:22 +00009525/// \brief Redundant parentheses over an equality comparison can indicate
9526/// that the user intended an assignment used as condition.
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00009527void Sema::DiagnoseEqualityWithExtraParens(ParenExpr *ParenE) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscf1620a2011-02-01 22:23:56 +00009528 // Don't warn if the parens came from a macro.
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00009529 SourceLocation parenLoc = ParenE->getLocStart();
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscf1620a2011-02-01 22:23:56 +00009530 if (parenLoc.isInvalid() || parenLoc.isMacroID())
9531 return;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis170a6a22011-03-28 23:52:04 +00009532 // Don't warn for dependent expressions.
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00009533 if (ParenE->isTypeDependent())
Argyrios Kyrtzidis170a6a22011-03-28 23:52:04 +00009534 return;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscf1620a2011-02-01 22:23:56 +00009535
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00009536 Expr *E = ParenE->IgnoreParens();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis0e2dc3a2011-02-01 18:24:22 +00009537
9538 if (BinaryOperator *opE = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E))
Argyrios Kyrtzidis70f23302011-02-01 19:32:59 +00009539 if (opE->getOpcode() == BO_EQ &&
9540 opE->getLHS()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->isModifiableLvalue(Context)
9541 == Expr::MLV_Valid) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis0e2dc3a2011-02-01 18:24:22 +00009542 SourceLocation Loc = opE->getOperatorLoc();
Ted Kremenek006ae382011-02-01 22:36:09 +00009543
Ted Kremenekf7275cd2011-02-02 02:20:30 +00009544 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_equality_with_extra_parens) << E->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenekf7275cd2011-02-02 02:20:30 +00009545 Diag(Loc, diag::note_equality_comparison_silence)
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00009546 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ParenE->getSourceRange().getBegin())
9547 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ParenE->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Argyrios Kyrtzidisabdd3b32011-04-25 23:01:29 +00009548 Diag(Loc, diag::note_equality_comparison_to_assign)
9549 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "=");
Argyrios Kyrtzidis0e2dc3a2011-02-01 18:24:22 +00009550 }
9551}
9552
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009553ExprResult Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc) {
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00009554 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis0e2dc3a2011-02-01 18:24:22 +00009555 if (ParenExpr *parenE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E))
9556 DiagnoseEqualityWithExtraParens(parenE);
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00009557
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009558 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
9559 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
9560 E = result.take();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis11ab7902010-11-01 18:49:26 +00009561
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009562 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
John McCallf6a16482010-12-04 03:47:34 +00009563 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
9564 return CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E); // C++ 6.4p4
9565
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009566 ExprResult ERes = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
9567 if (ERes.isInvalid())
9568 return ExprError();
9569 E = ERes.take();
John McCallabc56c72010-12-04 06:09:13 +00009570
9571 QualType T = E->getType();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009572 if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
9573 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
9574 << T << E->getSourceRange();
9575 return ExprError();
9576 }
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00009577 }
9578
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009579 return Owned(E);
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00009580}
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00009581
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009582ExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00009583 Expr *SubExpr) {
9584 if (!SubExpr)
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00009585 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009586
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00009587 return CheckBooleanCondition(SubExpr, Loc);
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00009588}
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00009589
John McCall1de4d4e2011-04-07 08:22:57 +00009590namespace {
John McCall755d8492011-04-12 00:42:48 +00009591 /// A visitor for rebuilding a call to an __unknown_any expression
9592 /// to have an appropriate type.
9593 struct RebuildUnknownAnyFunction
9594 : StmtVisitor<RebuildUnknownAnyFunction, ExprResult> {
9595
9596 Sema &S;
9597
9598 RebuildUnknownAnyFunction(Sema &S) : S(S) {}
9599
9600 ExprResult VisitStmt(Stmt *S) {
9601 llvm_unreachable("unexpected statement!");
9602 return ExprError();
9603 }
9604
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009605 ExprResult VisitExpr(Expr *E) {
9606 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_call)
9607 << E->getSourceRange();
John McCall755d8492011-04-12 00:42:48 +00009608 return ExprError();
9609 }
9610
9611 /// Rebuild an expression which simply semantically wraps another
9612 /// expression which it shares the type and value kind of.
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009613 template <class T> ExprResult rebuildSugarExpr(T *E) {
9614 ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr());
9615 if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
John McCall755d8492011-04-12 00:42:48 +00009616
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009617 Expr *SubExpr = SubResult.take();
9618 E->setSubExpr(SubExpr);
9619 E->setType(SubExpr->getType());
9620 E->setValueKind(SubExpr->getValueKind());
9621 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary);
9622 return E;
John McCall755d8492011-04-12 00:42:48 +00009623 }
9624
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009625 ExprResult VisitParenExpr(ParenExpr *E) {
9626 return rebuildSugarExpr(E);
John McCall755d8492011-04-12 00:42:48 +00009627 }
9628
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009629 ExprResult VisitUnaryExtension(UnaryOperator *E) {
9630 return rebuildSugarExpr(E);
John McCall755d8492011-04-12 00:42:48 +00009631 }
9632
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009633 ExprResult VisitUnaryAddrOf(UnaryOperator *E) {
9634 ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr());
9635 if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
John McCall755d8492011-04-12 00:42:48 +00009636
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009637 Expr *SubExpr = SubResult.take();
9638 E->setSubExpr(SubExpr);
9639 E->setType(S.Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType()));
9640 assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue);
9641 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary);
9642 return E;
John McCall755d8492011-04-12 00:42:48 +00009643 }
9644
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009645 ExprResult resolveDecl(Expr *E, ValueDecl *VD) {
9646 if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(VD)) return VisitExpr(E);
John McCall755d8492011-04-12 00:42:48 +00009647
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009648 E->setType(VD->getType());
John McCall755d8492011-04-12 00:42:48 +00009649
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009650 assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue);
John McCall755d8492011-04-12 00:42:48 +00009651 if (S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009652 !(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(VD) &&
9653 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(VD)->isInstance()))
9654 E->setValueKind(VK_LValue);
John McCall755d8492011-04-12 00:42:48 +00009655
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009656 return E;
John McCall755d8492011-04-12 00:42:48 +00009657 }
9658
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009659 ExprResult VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) {
9660 return resolveDecl(E, E->getMemberDecl());
John McCall755d8492011-04-12 00:42:48 +00009661 }
9662
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009663 ExprResult VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
9664 return resolveDecl(E, E->getDecl());
John McCall755d8492011-04-12 00:42:48 +00009665 }
9666 };
9667}
9668
9669/// Given a function expression of unknown-any type, try to rebuild it
9670/// to have a function type.
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009671static ExprResult rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(Sema &S, Expr *FunctionExpr) {
9672 ExprResult Result = RebuildUnknownAnyFunction(S).Visit(FunctionExpr);
9673 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
9674 return S.DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Result.take());
John McCall755d8492011-04-12 00:42:48 +00009675}
9676
9677namespace {
John McCall379b5152011-04-11 07:02:50 +00009678 /// A visitor for rebuilding an expression of type __unknown_anytype
9679 /// into one which resolves the type directly on the referring
9680 /// expression. Strict preservation of the original source
9681 /// structure is not a goal.
John McCall1de4d4e2011-04-07 08:22:57 +00009682 struct RebuildUnknownAnyExpr
John McCalla5fc4722011-04-09 22:50:59 +00009683 : StmtVisitor<RebuildUnknownAnyExpr, ExprResult> {
John McCall1de4d4e2011-04-07 08:22:57 +00009684
9685 Sema &S;
9686
9687 /// The current destination type.
9688 QualType DestType;
9689
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009690 RebuildUnknownAnyExpr(Sema &S, QualType CastType)
9691 : S(S), DestType(CastType) {}
John McCall1de4d4e2011-04-07 08:22:57 +00009692
John McCalla5fc4722011-04-09 22:50:59 +00009693 ExprResult VisitStmt(Stmt *S) {
John McCall379b5152011-04-11 07:02:50 +00009694 llvm_unreachable("unexpected statement!");
John McCalla5fc4722011-04-09 22:50:59 +00009695 return ExprError();
John McCall1de4d4e2011-04-07 08:22:57 +00009696 }
9697
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009698 ExprResult VisitExpr(Expr *E) {
9699 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_expr)
9700 << E->getSourceRange();
John McCall379b5152011-04-11 07:02:50 +00009701 return ExprError();
John McCall1de4d4e2011-04-07 08:22:57 +00009702 }
9703
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009704 ExprResult VisitCallExpr(CallExpr *E);
9705 ExprResult VisitObjCMessageExpr(ObjCMessageExpr *E);
John McCall379b5152011-04-11 07:02:50 +00009706
John McCalla5fc4722011-04-09 22:50:59 +00009707 /// Rebuild an expression which simply semantically wraps another
9708 /// expression which it shares the type and value kind of.
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009709 template <class T> ExprResult rebuildSugarExpr(T *E) {
9710 ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr());
9711 if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
9712 Expr *SubExpr = SubResult.take();
9713 E->setSubExpr(SubExpr);
9714 E->setType(SubExpr->getType());
9715 E->setValueKind(SubExpr->getValueKind());
9716 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary);
9717 return E;
John McCalla5fc4722011-04-09 22:50:59 +00009718 }
John McCall1de4d4e2011-04-07 08:22:57 +00009719
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009720 ExprResult VisitParenExpr(ParenExpr *E) {
9721 return rebuildSugarExpr(E);
John McCalla5fc4722011-04-09 22:50:59 +00009722 }
9723
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009724 ExprResult VisitUnaryExtension(UnaryOperator *E) {
9725 return rebuildSugarExpr(E);
John McCalla5fc4722011-04-09 22:50:59 +00009726 }
9727
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009728 ExprResult VisitUnaryAddrOf(UnaryOperator *E) {
9729 const PointerType *Ptr = DestType->getAs<PointerType>();
9730 if (!Ptr) {
9731 S.Diag(E->getOperatorLoc(), diag::err_unknown_any_addrof)
9732 << E->getSourceRange();
John McCall755d8492011-04-12 00:42:48 +00009733 return ExprError();
9734 }
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009735 assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue);
9736 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary);
9737 E->setType(DestType);
John McCall755d8492011-04-12 00:42:48 +00009738
9739 // Build the sub-expression as if it were an object of the pointee type.
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009740 DestType = Ptr->getPointeeType();
9741 ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr());
9742 if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
9743 E->setSubExpr(SubResult.take());
9744 return E;
John McCall755d8492011-04-12 00:42:48 +00009745 }
9746
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009747 ExprResult VisitImplicitCastExpr(ImplicitCastExpr *E);
John McCalla5fc4722011-04-09 22:50:59 +00009748
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009749 ExprResult resolveDecl(Expr *E, ValueDecl *VD);
John McCalla5fc4722011-04-09 22:50:59 +00009750
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009751 ExprResult VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) {
9752 return resolveDecl(E, E->getMemberDecl());
John McCall755d8492011-04-12 00:42:48 +00009753 }
John McCalla5fc4722011-04-09 22:50:59 +00009754
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009755 ExprResult VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
9756 return resolveDecl(E, E->getDecl());
John McCall1de4d4e2011-04-07 08:22:57 +00009757 }
9758 };
9759}
9760
John McCall379b5152011-04-11 07:02:50 +00009761/// Rebuilds a call expression which yielded __unknown_anytype.
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009762ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::VisitCallExpr(CallExpr *E) {
9763 Expr *CalleeExpr = E->getCallee();
John McCall379b5152011-04-11 07:02:50 +00009764
9765 enum FnKind {
John McCallf5307512011-04-27 00:36:17 +00009766 FK_MemberFunction,
John McCall379b5152011-04-11 07:02:50 +00009767 FK_FunctionPointer,
9768 FK_BlockPointer
9769 };
9770
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009771 FnKind Kind;
9772 QualType CalleeType = CalleeExpr->getType();
9773 if (CalleeType == S.Context.BoundMemberTy) {
9774 assert(isa<CXXMemberCallExpr>(E) || isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E));
9775 Kind = FK_MemberFunction;
9776 CalleeType = Expr::findBoundMemberType(CalleeExpr);
9777 } else if (const PointerType *Ptr = CalleeType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
9778 CalleeType = Ptr->getPointeeType();
9779 Kind = FK_FunctionPointer;
John McCall379b5152011-04-11 07:02:50 +00009780 } else {
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009781 CalleeType = CalleeType->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
9782 Kind = FK_BlockPointer;
John McCall379b5152011-04-11 07:02:50 +00009783 }
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009784 const FunctionType *FnType = CalleeType->castAs<FunctionType>();
John McCall379b5152011-04-11 07:02:50 +00009785
9786 // Verify that this is a legal result type of a function.
9787 if (DestType->isArrayType() || DestType->isFunctionType()) {
9788 unsigned diagID = diag::err_func_returning_array_function;
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009789 if (Kind == FK_BlockPointer)
John McCall379b5152011-04-11 07:02:50 +00009790 diagID = diag::err_block_returning_array_function;
9791
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009792 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diagID)
John McCall379b5152011-04-11 07:02:50 +00009793 << DestType->isFunctionType() << DestType;
9794 return ExprError();
9795 }
9796
9797 // Otherwise, go ahead and set DestType as the call's result.
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009798 E->setType(DestType.getNonLValueExprType(S.Context));
9799 E->setValueKind(Expr::getValueKindForType(DestType));
9800 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary);
John McCall379b5152011-04-11 07:02:50 +00009801
9802 // Rebuild the function type, replacing the result type with DestType.
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009803 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FnType))
John McCall379b5152011-04-11 07:02:50 +00009804 DestType = S.Context.getFunctionType(DestType,
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009805 Proto->arg_type_begin(),
9806 Proto->getNumArgs(),
9807 Proto->getExtProtoInfo());
John McCall379b5152011-04-11 07:02:50 +00009808 else
9809 DestType = S.Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(DestType,
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009810 FnType->getExtInfo());
John McCall379b5152011-04-11 07:02:50 +00009811
9812 // Rebuild the appropriate pointer-to-function type.
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009813 switch (Kind) {
John McCallf5307512011-04-27 00:36:17 +00009814 case FK_MemberFunction:
John McCall379b5152011-04-11 07:02:50 +00009815 // Nothing to do.
9816 break;
9817
9818 case FK_FunctionPointer:
9819 DestType = S.Context.getPointerType(DestType);
9820 break;
9821
9822 case FK_BlockPointer:
9823 DestType = S.Context.getBlockPointerType(DestType);
9824 break;
9825 }
9826
9827 // Finally, we can recurse.
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009828 ExprResult CalleeResult = Visit(CalleeExpr);
9829 if (!CalleeResult.isUsable()) return ExprError();
9830 E->setCallee(CalleeResult.take());
John McCall379b5152011-04-11 07:02:50 +00009831
9832 // Bind a temporary if necessary.
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009833 return S.MaybeBindToTemporary(E);
John McCall379b5152011-04-11 07:02:50 +00009834}
9835
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009836ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::VisitObjCMessageExpr(ObjCMessageExpr *E) {
John McCall755d8492011-04-12 00:42:48 +00009837 // Verify that this is a legal result type of a call.
9838 if (DestType->isArrayType() || DestType->isFunctionType()) {
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009839 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_func_returning_array_function)
John McCall755d8492011-04-12 00:42:48 +00009840 << DestType->isFunctionType() << DestType;
9841 return ExprError();
John McCall379b5152011-04-11 07:02:50 +00009842 }
9843
John McCall48218c62011-07-13 17:56:40 +00009844 // Rewrite the method result type if available.
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009845 if (ObjCMethodDecl *Method = E->getMethodDecl()) {
9846 assert(Method->getResultType() == S.Context.UnknownAnyTy);
9847 Method->setResultType(DestType);
John McCall48218c62011-07-13 17:56:40 +00009848 }
John McCall755d8492011-04-12 00:42:48 +00009849
John McCall379b5152011-04-11 07:02:50 +00009850 // Change the type of the message.
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009851 E->setType(DestType.getNonReferenceType());
9852 E->setValueKind(Expr::getValueKindForType(DestType));
John McCall379b5152011-04-11 07:02:50 +00009853
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009854 return S.MaybeBindToTemporary(E);
John McCall379b5152011-04-11 07:02:50 +00009855}
9856
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009857ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::VisitImplicitCastExpr(ImplicitCastExpr *E) {
John McCall755d8492011-04-12 00:42:48 +00009858 // The only case we should ever see here is a function-to-pointer decay.
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009859 assert(E->getCastKind() == CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
9860 assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue);
9861 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary);
John McCall379b5152011-04-11 07:02:50 +00009862
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009863 E->setType(DestType);
John McCall755d8492011-04-12 00:42:48 +00009864
John McCall379b5152011-04-11 07:02:50 +00009865 // Rebuild the sub-expression as the pointee (function) type.
9866 DestType = DestType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
9867
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009868 ExprResult Result = Visit(E->getSubExpr());
9869 if (!Result.isUsable()) return ExprError();
John McCall379b5152011-04-11 07:02:50 +00009870
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009871 E->setSubExpr(Result.take());
9872 return S.Owned(E);
John McCall379b5152011-04-11 07:02:50 +00009873}
9874
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009875ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::resolveDecl(Expr *E, ValueDecl *VD) {
9876 ExprValueKind ValueKind = VK_LValue;
9877 QualType Type = DestType;
John McCall379b5152011-04-11 07:02:50 +00009878
9879 // We know how to make this work for certain kinds of decls:
9880
9881 // - functions
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009882 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(VD)) {
9883 if (const PointerType *Ptr = Type->getAs<PointerType>()) {
9884 DestType = Ptr->getPointeeType();
9885 ExprResult Result = resolveDecl(E, VD);
9886 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
9887 return S.ImpCastExprToType(Result.take(), Type,
John McCalla19950e2011-08-10 04:12:23 +00009888 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay, VK_RValue);
9889 }
9890
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009891 if (!Type->isFunctionType()) {
9892 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unknown_any_function)
9893 << VD << E->getSourceRange();
John McCalla19950e2011-08-10 04:12:23 +00009894 return ExprError();
9895 }
John McCall379b5152011-04-11 07:02:50 +00009896
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009897 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD))
9898 if (MD->isInstance()) {
9899 ValueKind = VK_RValue;
9900 Type = S.Context.BoundMemberTy;
John McCallf5307512011-04-27 00:36:17 +00009901 }
9902
John McCall379b5152011-04-11 07:02:50 +00009903 // Function references aren't l-values in C.
9904 if (!S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009905 ValueKind = VK_RValue;
John McCall379b5152011-04-11 07:02:50 +00009906
9907 // - variables
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009908 } else if (isa<VarDecl>(VD)) {
9909 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Type->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
9910 Type = RefTy->getPointeeType();
9911 } else if (Type->isFunctionType()) {
9912 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unknown_any_var_function_type)
9913 << VD << E->getSourceRange();
John McCall755d8492011-04-12 00:42:48 +00009914 return ExprError();
John McCall379b5152011-04-11 07:02:50 +00009915 }
9916
9917 // - nothing else
9918 } else {
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009919 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_decl)
9920 << VD << E->getSourceRange();
John McCall379b5152011-04-11 07:02:50 +00009921 return ExprError();
9922 }
9923
Richard Trieu5e4c80b2011-09-09 03:59:41 +00009924 VD->setType(DestType);
9925 E->setType(Type);
9926 E->setValueKind(ValueKind);
9927 return S.Owned(E);
John McCall379b5152011-04-11 07:02:50 +00009928}
9929
John McCall1de4d4e2011-04-07 08:22:57 +00009930/// Check a cast of an unknown-any type. We intentionally only
9931/// trigger this for C-style casts.
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00009932ExprResult Sema::checkUnknownAnyCast(SourceRange TypeRange, QualType CastType,
9933 Expr *CastExpr, CastKind &CastKind,
9934 ExprValueKind &VK, CXXCastPath &Path) {
John McCall1de4d4e2011-04-07 08:22:57 +00009935 // Rewrite the casted expression from scratch.
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00009936 ExprResult result = RebuildUnknownAnyExpr(*this, CastType).Visit(CastExpr);
John McCalla5fc4722011-04-09 22:50:59 +00009937 if (!result.isUsable()) return ExprError();
John McCall1de4d4e2011-04-07 08:22:57 +00009938
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00009939 CastExpr = result.take();
9940 VK = CastExpr->getValueKind();
9941 CastKind = CK_NoOp;
John McCalla5fc4722011-04-09 22:50:59 +00009942
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00009943 return CastExpr;
John McCall1de4d4e2011-04-07 08:22:57 +00009944}
9945
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00009946static ExprResult diagnoseUnknownAnyExpr(Sema &S, Expr *E) {
9947 Expr *orig = E;
John McCall379b5152011-04-11 07:02:50 +00009948 unsigned diagID = diag::err_uncasted_use_of_unknown_any;
John McCall1de4d4e2011-04-07 08:22:57 +00009949 while (true) {
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00009950 E = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
9951 if (CallExpr *call = dyn_cast<CallExpr>(E)) {
9952 E = call->getCallee();
John McCall379b5152011-04-11 07:02:50 +00009953 diagID = diag::err_uncasted_call_of_unknown_any;
9954 } else {
John McCall1de4d4e2011-04-07 08:22:57 +00009955 break;
John McCall379b5152011-04-11 07:02:50 +00009956 }
John McCall1de4d4e2011-04-07 08:22:57 +00009957 }
9958
John McCall379b5152011-04-11 07:02:50 +00009959 SourceLocation loc;
9960 NamedDecl *d;
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00009961 if (DeclRefExpr *ref = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) {
John McCall379b5152011-04-11 07:02:50 +00009962 loc = ref->getLocation();
9963 d = ref->getDecl();
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00009964 } else if (MemberExpr *mem = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) {
John McCall379b5152011-04-11 07:02:50 +00009965 loc = mem->getMemberLoc();
9966 d = mem->getMemberDecl();
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00009967 } else if (ObjCMessageExpr *msg = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(E)) {
John McCall379b5152011-04-11 07:02:50 +00009968 diagID = diag::err_uncasted_call_of_unknown_any;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis20718082011-10-03 06:36:51 +00009969 loc = msg->getSelectorStartLoc();
John McCall379b5152011-04-11 07:02:50 +00009970 d = msg->getMethodDecl();
John McCall819e7452011-08-31 20:57:36 +00009971 if (!d) {
9972 S.Diag(loc, diag::err_uncasted_send_to_unknown_any_method)
9973 << static_cast<unsigned>(msg->isClassMessage()) << msg->getSelector()
9974 << orig->getSourceRange();
9975 return ExprError();
9976 }
John McCall379b5152011-04-11 07:02:50 +00009977 } else {
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +00009978 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_expr)
9979 << E->getSourceRange();
John McCall379b5152011-04-11 07:02:50 +00009980 return ExprError();
9981 }
9982
9983 S.Diag(loc, diagID) << d << orig->getSourceRange();
John McCall1de4d4e2011-04-07 08:22:57 +00009984
9985 // Never recoverable.
9986 return ExprError();
9987}
9988
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00009989/// Check for operands with placeholder types and complain if found.
9990/// Returns true if there was an error and no recovery was possible.
John McCallfb8721c2011-04-10 19:13:55 +00009991ExprResult Sema::CheckPlaceholderExpr(Expr *E) {
John McCall1de4d4e2011-04-07 08:22:57 +00009992 // Placeholder types are always *exactly* the appropriate builtin type.
9993 QualType type = E->getType();
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00009994
John McCall1de4d4e2011-04-07 08:22:57 +00009995 // Overloaded expressions.
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009996 if (type == Context.OverloadTy) {
9997 // Try to resolve a single function template specialization.
9998 // This is obligatory.
9999 ExprResult result = Owned(E);
10000 if (ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(result, false)) {
10001 return result;
10002
10003 // If that failed, try to recover with a call.
10004 } else {
10005 tryToRecoverWithCall(result, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_unresolvable),
10006 /*complain*/ true);
10007 return result;
10008 }
10009 }
John McCall1de4d4e2011-04-07 08:22:57 +000010010
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010011 // Bound member functions.
10012 if (type == Context.BoundMemberTy) {
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +000010013 ExprResult result = Owned(E);
10014 tryToRecoverWithCall(result, PDiag(diag::err_bound_member_function),
10015 /*complain*/ true);
10016 return result;
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010017 }
10018
John McCall1de4d4e2011-04-07 08:22:57 +000010019 // Expressions of unknown type.
10020 if (type == Context.UnknownAnyTy)
10021 return diagnoseUnknownAnyExpr(*this, E);
10022
10023 assert(!type->isPlaceholderType());
10024 return Owned(E);
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +000010025}
Richard Trieubb9b80c2011-04-21 21:44:26 +000010026
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +000010027bool Sema::CheckCaseExpression(Expr *E) {
10028 if (E->isTypeDependent())
Richard Trieubb9b80c2011-04-21 21:44:26 +000010029 return true;
Richard Trieuccd891a2011-09-09 01:45:06 +000010030 if (E->isValueDependent() || E->isIntegerConstantExpr(Context))
10031 return E->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType();
Richard Trieubb9b80c2011-04-21 21:44:26 +000010032 return false;
10033}